Costing of ICWAI
Costing of ICWAI
Costing of ICWAI
6
01
-2
US
AB
LL
SY
COST
ACCOUNTING INTERMEDIATE
STUDY NOTES
Published by :
Directorate of Studies
The Institute of Cost Accountants of India (ICAI)
CMA Bhawan, 12, Sudder Street, Kolkata - 700 016
Printed at :
M/s. Sap Prints Solutions Pvt. Ltd.
28A, Lakshmi Industrial Estate
S.N. Path, Lower Parel (W)
Mumbai - 400 013, Maharashtra
C
30%
A
40%
B
30%
ASSESSMENT STRATEGY
There will be written examination paper of three hours
OBJECTIVES
To provide an in depth study of the Cost Accounting Principles and Techniques for identification, analysis and
classification of cost components to facilitate managerial decision making.
Learning aims
The syllabus aims to test the student’s ability to:
Understand and explain the conceptual framework of Cost Accounting
Explain the basic concepts and processes in determination of cost of products and services
Understand the Cost Accounting Standards (CAS)
Apply marginal costing in decision making
Apply the concept of Standard Costing for variance analysis
Skill set required
Level B: Requiring the skill levels of knowledge, comprehension, application and analysis.
COST ACCOUNTING
INTRODUCTION TO COST ACCOUNTING [40 MARKS]
1. INTRODUCTION TO COST ACCOUNTING:
(a) Definition, Scope, objectives and significance of cost accounting, its relationship with financial
accounting and management accounting
(b) Cost Objects, Cost centers and Cost Units
(c) Elements of cost
(d) Classification of costs
2. COST ASCERTAINMENT - ELEMENTS OF COST:
(a) Material Costs:
(i) Procurement of Materials,
(ii) Inventory Management and Control,
(iii) Inventory Accounting & Valuation
(iv) Physical Verification, treatment of losses
(v) Scrap, spoilage, defectives and wastage.
(b) Employee Costs:
(i) Time keeping, Time booking and payroll,
(ii) Labour Turnover, Overtime and idle time
(iii) Principles and methods of remuneration and incentive schemes
(iv) Employee cost reporting and measurement of efficiency.
(c) Direct Expenses
(d) Overheads:
(i) Collection, classification and apportionment and allocation of overheads
(ii) Absorption and treatment of over or under absorption of overheads
(iii) Reporting of overhead costs
3. COST ACCOUNTING STANDARDS (Basic Understanding only)
(CAS 1 to CAS 24)
4. COST BOOK KEEPING:
(a) Cost Accounting Records, Ledgers and Cost Statements
(b) Items excluded from cost and normal and abnormal items/cost
(c) Integral accounts
(d) Reconciliation of cost accounting records with financial accounts
(e) Infrastructure, Educational, Healthcare and Port services
METHODS OF COSTING [30 MARKS]
5. METHODS OF COSTING:
(a) Job Costing
(b) Batch Costing
(c) Contract Costing
(d) Process Costing – Normal and abnormal losses, equivalent production, Joint and By Products.
(e) Operating Costing or Service Costing – Transport, Hotel and Hospital
COST ACCOUNTING TECHNIQUES [30 MARKS]
6. COST ACCOUNTING TECHNIQUES: (Basic Understanding only)
(A) Marginal Costing
(i) Meaning of Marginal Cost and Marginal Costing
(ii) Absorption Costing vs. Marginal Costing
(iii) Break-even analysis
(iv) Margin of safety
(v) Application of Marginal Costing for decision making (simple problems only)
(B) Standard Costing & Variance Analysis
(i) Concept of standard cost and standard costing
(ii) Advantages and limitations
(iii) Computation of variances relating to material and labour costs only
(C) Budget and Budgetary Control (simple problems only)
(i) Concepts, Types of Budgets
(ii) Budgetary Control Vs Standard Costing
(iii) Advantages and limitations
(iv) Preparation of Budgets (simple problems only)
Contents
COST ACCOUNTING
Study Note 1 : Introduction to Cost Accounting
1.1 Definition, scope, objectives and significance of Cost Accounting, its relationship with
Financial Accounting and Management Accounting 1
1.2 Cost Object, Cost Centers and Cost Units – Elements of Cost 8
1.3 Classification of Cost 14
1.4 Role of Cost Accountants in Organisations 23
1.1 Definition, scope, objectives and significance of Cost Accounting its relationship with
Financial Accounting and Management Accounting
1.2 Cost Objects, Cost Centres and Cost Units − Elements of Cost
1.3 Classification of Costs
1.4 Role of Cost Accountants in organisations
1.1 DEFINITION, SCOPE, OBJECTIVES AND SIGNIFICANCE OF COST ACCOUNTING, ITS RELATIONSHIP
WITH FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING AND MANAGEMENT ACCOUNTING
Way back to 15th Century, no accounting system was there and it was the barter system prevailed.
It was in the last years of 15th century Luca Pacioli, an Italian found out the double entry system of
accounting in the year 1494. Later it was developed in England and all over the world upto 20th
Century. During these 400 years, the purpose of Cost Accounting needs are served as a small branch
of Financial Accounting except a few like Royal wallpaper manufactory in France (17th Century), and
some iron masters & potters (18th century).
The period 1880 AD- 1925 AD saw the development of complex product designs and the emergence
of multi activity diversified corporations like Du Pont, General Motors etc. It was during this period that
scientific management was developed which led the accountants to convert physical standards into
Cost Standards, the latter being used for variance analysis and control.
During the World War I and II the social importance of Cost Accounting grew with the growth of each
country’s defence expenditure. In the absence of competitive markets for most of the material required
for war, the governments in several countries placed cost-plus contracts under which the price to be
paid was cost of production plus an agreed rate of profit. The reliance on cost estimation by parties to
defence contracts continued after World War II.
In addition to the above, the following factors have made accountants to find new techniques to
serve the industry :-
(i) Limitations placed on financial accounting
(ii) Improved cost consciousness
(iii) Rapid industrial development after industrial revolution and world wars
(iv) Growing competition among the manufacturers
(v) To control galloping price rise, the cost of computing the precise cost of product / service
(vi) To control cost several legislations passed throughout the world and India too such as Essential
Commodities Act, Industrial Development and Regulation Act... etc.
Due to the above factors, the Cost Accounting has emerged as a specialised discipline from the initial
years of 20th century i.e after World War I and II.
In India, prior to independence, there were a few Cost Accountants, and they were qualified mainly
from I.C.M.A. (now CIMA) London. During the Second World War, the need for developing the
profession in the country was felt, and the leadership of forming an Indian Institute was taken by some
members of Defence Services employed at Kolkata. However, with the enactment of the Cost and
Works Accountants of India Act, 1959, the Institute of Cost and Works Accountants of India (Now called
as The Institute of Cost Accountants of India) was established at Kolkata. The profession assumed further
importance in 1968 when the Government of India introduced Cost Audit under section 233(B) of the
Companies Act, 1956. At present it is under Section 148 of the Companies Act, 2013.
Many times we use Cost Accounting, Costing and Cost Accountancy interchangeably. But there are
differences among these terms. As a professional, though we use interchangeably we must know the
meaning of each term precisely.
Cost Accounting : Cost Accounting may be defined as “Accounting for costs classification and analysis
of expenditure as will enable the total cost of any particular unit of production to be ascertained
with reasonable degree of accuracy and at the same time to disclose exactly how such total cost is
constituted”. Thus Cost Accounting is classifying, recording an appropriate allocation of expenditure
for the determination of the costs of products or services, and for the presentation of suitably arranged
data for the purpose of control and guidance of management.
Cost Accounting can be explained as follows :-
Cost Accounting is the process of accounting for cost which begins with recording of income and
expenditure and ends with the preparation of statistical data. It is the formal mechanism by means of
which cost of products or services are ascertained and controlled.
Cost Accounting provides analysis and classification of expenditure as will enable the total cost of
any particular unit of product / service to be ascertained with reasonable degree of accuracy and
at the same time to disclose exactly how such total cost is constituted. For example it is not sufficient
to know that the cost of one pen is ` 25/- but the management is also interested to know the cost of
material used, the amount of labour and other expenses incurred so as to control and reduce its cost.
It establishes budgets and standard costs and actual cost of operations, processes, departments or
products and the analysis of variances, profitability and social use of funds.
Thus Cost Accounting is a quantitative method that collects, classifies, summarises and interprets
information for product costing, operation planning and control and decision making.
Material ` 100
Labour ` 40
Expenses ` 60
Total ` 200
Finding out the breakup of the total cost from the recorded data is a daily process. That is why it
is called arithmetic process/daily routine. In this process we are classifying the recorded costs and
summarizing at each element and total is called technique.
Cost Accountancy: Cost Accountancy is defined as ‘the application of Costing and Cost Accounting
principles, methods and techniques to the science, art and practice of cost control and the
ascertainment of profitability’. It includes the presentation of information derived there from for the
purposes of managerial decision making. Thus, Cost Accountancy is the science, art and practice of
a Cost Accountant.
(a) It is a science because it is a systematic body of knowledge having certain principles which a cost
accountant should possess for proper discharge of his responsibilities.
(b) It is an art as it requires the ability and skill with which a Cost Accountant is able to apply the
principles of Cost Accountancy to various managerial problems.
(c) Practice includes the continuous efforts of a Cost Accountant in the field of Cost Accountancy.
Such efforts of a Cost Accountant also include the presentation of information for the purpose of
managerial decision making and keeping statistical records.
To appreciate fully the objectives and scope of Cost Accounting, it would be useful to examine the
position of Cost Accounting in the broader field of general accounting and other sciences. i.e Financial
Accounting, Management Accounting, Engineering and Service Industry.
Financial Accounting and Cost Accounting: Financial Accounting is primarily concerned with the
preparation of financial statements, which summarise the results of operations for selected period of
time and show the financial position of the company at particular dates. In other words Financial
Accounting reports on the resources available (Balance Sheet) and what has been accomplished with
these resources (Profit and Loss Account). Financial Accounting is mainly concerned with requirements
of creditors, shareholders, government, prospective investors and persons outside the management.
Financial Accounting is mostly concerned with external reporting.
Cost Accounting, as the name implies, is primarily concerned with determination of cost of something,
which may be a product, service, a process or an operation according to costing objective of
management. A Cost Accountant is primarily charged with the responsibility of providing cost data for
whatever purposes they may be required for.
The main differences between Financial and Cost Accounting are as follows:
(k) Only transactions which can be measured in (k) Non-Monetary information likes No of Units /
monetary terms are recorded. Hours etc are used.
(l) Financial Accounting deals with actual (l) Cost Accounting deals with partly facts and
figures and facts only. figures and partly estimates / standards.
(m)
Financial Accounting do not provide (m) Cost Accounts provide valuable information
information on efficiencies of various workers/ on the efficiencies of employees and Plant &
Plant & Machinery. Machinery.
(n) Stocks are valued at Cost or Market price (n) Stocks are valued at Cost only.
whichever is lower.
(o) Financial Accounting is a positive science as (o) Cost Accounting is not only positive science
it is subject to legal rigidity with regarding to but also normative because it includes
preparation of financial statements. techniques of budgetary control and
standard costing.
(p) These accounts are kept in such away to (p) Generally Cost Accounts are kept
meet the requirements of Companies Act voluntarily to meet the requirements of the
2013 as per Sec 128 & Income Tax Act, 1961 management, only in some industries Cost
Sec 44AA. Accounting records are kept as per the
Companies Act.
Large number of Conventions, Estimates and Flexible factors: No cost can be said to be exact as they
incorporate a large number of conventions, estimations and flexible factors such as :-
(i) Classification of costs into its elements.
(ii) Materials issue pricing based on average or standard costs.
(iii) Apportionment of overhead expenses and their allocation to cost units/centres.
(iv) Arbitrary allocation of joint costs.
(v) Division of overheads into fixed and variable.
(vi) Maintenance of Cost Accounting system appears to be expensive since the cost analysis,
allocation and absorption of overheads etc. require considerable amount of additional work
causing additional expenditure.
(vii) Since the results shown by the financial accounts differ from those shown by the cost accounts,
there is a need for preparing reconciliation statements for verification of accuracy.
Cost Accounting lacks the uniform procedures and formats in preparing the cost information of a
product/ service. Keeping in view this limitation, all Cost Accounting results can be taken as mere
estimates.
1.2 COST OBJECTS, COST CENTERS AND COST UNITS – ELEMENTS OF COST
Cost: Cost is a measurement, in monetary terms, of the amount of resources used for the purpose of
production of goods or rendering services.
Cost in simple, words, means the total of all expenses. Cost is also defined as the amount of expenditure
(actual or notional) incurred on or attributable to a given thing or to ascertain the cost of a given thing.
Thus it is that which is given or in sacrificed to obtain something. The cost of an article consists of actual
outgoings or ascertained charges incurred in its production and sale. Cost is a generic term and it is
always advisable to qualify the word cost to show exactly what it meant, e.g., prime cost, factory cost,
etc. Cost is also different from value as cost is measured in terms of money whereas value in terms of
usefulness or utility of an article.
Elements of Cost
cost. Direct expenses include all expenditure other than direct material or direct labour that is
specifically incurred for a particular product or process. Such expenses are charged directly to the
particular cost account concerned as part of the prime cost. Examples of direct expenses are: (i) GST;
(ii) Royalty; (iii) Architect or Supervisor’s fees; (iv) Cost of rectifying defective work; (v) Travelling
expenses to the city; (vi) Experimental expenses of pilot projects; (vii) Expenses of designing or drawings
of patterns or models; (viii) Repairs and maintenance of plant obtained on hire; and (ix) Hire of special
equipment obtained for a contract.
Overhead
Overheads comprise of indirect materials, indirect employee cost and indirect expenses which are
not directly identifiable or allocable to a cost object. Overheads may be defined as the aggregate
of the cost of indirect material, indirect labour and such other expenses including services as cannot
conveniently be charged directly to specific cost units. Thus overheads are all expenses other than
direct expenses. In general terms, overheads comprise all expenses incurred for or in connection with,
the general organization of the whole or part of the undertaking, i.e., the cost of operating supplies
and services used by the undertaking and includes the maintenance of capital assets.
Prime Cost
The aggregate of Direct Material, Direct Labour and Direct Expenses is called Prime Cost. Generally it
constitutes 50% to 80% of the total cost of the product, as such, as it is primary to the cost of the product
and called Prime Cost.
Cost Object
Cost object is the technical name for a product or a service, a project, a department or any activity
to which a cost relates. Therefore the term cost should always be linked with a cost object to be more
meaningful. Establishing a relevant cost object is very crucial for a sound costing system. The Cost
object could be defined broadly or narrowly. At a broader level a cost object may be named as a
Cost Centre, where as at a lowermost level it may be called as a Cost Unit.
Cost Driver
CIMA terminology defines a Cost Driver as “the factor influencing the level of cost, often used in the
context of ABC to denote the factor which links activity resource consumption to produce outputs,
for example, the number of purchase orders would be a Cost Driver for procurement cost”. In other
words, we can say that, the Cost Driver is an activity which is responsible for cost incurrence. An activity
may be an event, unit of work etc. Examples of the Cost Drivers are (i) number of machine set−ups, (ii)
number of purchase orders, (iii) hours spent on product inspection, (iv) number of tests performed etc.
Cost Centre
CIMA defines a cost centre as “a location, a person, or an item of equipment (or a group of them) in
or connected with an undertaking, in relation to which costs ascertained and used for the purpose of
cost control”. The determination of suitable cost centres as well as analysis of cost under cost centres
is very helpful for periodical comparison and control of cost. In order to obtain the cost of product or
service, expenses should be suitably segregated to cost centre. The manager of a cost centre is held
responsible for control of cost of his cost centre. The selection of suitable cost centres or cost units
for which costs are to be ascertained in an undertaking depends upon a number of factors such as
organization of a factory, condition of incidence of cost, availability of information, requirements of
costing and management policy regarding selecting a method from various choices. Cost centre
may be production cost centres operating cost centres or process cost centres depending upon the
situation and classification.
Cost centres are of two types-Personal and Impersonal Cost Centre. A personal cost centre consists of
person or group of persons. An impersonal cost centre consists of a location or item of equipment or
group of equipments.
In a manufacturing concern, the cost centres generally follow the pattern or layout of the departments
or sections of the factory and accordingly, there are two main types of cost centres as below :-
(i) Production Cost Centre: These centres are engaged in production work i.e engaged in converting
the raw material into finished product, for example Machine shop, welding shops...etc
(ii) Service Cost Centre: These centres are ancillary to and render service to production cost centres,
for example Plant Maintenance, Administration...etc
The number of cost centres and the size of each vary from one undertaking to another and are
dependent upon the expenditure involved and the requirements of the management for the purpose
of control.
Responsibility Centre
A responsibility centre in Cost Accounting denotes a segment of a business organization for the
activities of which responsibility is assigned to a specific person. Thus a factory may be split into a
number of centres and a supervisor is assigned with the responsibility of each centre. All costs relating
to the centre are collected and the Manager responsible for such a cost centres judged by reference
to the activity levels achieved in relation to costs. Even an individual machine may be treated as
responsibility centre for cost control and cost reduction.
Cost Unit
Cost Unit is a device for the purpose of breaking up or separating costs into smaller sub divisions
attributable to products or services. Cost unit can be defined as a ‘Unit of product or service in relation
to which costs are ascertained’. The cost unit is the narrowest possible level of cost object.
It is the unit of quantity of product, service of time (or combination of these) in relation to which costs
may be ascertained or expressed. We may, for instance, determine service cost per tonne of steel,
per tonne-kilometre of a transport service or per machine hour. Sometimes, a single order or contract
constitutes a cost unit which is known as a job. A batch which consists of a group of identical items
and maintains its identity through one or more stages or production may also be taken as a cost unit.
A few examples of cost units are given below:
Cost Allocation
When items of cost are identifiable directly with some products or departments such costs are charged
to such cost centres. This process is known as cost allocation. Wages paid to workers of service
department can be allocated to the particular department. Indirect materials used by a particular
department can also be allocated to the department. Cost allocation calls for two basic factors - (i)
Concerned department/product should have caused the cost to be incurred, and (ii) exact amount
of cost should be computable.
Cost Apportionment
When items of cost cannot be directly charged to or accurately identifiable with any cost centres,
they are prorated or distributed amongst the cost centres on some predetermined basis. This method
is known as cost apportionment. Thus we see that items of indirect costs residual to the process of cost
allocation are covered by cost apportionment. The predetermination of suitable basis of apportionment
is very important and usually following principles are adopted - (i) Service or use (ii) Survey method (iii)
Ability to bear. The basis ultimately adopted should ensure an equitable share of common expenses
for the cost centres and the basis once adopted should be reviewed at periodic intervals to improve
upon the accuracy of apportionment.
Cost Absorption
Ultimately the indirect costs or overhead as they are commonly known, will have to be distributed over
the final products so that the charge is complete. This process is known as cost absorption, meaning
thereby that the costs absorbed by the production during the period. Usually any of the following
methods are adopted for cost absorption - (i) Direct Material Cost Percentage (ii) Direct Labour Cost
Percentage (iii) Prime Cost Percentage (iv) Direct Labour Hour Rate Method (v) Machine Hour Rate,
etc. The basis should be selected after careful maximum accuracy of Cost Distribution to various
production units. The basis should be reviewed periodically and corrective action whatever needed
should be taken for improving upon the accuracy of the absorption.
Conversion Cost
This term is defined as the sum of direct wages, direct expenses and overhead costs of converting raw
material to the finished products or converting a material from one stage of production to another
stage. In other words, it means the total cost of producing an article less the cost of direct materials
used. The cost of indirect materials and consumable stores are included in such cost. The compilation
of conversion cost is useful in a number of cases. Where cost of direct materials is of fluctuating nature,
conversion cost is used to cost control purpose or for any other decision making. In contracts/jobs
where raw materials are on account of the buyers conversion cost takes the place of total cost in the
books of the producer. Periodic comparison/review of the conversion cost may give sufficient insight
as to the level of efficiency with which the production unit is operating.
Cost Control
Cost Control is defined as the regulation by executive action of the costs of operating an undertaking,
particularly where such action is guided by Cost Accounting. Cost control involves the following steps
and covers the various facets of the management:
Planning: First step in cost control is establishing plans / targets. The plan/target may be in the form of
budgets, standards, estimates and even past actual may be expressed in physical as well as monetary
terms. These serves as yardsticks by which the planned objective can be assessed.
Communication: The plan and the policy laid down by the management are made known to all those
responsible for carrying them out. Communication is established in two directions; directives are issued
by higher level of management to the lower level for compliance and the lower level executives report
performances to the higher level.
Motivation: The plan is given effect to and performances starts. The performance is evaluated, costs are
ascertained and information about results achieved are collected and reported. The fact that costs
are being complied for measuring performances acts as a motivating force and makes individuals
endeavor to better their performances.
Appraisal and Reporting: The actual performance is compared with the predetermined plan and
variances, i.e deviations from the plan are analyzed as to their causes. The variances are reported to
the proper level of management.
Decision Making: The variances are reviewed and decisions taken. Corrective actions and remedial
measures or revision of the target, as required, are taken.
Advantages of Cost Control
The advantages of cost control are mainly as follows
(i) Achieving the expected return on capital employed by maximising or optimizing profit
(ii) Increase in productivity of the available resources
(iii) Reasonable price of the customers
(iv) Continued employment and job opportunity for the workers
(v) Economic use of limited resources of production
(vi) Increased credit worthiness
(vii) Prosperity and economic stability of the industry
Cost Reduction
Profit is the resultant of two varying factors, viz., sales and cost. The wider the gap between these two
factors, the larger is the profit. Thus, profit can be maximised either by increasing sales or by reducing
costs. In a competition less market or in case of monopoly products, it may perhaps be possible to
increase price to earn more profits and the need for reducing costs may not be felt. Such conditions
cannot, however, exist paramount and when competition comes into play, it may not be possible to
increase the sale price without having its adverse effect on the sale volume, which, in turn, reduces
profit. Besides, increase in price of products has the ultimate effect of pushing up the raw material
prices, wages of employees and other expenses- all of which tend to increase costs. In the long run,
substitute products may come up in the market, resulting in loss of business. Avenues have, therefore, to
be explored and method devised to cut down expenditure and thereby reduce the cost of products.
In short, cost reduction would mean maximization of profits by reducing cost through economics and
savings in costs of manufacture, administration, selling and distribution.
Cost reduction may be defined as the real and permanent reduction in the unit costs of goods
manufactured or services rendered without impairing their suitability for the use intended. As will be
seen from the definition, the reduction in costs should be real and permanent. Reductions due to
windfalls, fortuities receipts, changes in government policy like reduction in taxes or duties, or due
to temporary measures taken for tiding over the financial difficulties do not strictly come under the
purview of cost reduction. At the same time a programme of cost reduction should in no way affect
the quality of the products nor should it lower the standards of performance of the business.
Broadly speaking reduction in cost per unit of production may be affected in two ways viz.,
(i) By reducing expenditure, the volume of output remaining constant, and
(ii) By increasing productivity, i.e., by increasing volume of output and the level of expenditure
remains unchanged.
These aspects of cost reduction are closely linked and they act together - there may be a reduction in
the expenditure and the same time, an increase in productivity.
Cost Control vs. Cost Reduction: Both Cost Reduction and Cost Control are efficient tools of management
but their concepts and procedure are widely different. The differences are summarised below:
Types of costing have been designed to suit the needs of individual business conditions. The basic
principles underlying all these methods are the same i.e. to collect and analyze the expenditure
according to the elements of costs and to determine the cost of each Cost Centre and or Cost Unit.
Classification of cost is the arrangement of items of costs in logical groups having regard to their nature
or purpose. Items should be classified by one characteristic for a specific purpose without ambiguity.
Scheme of classification should be such that every item of cost can be classified. In view of the above,
cost classification may be explained as below:
As per Cost Accounting Standard 1 (CAS-1), the basis for cost classification is as follows:
(a) Nature of expense
(b) Relation to Object – Traceability
(c) Functions / Activities
(d) Behaviour – Fixed, Semi-variable or Variable
(e) Management decision making
(f) Production or Process
(g) Time Period
Classification of cost is the process of grouping the components of cost under a common designation
on the basis of similarities of nature, attributes or relations. It is the process of identification of each item
and the systematic placement of like items together according to their common features.
(a) Classification by Nature of Expense
Costs should be gathered together in their natural grouping such as Material, Labour and Other Direct
expenses. Items of costs differ on the basis of their nature. The elements of cost can be classified in the
following three categories. 1. Material 2. Labour 3. Expenses
Material Cost: Material cost is the cost of material of any nature used for the purpose of production
of a product or a service. It includes cost of materials, freight inwards, taxes & duties, insurance ...etc
directly attributable to acquisition, but excluding the trade discounts, duty drawbacks and refunds on
account of GST etc.
Labour Cost: Labour cost means the payment made to the employees, permanent or temporary for
their services. Labour cost includes salaries and wages paid to permanent employees, temporary
employees and also to the employees of the contractor. Here salaries and wages include all the
benefits like provident fund, gratuity, ESI, overtime, incentives...etc
Expenses: Expenses are other than material cost or labour cost which are involved in an activity.
(b) Classification by Relation to Cost Centre or Cost Unit
If expenditure can be allocated to a cost centre or cost object in an economically feasible way then
it is called direct otherwise the cost component will be termed as indirect. According to this criteria for
classification, material cost is divided into direct material cost and indirect material cost, Labour cost
is divided into direct labour and indirect labour cost and expenses into direct expenses and indirect
expenses. Indirect cost is also known as overhead.
Direct Indirect
Direct Material Cost: Cost of material which can be directly allocated to a cost centre or a cost object
in an economically feasible way.
Direct labour Cost: Cost of wages of those workers who are readily identified or linked with a cost
centre or cost object.
Direct Expenses: Expenses other than direct material and direct labour which can be identified or
linked with cost centre or cost object.
Direct Material + Direct labour + Direct Expenses = Prime Cost
Indirect Material : Cost of material which cannot be directly allocable to a particular cost centre or
cost object.
Indirect Labour : Cost of wages of employees which are not directly allocable to a particular cost
centre.
Indirect expenses: Expenses other than of the nature of material or labour and cannot be directly
allocable to a particular cost centre.
Costs may be required to be determined for each of these functions and on this basis functional costs
may be classified into the following types:-
(i) Production or Manufacturing Costs: Production cost is the cost of all items involved in the production of
a product or service. These refer to the costs of operating the manufacturing division of an undertaking
and include all costs incurred by the factory from the receipt of raw materials and supply of labour and
services until production is completed and the finished product is packed with the primary packing.
The followings are considered as Production or Manufacturing Costs:-
(1) Direct Material
(2) Direct Labour
(3) Direct Expenses and
(4) Factory overhead, i.e., aggregate of factory indirect material, indirect labour and indirect
expenses.
Manufacturing cost can also be referred to as the aggregate of prime cost and factory overhead.
(ii) Administration Costs: Administration costs are expenses incurred for general management of an
organization. These are in the nature of indirect costs and are also termed as administrative overheads.
For understanding administration cost, it is necessary to know the scope of administrative function.
Administrative function in any organization is primarily concerned with following activities :-
(1) Formulation of policy
Fixed Cost: Fixed cost is the cost which does not vary with the change in the volume of activity in the
short run. These costs are not affected by temporary fluctuation in activity of an enterprise. These are
also known as period costs. Example: Rent, Depreciation...etc.
Variable Cost: Variable cost is the cost of elements which tends to directly vary with the volume of
activity. Variable cost has two parts (i) Variable direct cost (ii) Variable indirect costs. Variable indirect
costs are termed as variable overheads. Example: Direct labour, Outward Freight...etc.
Semi-Variable Costs: Semi variable costs contain both fixed and variable elements. They are partly
affected by fluctuation in the level of activity. These are partly fixed and partly variable costs and vice
versa. Example: Factory supervision, Maintenance...etc.
(e) Classification based on Costs for Management Decision Making
Ascertainment of cost is essential for making managerial decisions. On this basis costing may be
classified into the following types.
Marginal Costing: Marginal Cost is the aggregate of variable costs, i.e. prime cost plus variable
overhead. Marginal cost per unit is the change in the amount at any given volume of output by which
the aggregate cost changes if the volume of output is increased or decreased by one unit. Marginal
Costing system is based on the system of classification of costs into fixed and variable. The fixed costs
are excluded and only the marginal costs, i.e. the variable costs are taken into consideration for
determining the cost of products and the inventory of work-in-progress and completed products.
Differential Cost: Differential cost is the change in the cost due to change in activity from one level to
another.
Opportunity Cost: Opportunity cost is the value of alternatives foregone by adopting a particular
strategy or employing resources in specific manner. It is the return expected from an investment other
than the present one. These refer to costs which result from the use or application of material, labour
or other facilities in a particular manner which has been foregone due to not using the facilities in the
manner originally planned. Resources (or input) like men, materials, plant and machinery, finance etc.,
when utilized in one particulars way, yield a particular return (or output). If the same input is utilized in
another way, yielding the same or a different return, the original return on the forsaken alternative that
is no longer obtainable is the opportunity cost. For example, if fixed deposits in the bank are proposed
to be withdrawn for financing project, the opportunity cost would be the loss of interest on the deposits.
Similarly when a building leased out on rent to a party is got vacated for own purpose or a vacant
space is not leased out but used internally, say, for expansion of the production programme, the rent
so forgone is the opportunity cost.
Replacement Cost: Replacement cost is the cost of an asset in the current market for the purpose
of replacement. Replacement cost is used for determining the optimum time of replacement of an
equipment or machine in consideration of maintenance cost of the existing one and its productive
capacity. This is the cost in the current market of replacing an asset. For example, when replacement
cost of material or an asset is being considered, it means that the cost that would be incurred if the
material or the asset was to be purchased at the current market price and not the cost, at which it was
actually purchased earlier, should be take into account.
Relevant Costs: Relevant costs are costs which are relevant for a specific purpose or situation. In the
context of decision making, only those costs are relevant which are pertinent to the decision at hand.
Since we are concerned with future costs only while making a decision, historical costs, unless they
remain unchanged in the future period are irrelevant to the decision making process.
Imputed Costs: Imputed costs are hypothetical or notional costs, not involving cash outlay computed
only for the purpose of decision making. In this respect, imputed costs are similar to opportunity costs.
Interest on funds generated internally, payment for which is not actually made is an example of
imputed cost. When alternative capital investment projects are being considered out of which one or
more are to be financed from internal funds, it is necessary to take into account the imputed interest
on own funds before a decision is arrived at.
Sunk Costs: Sunk costs are historical costs which are incurred i.e. sunk in the past and are not relevant
to the particular decision making problem being considered. Sunk costs are those that have been
incurred for a project and which will not be recovered if the project is terminated. While considering
the replacement of a plant, the depreciated book value of the old asset is irrelevant as the amount is
sunk cost which is to be written-off at the time of replacement.
Normal Cost & Abnormal Cost: Normal Cost is a cost that is normally incurred at a given level of output
in the conditions in which that level of output is achieved. Abnormal Cost is an unusual and typical
cost whose occurrence is usually irregular and unexpected and due to some abnormal situation of the
production.
Avoidable Costs & Unavoidable Costs: Avoidable Costs are those which under given conditions of
performance efficiency should not have been incurred. Unavoidable Costs which are inescapable
costs, which are essentially to be incurred, within the limits or norms provided for. It is the cost that must
be incurred under a programme of business restriction. It is fixed in nature and inescapable.
Uniform Costing: This is not a distinct system of costing. The term applies to the costing principles and
procedures which are adopted in common by a number of undertakings which desire to have the
benefits of a uniform system. The methods of Uniform Costing may be extended so as to be useful in
inter-firm comparison.
Engineered Cost: Engineered Cost relates to an item where the input has an explicit physical relationship
with the output. For instance in the manufacture of a product, there is a definite relationship between the
units of raw material and labour time consumed and the amount of variable manufacturing overhead
on the one hand and units of the products produced on the other. The input-output relationship can
be established the form of standards by engineering analysis or by an analysis of the historical data. It
should be noted that the variable costs are not engineered cost but some administration and selling
expenses may be categorized as engineered cost.
Out-of-Pocket Cost: This is the portion of the cost associated with an activity that involve cash payment
to other parties, as opposed to costs which do not require any cash outlay, such as depreciation
and certain allocated costs. Out-of-Pocket Costs are very much relevant in the consideration of price
fixation during trade recession or when a make-or-buy decision is to be made.
Managed Cost: Managed (Programmed or Discretionary) Costs all opposed to engineering costs, relate
to such items where no accurate relationship between the amount spent on input and the output can
be established and sometimes it is difficult to measure the output. Examples are advertisement cost,
research and development costs, etc.,
Common Costs: These are costs which are incurred collectively for a number of cost centres and are
required to be suitably apportioned for determining the cost of individual cost centres. Examples are:
Combined purchase cost of several materials in one consignment, and overhead expenses incurred
for the factory as a whole.
Controllable and Non-Controllable Costs: Controllable Cost is that cost which is subject to direct
control at some level of managerial supervision. Non-controllable Cost is the cost which is not subject
to control at any level of managerial supervision.
Batch Costing: Batch Costing is the aggregate cost related to a cost unit which consists of a group of
similar articles which maintains its identity throughout one or more stages of production. In this method,
the cost of a group of products is ascertained. The unit cost is a batch or group of identical products
instead of a single job, order, or contract. This method is applicable to general engineering factories
which produces components in convenient economical batches.
Process Costing: When the production process is such that goods are produced from a sequence
of continuous or repetitive operations or processes, the cost incurred during a period is considered
as Process Cost. The process cost per unit is derived by dividing the process cost by number of units
produced in the process during the period. Process Costing is employed in industries where a continuous
process of manufacturing is carried out. Costs are ascertained for a specified period of time by
departments or process. Chemical industries, refineries, gas and electricity generating concerns may
be quoted as examples of undertakings that employ process costing.
Operation Cost: Operation Cost is the cost of a specific operation involved in a production process
or business activity. The cost unit in this method is the operation, instead of process. When the
manufacturing method consists of a number of distinct operations, operation costing is suitable.
Operating Cost: Operating cost is the cost incurred in conducting a business activity. Operating cost
refer to the cost of undertakings which do not manufacture any product but which provide services.
Industries and establishments like power house, transport and travel agencies, hospitals, and schools,
which undertake services rather than the manufacture of products, ascertain operating costs. The
cost units used are Kilo Watt Hour (KWH), Passenger Kilo-meter and Bed in the hospital....etc. Operating
costing method constitutes a distinct type of costing but it may also be classed as a variant of Process
Cost since costs in this method are usually compiled for a specified period.
Contract Costing: Contract cost is the cost of contract with some terms and conditions between
contractee and contractor. This method is used in undertakings, carrying out, building or constructional
contracts like constructional engineering concerns, civil engineering contractors. The cost unit here is a
contract, which may continue over more than one financial year.
Joint Costs: Joint costs are the common cost of facilities or services employed in the output of two
or more simultaneously produced or otherwise closely related operations, commodities or services.
When a production process is such that from a set of same input two or more distinguishably different
products are produced together, products of greater importance are termed as Joint Products and
products of minor importance are termed as By-products and the costs incurred prior to the point of
separation are called Joint Costs. For example in petroleum industry petrol, diesel, kerosene, naphtha,
tar is produced jointly in the refinery process.
By-product Cost: By-product Cost is the cost assigned to by-products till the split-off point.
Classification by Time
Historical Pre-determined
Cost Cost
Historical Costs: Historical Costs are the actual costs of acquiring assets or producing goods or services.
They are post-mortem costs ascertained after they have been incurred and they represent the cost of
actual operational performance. Historical Costing follows a system of accounting to which all values
are based on costs actually incurred as relevant from time to time.
Predetermined Costs: Pre-determined Costs for a product are computed in advance of production
process, on the basis of a specification of all the factors affecting cost and cost data. Predetermined
Costs may be either standard or estimated.
Standard Costs: A predetermined norm applies as a scale of reference for assessing actual cost,
whether these are more or less. The Standard Cost serves as a basis of cost control and as a measure
of productive efficiency, when ultimately posed with an actual cost. It provides management with
a medium by which the effectiveness of current results is measured and responsibility of deviation
placed. Standard Costs are used to compare the actual costs with the standard cost with a view to
determine the variances, if any, and analyse the causes of variances and take proper measure to
control them.
Estimated Costs: Estimated Costs of a product are prepared in advance prior to the performance
of operations or even before the acceptance of sale orders. Estimated Cost is found with specific
reference to product in question, and the activity levels of the plant. It has no link with actual and
hence it is assumed to be less accurate than the Standard Cost.
Techniques of Costing
A. Marginal Costing
B. Standard Costing
C. Budgetary Control
D. Uniform Costing
A. Marginal costing
Marginal Costing is the ascertainment of marginal costs and of the effect on profit of changes in
volume or type of output by differentiating between fixed costs and variable costs. Several other terms
in use like Direct Costing, Contributory Costing, Variable Costing, Comparative Costing, Differential
Costing and Incremental Costing are used more or less synonymously with Marginal Costing.
The term direct cost should not be confused with direct costing. In absorption costing, direct cost
refers to the cost which is attributable to a cost centre of cost unit (e.g., direct labour, direct material
and direct expenses including traceable fixed expenses, i.e., the fixed expense which are directly
chargeable). In Direct Costing (or Marginal Costing), factory variable overhead is taken as a direct
cost while in the Absorption Cost Method, it is Indirect Cost.
B. Standard Costing
Standard Costing is defined as the preparation and use of standard cost, their comparison with
actual costs and the measurement and analysis of variances to their causes and points of incidence.
Standard Cost is a predetermined cost unit that is calculated from the management’s standards of
efficient operation and the relevant necessary expenditure. Standard Costs are useful for the cost
estimation and price quotation and for indicating the suitable cost allowances for products, process
and operations but they are effective tools for cost control only when compared with the actual costs
of operation. The techniques of standard costing may be summarised as follows :-
(i) Predetermination of technical data related to production. i.e., details of materials and labour
operations required for each product, the quantum of inevitable losses, efficiencies expected,
level of activity, etc.
(ii) Predetermination of standard costs in full details under each element of cost, viz., labour, material
and overhead.
(iii) Comparison of the actual performance and costs with the standards and working out the
variances, i.e., the differences between the actual and the standards.
(iv) Analysis of the variances in order to determine the reasons for deviations of actuals from the
standards.
(v) Presentation of information to the appropriate level of management to enable suitable action
(remedial measures or revision of the standard) being taken.
C. Budgetary Control
Budgetary Control may be defined as the process of continuous comparison of actual costs and
performance with the pre-established budgets in relation to the responsibilities of the executives to the
specific budgets for the achievement of a target in accordance with the policy of the organisation and
to provide a basis for revision of budget. Therefore, Budgetary Control involves mainly establishment
of budgets, continuous compassion of actual with budgets for achievement of targets, revision of
budgets in the light of changed circumstances.
The classification of budgets into various categories certainly helps to make the budgetary control
more effective because the maximum use is made of the functional budgets. Functional Budgets over
the goals to be attained by the functional executives and thus assume the greatest significance.
D. Uniform Costing
Uniform Costing may be defined as the application and use of the same costing principles and
procedures by different Organizations under the same management or on a common understanding
between members of an association. It is thus not a separate technique or method. It simply denotes
a situation in which a number of organizations may use the same costing principles in such a way as
to produce costs which are of the maximum comparability. From such comparable costs valuable
conclusions can be drawn. When the Uniform Costing is made use of by the different concerns
the same management it helps to indicate the strengths and/or weaknesses of those concerns. By
studying the findings, appropriate corrective steps may be taken to improve the overall efficiency of
the organizations. When used by the member concerns of a trade association Uniform Costing helps to
reduce expenditure on a comparative marketing, to determine and follow a uniform pricing policy, to
exchange information between the members for comprised and improvement and so on.
Inter-firm Comparison as the name denotes means the techniques of evaluating the performances,
efficiencies, deficiencies, costs and profits of similar nature of firms engaged in the same industry or
business. It consists of exchange of information, voluntarily of course, concerning production, sales
cost with various types of break-up, prices, profits, etc., among the firms who are interested or willing
to make the device a success. The basic purposes of such comparison are to find out the work points
in an organization and to improve the efficiency by taking appropriate measures to wipe out the
weakness gradually over a period of time.
In today’s business world all organisations irrespective of their size, nature of business, profitability etc.
need a wide variety of cost information in making day−to−day operating decisions. The cost accountants
collect, assimilate, collate, and analyse all financial information relating to the organisations. They
consider many factors such as the cost of raw materials, labour, overheads etc. in order to plan and
execute effective management information and control system, inventory control incorporating
mathematical models, investment analysis, internal audit, cost audit, project management etc.
The cost accountants perform one of the most important roles in the entire organisations. They deal with
the preparation of various reports for the knowledge and decision making by the senior management.
Therefore, the companies must provide greater emphasis on the role of the cost accountants.
The role of the cost accountants in the organisations can be enumerated as follows:
(i) to analyse various elements of cost of production/services such as material, labour, overhead
expenses etc.
(ii) to introduce appropriate costing methods in the organisation so as to facilitate management with
the knowledge of cost of production/services for managerial decision making
(iii) to determine the cost of the new product/service in order to facilitate management in arriving at
the correct pricing decisions
(iv) to determine the feasibility and profitability of the various project proposals considered by the
management
(v) to analyse variances against standard by reason to enable concerned department to initiate
corrective action
(vi) collection, collation of extraneous information for management to compare the company’s
performance with that of peers and the industry for better appreciation and decision−making.
GLOSSARY
Activity based Costing (ABC): Activity based Costing is a system that focuses on activities as the
fundamental cost objects and uses the cost of these activities for compiling the costs of products and
other cost objects. The product cost is built up from the cost of the specific activities undertaken to
manufacture it.
Conversion Cost: Conversion Cost is the cost of converting material input into semi−finished or finished
products i.e. the cost incurred in additional direct materials, direct wages, direct expenses and
absorbed overhead.
Cost Absorption: Cost Absorption is the process of charging to the cost units by means of rates.
Cost Accountancy: Cost Accountancy is the application of costing and cost accounting principles,
methods and techniques to the science, art and practice of cost control and the ascertainment of
profitability. It includes the presentation of information derived therefrom for the purpose of managerial
decision making.
Cost Accounting: Cost Accounting is a process of accounting for cost which begins with the recording
of income and expenditure or the bases on which they are calculated and ends with the preparation
of periodical statements and reports for ascertaining and controlling costs.
Cost Allocation: Cost Allocation is that part of cost attribution which charges specific cost to a cost
centre or cost unit.
Cost Apportionment: Cost Apportionment is that part of cost attribution which shares costs among two
or more cost centres or cost units in proportion to the estimated benefit received.
Cost Audit: Cost Audit is the verification of correctness of cost accounts and check on the adherence
to the cost accounting plan. Its purpose is not only to ensure the arithmetical accuracy of cost records
but also to ensure that the principles and rules have been applied correctly.
Cost Centre: Cost Centre is a location, function or items of equipment in respect of which costs may be
ascertained and related to cost units for control purposes.
Cost Control: Cost Control is the process of regulating the action so as to keep the element of cost
within the set parameters.
Cost Driver: Cost Driver is the factor influencing the level of cost, often used in the context of ABC to
denote the factor which links activity resource consumption to produce outputs, for example, the
number of purchase orders would be a cost driver for procurement cost.
Cost Object: Cost Object is anything for which a separate measurement of cost is required. Cost object
may be a product, a service, a project, a customer, a brand category, an activity, a department or a
programme etc.
Cost Reduction: Cost Reduction is the achievement of real and permanent reduction in the unit cost
of goods manufactured or services rendered without impairing their suitability for the use intended or
diminution in the quality of the product.
Cost Unit: Cost Unit is a unit of product or service in relation to which costs are ascertained.
Cost: Cost is the amount of expenditure (actual or notional) incurred on or attributable to a specified
article, product or activity.
Financial Accounting: Financial Accounting is the organisation and presentation of a firm’s accounts
for information of the management as well as the various stakeholders.
Investment Centre: Investment Centre is a profit centre whose performance is measured by its return
on capital employed.
Profit Centre: Profit Centre is a part of business accountable for costs and revenues.
Revenue Centre: Revenue Centre is a responsibility centre which is accountable for generation of
revenue for the organisation.
Sunk Cost: Sunk Cost is the cost incurred in purchasing a capital asset. Depreciation is in the nature of
a recovery of sunk cost due to the past management decision.
7. Which of the following classification is meant for distinction between direct cost and indirect cost?
A. Function
B. Element
C. Variability
D. Controllability
E. None of the above
1. Differential Cost is the change in the cost due to change in activity from one level to another.
5. Profit is result of two varying factors sales sales and variable cost.
6. Cost Accounting is not required for a non−profit organisation such as medical hospital.
12. All store items such as lubricant oil, cotton waste etc. is regarded as direct material cost
[Ans: T, F, F, T, F, F, F, T, F, F, F, F ]
[Ans: (1) activity; (2) management; (3) cost; (4) sales, cost; (5) sunk;
(6) Cost Centre; (7) Sunk; (8) Notional.
[Ans: (1) - (E); (2) - (D); (3) - (A); (4) - (B); (5) - (C).
Material is a substance (Physics term) that forms part of or composed of a finished product. i.e material
refers to the commodities supplied to an undertaking for the purpose of consumption in the process
of manufacturing or of rendering service or for transformation into products. The term ‘Stores’ is often
used synonymously with materials, however, stores has a wider meaning and it covers not only raw
materials consumed or utilised in production but also such other items as sundry supplies, maintenance
stores, fabricated parts, components, tools, jigs, other items, consumables, lubricants......etc. Finished
and partly finished products are also often included under the term ‘Stores’. Materials are also known
as Inventory. The term Materials / Inventory covers not only raw materials but also components, work-
in-progress and finished goods and scrap also.
Material cost is the significant constituent of the total cost of any product. It constitutes 40% to 80% of
the total cost. The percentages may differ from industry to industry. But for manufacturing sector the
material costs are of greatest significance. Inventory also constitutes a vital element in the Working
Capital. So it is treated as equivalent to cash. Therefore the analysis and control on Material Cost is
very important.
Material
Control
Purchase Flow
The main functions of a purchase department are as follows :-
(a) What to purchase? – Right Material with good quality
(b) When to purchase? – Right Time
(c) Where to purchase? – Right Source
(d) How much to purchase? – Right Quantity
(e) At what price to purchase? – Right Price
To perform these functions effectively, the purchasing department follows the following procedure:-
(a) Receiving purchase requisitions
(b) Exploring the sources of supply and choosing the supplier
(c) Preparation and execution of purchase orders
(d) Receiving materials
(e) Inspecting and testing materials
(f) Checking and passing of bills for payment
Purchase Organisation
Purchasing involves procurement of materials of requisite quantity and quality at economic price. It
is of extreme importance particularly to a manufacturing concern because it has bearing on all vital
factors of manufacture such as quantity, quality, cost, efficiency, economy, prompt delivery, volume
of production and so on. Purchase department in a business concern can be organized into two types
i.e Centralised Purchasing System and De-centralised Purchasing System. Purchasing process in most
of the organisation is a centralised function because the advantages of a centralised purchasing out
weight its disadvantages. Lets us see the merits and demerits of both the systems.
(c) Effective control can be exercised over the stock of materials because duplication of purchase
of the same materials may easily be avoided in centralised purchase system, where as in
decentralised purchase system, duplication of purchase of same material cannot be avoided.
(d) Under centralised purchase system effective control can be exercised on the purchases of all the
materials as the purchase function is channelised through one track which would make the system
of receiving, checking and inspection efficient. Where as in decentralised purchase system it is
very difficult to exercise controls.
(e) Under centralised system of purchase materials, components and capital equipments can be
suitably standardised so that the maximum purchasing benefits be availed of, storage facilities can
be improved and available production facilities can be greatly utilised to the maximum possible
extent. Under decentralised purchase system standardization of materials, storage facilities.....etc
is very difficult to achieve.
(f) Under centralised system of purchase closer cooperation between the financial and purchasing
departments can be achieved which may not be easy under decentralised purchase system.
Bill of Material
Bill of Material is a complete schedule of parts and materials required for a particular order prepared
by the Drawing Office and issued by it together with necessary blue prints of drawings. For standard
products, printed copies of Bill of Material are kept with blank spaces for any special details of
modification to be filled in for a particular job/order. The schedule details everything, even to bolts and
nuts, sizes and weights. The document solves a number of useful purposes, such as:
(a) It provides a quantitative estimate of budget of material required for a given job, process or
operation which might be used for control purposes.
(b) It substitutes material requisitions and expedite issue of materials.
(c) The store-keeper can draw up a programme of material purchases and issue for a given period.
(d) It provides the basis for charging material cost to the respective job/process.
Modern Ltd
Bill of Materials
Symbol Description No. Description Code Qty. Date Reqn Order Date of Remarks
No. reqd. No. Reqd. no. No. delivery
Checked by:
Purchase Requisition
Purchases Requisition is a request made to the Purchase Department to procure materials of given
description and of the required quality and quantity within a specified period. It is a formal request
and it authorizes the Purchase Department to issue a Purchase Order to secure materials intended for
periodic requirements of a given material or materials to provide guidance to the Purchase Department
to estimate the future requirements in order to secure maximum purchase benefits in the form of higher
discount and better credit terms. The extent and range of materials requirements provide a basis for
preparation of a purchase budget. The actual requirements of a given period can be summarised
from the purchases requisition and compared with the purchase budget in order to determine the
variances and the reasons thereof. This form is prepared by storekeeper for regular items and by the
departmental head for special materials not stocked as regular items.
The Purchase Requisition is prepared in three copies. Original will be sent to Purchase department,
Duplicate copy will be retained by the indenting (request initiating) department and the triplicate will
be sent to approver for approving the purchase requisition.
Purchase Requisition provides the three basic things :-
(a) What type of material is to be purchased?
(b) When to be purchased?
(c) How much is to be purchased?
Modern Ltd
Purchase Requisition or Indent
Department :
Requested by Approved by
A number of factors should be considered before deciding from where the purchase should be made
viz. inquiry and call for tenders or quotations, analysis of tenders called, selection of the appropriate
source with appropriate fixation of price, quality, time of delivery, terms of payment, mode of delivery,
etc.
Purchase Order
Purchase Order (PO) is a request made in writing to selected supplier to deliver goods of requisite
quality, quantity, (as per the purchase requisition) at the prices, terms and conditions agreed upon. It is
a commitment on the part of the purchaser to accept the delivery of goods contained in the Purchase
Order if the terms included therein, are fulfilled. Purchase Order contains the following details :-
(a) Purchase Order No; (b) PO Date; (c) Supplier Name and Address; (d) Material Code; (e) Material
description; (f) Grade & Other particulars of the material; (g) Quantity to be supplied; h) Price; i) Place
of delivery; j) Taxes; k) Terms of Payment (Credit period) .....etc
Usually a purchase order is made in five copies, one each for suppliers, Receiving/Stores Department,
Originating Department, Accounts Department and filing. Thus we see that all the departments
concerned with the materials are informed fully about all the details of every purchases and it becomes
easier for everyone to follow up on any relevant matter.
Modern Ltd
Purchase Order
To PO No:
Supplier XXXXXX PO date:
Quotation
Reference:
Address PR No:
Please supply the following items in accordance with the instructions mentioned there in
on the following terms and conditions.
Material Rate per Delivery
S.No Material Code Quantity Amount Remarks
Description Unit Date
Packing &
Freight
Taxes
Total Amount
Delivery: Goods to be delivered at
Delivery date:
Payment Terms:
Authorised signatory
The specimen copy of the Goods Received cum Inspection Note as below:
Carrying Cost
EOQ
Cost
Ordering Cost
Quantity
Illustration 1
Calculate the Economic Order Quantity from the following information. Also state the number of orders
to be placed in a year.
Solution:
2×A×O
EOQ =
C
A = Units consumed during year = 10,000 Kg.
O = Order cost per order = `50
C = Inventory carrying cost per unit per annum 2 × 8% = ` 0.16
2 ×10,000 (units)× ` 50
EOQ =
` 0.16
Illustration 2
The average annual consumption of a material is 18,250 units at a price of ` 36.50 per unit. The storage
cost is 20% on an average inventory and the cost of placing an order is ` 50. How much quantity is to
be purchased at a time?
Solution:
2 ×18,250 (units)× ` 50
EOQ =
20% of ` 36.50
18,25,000
=
7.3
= 500 Units
Material Storage & Control
Once the material is received, it is the responsibility of the stores-in-charge, to ensure that material
movements in and out of stores are done only against the authorized documents. Stores-in-charge
is responsible for proper utilization of storage space & exercise better control over the material in
the stores to ensure that the material is well protected against all losses such as theft, pilferage, fire,
misappropriation ...etc.
Duties of store keeper
The duties of store-keeper are as follows :-
(a) To exercise general control over all activities in stores department
(b) To ensure safe storage of the materials
(c) To maintain proper records
(d) To initiate purchase requisitions for the replacement of stock of all regular materials, whenever the
stock level of any item in the store reaches the Minimum Level
(e) To initiate the action for stoppage of further purchasing when the stock level approaches the
Maximum Level
(f) To issue materials only in required quantities against authorized requisition documents
(g) To check and receive purchased materials forwarded by the receiving department and to
arrange for storage in appropriate places
Centralised stores
The usual practice in most of the concerns is to have a central store. Separate store to meet the
requirements of each production department are not popular because of the heavy expenditure
involved. In case of centralised stores materials are received by and issued from one stores department.
All materials are kept at one central store. The advantages and disadvantages of this type of store are
set out as follows:
While fixing the level, the following factors are to be taken into consideration:
(a) Maximum requirement of the store for production purpose, at any point of time
(b) Rate of consumption and lead time
(c) Nature and properties of the Store: For instance, the maximum level is necessarily kept low for
materials that are liable to quick deterioration or obsolescence during storage.
(d) Storage facilities that can be conveniently spared for the item without determinant to the
requirements of other items of stores.
(e) Cost of storage and insurance
(f) Economy in prices: For seasonal supplies purchased in bulk during the season, the maximum level
is generally high.
(g) Financial considerations: Availability of funds and the price of the stores are to be kept in view. For
costly items, the maximum level should be as low as possible. Another point to be considered is
the future market trend. If prices are likely to rise, the concern may like to stock-piling for keeping
large stock in reserve for long-term future uses and in such a case, the level is pushed up.
(h) Rules framed by the government for import or procurement. If due to these and other causes
materials are difficult to obtain and supplies are irregular the maximum level should be high.
(i) The maximum level is also dependent on the economic ordering quantity.
Maximum Level = Re-Order Level + Re-Order Qty – (Minimum Rate of Consumption × Minimum Re-
Order Period)
Minimum Level
The Minimum Level indicates the lowest quantitative balance of an item of material which must be
maintained at all times so that there is no stoppage of production due to the material being not
available. In fixing the minimum level, the following factors are to be considered :-
(a) Nature of the item: For special material purchased against customer’s specific orders, no minimum
level is necessary. This applies to other levels also.
(b) The minimum time (normal re-order period) required replenishing supply: This is known as the Lead
Time and are defined as the anticipated time lag between the dates of issuing orders and the
receipt of materials. Longer the lead time, lower is minimum level, the re-order point remaining
constant.
(c) Rate of consumption (normal, minimum or maximum) of the material.
Minimum Level = Re-Order level – (Normal Rate of Consumption × Normal Re-Order Period)
Re-Order Level
When the stock in hand reach the ordering or re-ordering level, store keeper has to initiate the action
for replenish the material. This level is fixed somewhere between the maximum and minimum levels
in such a manner that the difference of quantity of the material between the Re-ordering Level and
Minimum Level will be sufficient to meet the requirements of production up to the time the fresh supply
of material is received.
The basic factors which are taken into consideration in fixing a Re-ordering Level for a store item
include minimum quantity of item to be kept, rate of consumption and lead time which are applied
for computing of this level.
Re-Ordering level = Minimum Level + Consumption during lead time
= Minimum Level + (Normal Rate of Consumption × Normal Re-order Period)
Danger Level
It is the level at which normal issue of raw materials are stopped and only emergency issues are only
made. This is a level fixed usually below the Minimum Level. When the stock reaches this level very
urgent action for purchases is indicated. This presupposed that the minimum level contains a cushion
to cover such contingencies. The normal lead time cannot be afforded at this stage. It is necessary to
resort to unorthodox hasty purchase procedure resulting in higher purchase cost.
The practice in some firms is to fix danger level below the Re-Ordering Level but above the Minimum
Level. In such case, if action for purchase of an item was taken when the stock reached the Re-Ordering
Level, the Danger Level is of no significance except that a check with the purchases department may
be made as soon as the Danger Level is reached to ensure that everything is all right and that delivery
will be made on the scheduled date.
Danger Level = Normal Rate of Consumption × Maximum Reorder Period for emergency purchases
Illustration 3
The components A and B are used as follows:
Normal usage .... 300 units per week each
Maximum usage .... 450 units per week each
Minimum usage .... 150 units per week each
Reorder Quantity .... A 2,400 units; B 3,600 units.
Reorder period .... A 4 to 6 weeks, B 2 to 4 weeks.
Calculate for each component:
(a) Re-order Level (b) Minimum Level (c) Maximum Level (d) Average Stock Level.
Solution:
Particulars A B
a) Reorder Level 2700 units 1800 units
[Max. Consumption × Max. Re-order (450 × 6) (450 × 4)
Period]
b) Minimum Level
[ROL – (Normal Consumption × Normal 1200 units 900 units
Re-order period)] [2700 – (300×5)] [1800 – (300×3)]
c) Maximum Level
[ROL + ROQ – (Min. Consumption × Min. 4500 units 5100 units
Re-order Period)] [2700 + 2400 – (150×4)] [1800 + 3600 – (150 × 2)]
d) Average Stock Level 2850 units 3000 units
[Min. Level + Max. Level] / 2 [4500 + 1200]/2 [5100 + 900]/2
OR (or) (or)
[Min. Level + ½ Re-order Quantity] 2400 units 2700 units
1200 + ½ (2400) 900 + ½ (3600)
Stores Records
The bin cards and the stores ledger are the two important stores records that are generally kept for
making a record of various items.
Bin Card
Bin Card is a quantitative record of receipts, issues and closing balance of items of stores. Separate
bin cards are maintained for each item and are placed in shelves or bins. This card is debited with the
quantity of stores received, credited with the quantity of stores issued and the balance of quantity of
store is taken after every receipt or issue. The balance quantity of the item may be easily known at any
time. To have an up to date balance of stores, the principle of ‘before touching the item, bin card
should be touched’. For each item of stores, Material Code, Minimum Quantity, Maximum Quantity,
Ordering Quantity, Balance Quantities are stated on the bin card. Bin card is also known as ‘Bintag’ or
‘Stock card’.
Stores Ledger
Stores Ledger is maintained by the costing department to make record of all receipts, issues of materials
with quantities, values (Sometimes unit rates also). Ledger resembles with bin cards except that receipts,
issues and balances are shown along with their money value. The ledger contains an account for every
item of stores in which receipts, issues and balances are recorded both in quantity and value.
Receipts Issues Balance
Date
GR No Qty Rate Amount SR No Qty Rate Amount Qty Rate Amount
(e) As the work is carried out systematically and without undue haste the figures are readily available.
(f) Actual stock can be compared with the authorised maximum and minimum levels, thus keeping
the stocks within the prescribed limits. The disadvantages of excess stocks are avoided and
capitalised up in stores materials cannot exceed the budget.
(g) The recorder level of various items of stores are readily available thus facilitating the work of
procurement of stores.
(h) For monthly or quarterly financial statements like Profit and Loss Account and Balance Sheet
the stock figures are readily available and it is not necessary to have physical verification of the
balances.
ABC Analysis
The “ABC Analysis” is an analytical method of stock control which aims at concentrating efforts on
those items where attention is needed most. It is based on the concept that a small number of the
items in inventory may typically represent the bulk money value of the total materials used in production
process, while a relatively large number of items may present a small portion of the money value of
stores used resulting in a small number of items be subjected to greater degree of continuous control.
Under this system, the materials stocked may be classified into a number of categories according to
their importance, i.e., their value and frequency of replenishment during a period. The first category
(we may call it group ‘A’ items) may consist of only a small percentage of total items handled but
combined value may be a large portion of the total stock value. The second category, naming it as
group ‘B’ items, may be relatively less important. In the third category, consisting of group ‘C’ items,
all the remaining items of stock may be included which are quite large in number but their value is not
high.
Category No. of Items % of the Total Value % of the Total Average Value
No. of Items Amount (`) Value Item Amount (`)
A 75 6 70,000 70 933
B 375 30 20,000 20 53
C 800 64 10,000 10 12
1250 100 1,00,000 100 998
Category ‘A’ items represent 70% of the total investment but as little as only 6% of the number of items.
Maximum control must be exercised on these items. Category ‘B’ is of secondary importance and
normal control procedures may be followed. Category ‘C’ comprising of 64% in quantity but only 10%
in value, needs a simpler, less elaborate and economic system of control.
The advantages of ABC analysis are:
(a) Closer and stricter control of those items which represent a major portion of total stock value is
maintained.
(b) Investment in inventory can be regulated and funds can be utilised in the best possible manner.
‘A’ class items are ordered as and when need arises, so that the working capital can be utilised in
a best possible way.
(c) With greater control over the inventories, savings in material cost will be realised.
(d) It helps in maintaining enough safety stock for ‘C’ category of items.
(e) Scientific and selective control helps in the maintenance of high stock turnover ratio.
VED Analysis
VED stands for Vital, Essential and Desirable- analysis is used primarily for control of spare parts. The
spare parts can be classified in to three categories i.e Vital, Essential and Desirable- keeping in view
the criticality to production.
Vital: The spares, stock-out of which even for a short time will stop the production for quite some time,
and where in the stock-out cost is very high are known as Vital spares. For a car Assembly Company,
Engine is a vital part, without the engine the assembly activity will not be started.
Essential: The spares or material absence of which cannot be tolerated for more than few hours or a
day and the cost of lost production is high and which is essential for production to continue are known
as Essential items. For a car assembly company ‘Tyres’ is an essential item, without fixing the tyres the
assembly of car will not be completed.
Desirable: The Desirable spares are those parts which are needed, but their absence for even a week
or more also will not lead to stoppage of production. For example, CD player, for a car assembly
company.
Some spares though small in value, may be vital for production, requires constant attention. Such
spares may not pay attention if the organization adopts ABC analysis.
FSN Analysis
FSN analysis is the process of classifying the materials based on their movement from inventory for a
specified period. All the items are classified in to F-Fast moving, S- Slow moving and N-Non-moving
Items based on consumption and average stay in the inventory. Higher the stay of item in the inventory,
the slower would be the movement of the material. This analysis helps the store keeper / purchase
department to keep the fast moving items always available & take necessary steps to dispose off the
non-moving inventory.
Just-in-Time
Just in time (JIT) is a production strategy that strives to improve a business return on investment by
reducing in-process inventory and associated carrying costs. Inventory is seen as incurring costs, or
waste, instead of adding and storing value, contrary to traditional accounting. In short, the Just-in-Time
inventory system focuses on “the right material, at the right time, at the right place, and in the exact
amount” without the safety net of inventory.
The advantages of Just-in-Time system are as follows :-
(a) Increased emphasis on supplier relationships. A company without inventory does not want a
supply system problem that creates a part shortage. This makes supplier relationships extremely
important.
(b) Supplies come in at regular intervals throughout the production day. Supply is synchronized with
production demand and the optimal amount of inventory is on hand at any time. When parts
move directly from the truck to the point of assembly, the need for storage facilities is reduced.
(c) Reduces the working capital requirements, as very little inventory is maintained.
(d) Minimizes storage space.
(e) Reduces the chance of inventory obsolescence or damage.
Illustration 4
Compute the Inventory turnover ratio from the following:
Opening Stock - ` 10,000
Closing Stock - ` 16,000
Material Consumed - ` 78,000
Solution :
Value of material consumed during the period
Inventory Turnover Ratio =
Value of average stock held during the period
(g) The material cost of normal scrap / defectives which are rejects shall be included in the material
cost of goods manufactured. The material cost of actual scrap / defectives, not exceeding the
normal shall be adjusted in the material cost of good production. Material cost of abnormal
scrap/ defectives should not be included in material cost but treated as loss after giving credit to
the realisable value of such scrap / defetives.
Materials issued from stores should be priced at the price at which they are carried in inventory.
Material may be purchased from different suppliers at different prices in different situations, where as
consumption may happen the entire inventory at a time or at different lots....etc. So issue of materials
should be valued after considering the following factors:-
(a) Nature of business and production process.
(b) Management policy relating to the closing stock valuation.
(c) Frequency of purchases and price fluctuations.
Several methods of pricing of material issues have been evolved; these may be classified into the
following:-
Cost Price Method
(a) First in First out
(b) Last-in-first out
(c) Base Stock Method
Specific price method
(a) Average Price Method
(b) Simple Average Price Method
(c) Weighted Average Price Method
(d) Moving Simple Average Method
(e) Moving Weighted Average Method
Disadvantages
(a) If the prices fluctuate frequently, this method may lead to clerical errors.
(b) In case of rising prices this method is not advisable.
(c) The material costs charged to same job are likely to show different rates.
(2) Last-in-First Out Method
Under this method the prices of last received batch (lot) are used for pricing the issues, until it is
exhausted and so on. During the inflationary period or period of rising prices, the use of LIFO would
help to ensure the cost of production determined approximately on the above basis is approximately
the current one. Under LIFO stocks would be valued at old prices, but not represent the current prices.
Advantages
(a) The cost of materials issued will be either nearer to and/or will reflect the current market price.
(b) In case of falling prices profit tends to rise due to lower material cost
Disadvantages
(a) The computations become complicated if too many receipts are there.
(b) Companies having JIT system will face this problem more.
(3) Base Stock Method
A minimum quantity of stock under this method is always held at a fixed price as reserve in the stock, to
meet a state of emergency, if arises. This minimum stock is known as Base Stock and is valued at a price
at which the first lot of materials is received and remains unaffected by subsequent price fluctuations.
The quantity in excess of the base stock may be valued either on the LIFO basis or FIFO basis. This
method is not an independent method as it uses FIFO or LIFO. Its advantages and disadvantages
therefore will depend upon the use of the other method.
(4) Specific Price Method
This method is useful, especially when the materials are purchased for a specific job or work order, and
as such these materials are issued subsequently to that specific job or work order at the price at which
they were purchased. The cost of materials issued for production purposes to specific jobs represent
actual and correct costs. This method is specific for non-standard products. This method is difficult to
operate, especially when purchases and issues are numerous.
Under this method materials issued are valued at average price, which is computed by dividing the
total of all units rate by the number of units.
Material Issue Price = Total of unit prices of each purchase / Total No of Units
This method is useful, when the materials are received in uniform lots of similar quantity and prices do
not fluctuate considerably.
This method removes the limitation of Simple Average Method in that it also takes into account the
quantities which are used as weights in order to find the issue price. This method uses total cost of
material available for issue divided by the quantity available for issue.
Issue Price = Total Cost of Materials in stock / Total Quantity of Materials in stock
Illustration 5
Prepare a statement showing the pricing of issues, on the basis of
(a) Simple Average and
(b) Weighted Average methods from the following information pertaining to Material-D
2016 March 1 Purchased 100 units @ `10 each
2 Purchased 200 units @ ` 10.2 each.
5 Issued 250 units to Job X vide M.R.No.12
7 Purchased 200 units @ `10.50 each
10 Purchased 300 units @ `10.80 each
13 Issued 200 units to Job Y vide M.R.No.15
18 Issued 200 units to Job Z vide M.R.No.17
20 Purchased 100 units @ `11 each
25 Issued 150 units to Job K vide M.R.No.25
Solution:
(a) Simple Average Method:
Stores Ledger Account
Working Notes:
1. Calculation of Price for Issue on March 5th
= (10 + 10.2) / 2 = `10.10
2. Calculation of Price for Issue on March 13th
= (10.2 + 10.5 + 10.8) / 3 = `10.5
3. Calculation of Price for Issue on March 18th
= (10.5 + 10.8) / 2 = `10.65
4. Calculation of Price for Issue on March 25th
= (10.8 + 11) / 2 = `10.90
Working Notes:
1. Calculation of price for Issue on March 5th
= 3040/300 = `10.13
Illustration 6
The stock of material held on 1-4-2015 was 400 units @ 50 per unit. The following receipts and issues were
recorded. You are required to prepare the Stores Ledger Account, showing how the values of issues
would be calculated under Base Stock Method, both through FIFO AND LIFO base being 100 units.
2-4-2015 Purchased 100 units @`55 per unit
6-4-2015 Issued 400 units
10-4-2015 Purchased 600 units @ `55 per unit
13-4-2015 Issued 400 units
20-4-2015 Purchased 500 units @ `65 per unit.
25-4-2015 Issued 600 units
10-5-2015 Purchased 800 units @ `70 per unit
12-5-2015 Issued 500 units
13-5-2015 Issued 200 units
15-5-2015 Purchased 500 units @ `75 per unit
12-6-2015 Issued 400 units
15-6-2015 Purchased 300 units @ ` 80 per unit
Solution:
Stores Ledger Account [under Base Stock through FIFO Method]
or job, the total cost of the process, etc., is distributed over the reduced output, i.e., the units of good
production only. The cost of abnormal waste, should, however, be excluded from the total cost and
charged to the Profit and Loss Account.
The actual waste is observed against standards and periodically reported to the management.
4. Scrap
This is also in the form of incidental material residue coming out of certain types of manufacturing
processes but it is usually in small amounts and has low measurable utility or market value, recoverable
without further processing. Numerous examples of scrap may be given; scrap may arise in the form of
turnings, borings, trimmings, fillings, shavings etc., from metals on which machine operations are carried
out; saw dust and trimmings in the timber industry; dead heads and bottom ends in foundries; and
cuttings, pieces, and split in leather industries. Scrap should always be physically available unlike waste
which may or may not be present in the form of a residue.
Accounting treatment of scrap is as follows:
(a) Sales Credited to Revenue
In this method, the scrap is not cost and its value does not, therefore, appear separately in the Cost
Accounts. Only a quantitative record of the scrap returned to storeroom from the shops is maintained
and the sale value realised from time to time is credited to the Profit and Loss Account as miscellaneous
revenue.
(b) Credit to Overhead
In this method and in the following method the scrap is assigned a cost. The cost is usually the sale
value of the scrap less selling and distribution costs. If the scrap has no ready market but has only utility
or use value, and is taken as a credit to manufacturing overhead. The effect of this credit is to reduce
the overhead recovery rate. When predetermined overhead rates are in use, it is more expedient to
credit an estimated allowance for the scrap instead of the amount of actual scrap.
(c) Credit to Jobs
The scrap is assigned a cost and is traced to the job which yielded the scrap. This affords a reasonable
amount of credit to the jobs and widely different.
(d) Transfer to Other Jobs
Scrap arising in one job may be issued for utilization in another job. Such transfers of scrap from one job
to another should be affected through Material Transfer Notes. Alternatively, scrap may be returned to
store room and subsequently issued to another job for utilization. The latter method is more appropriate
when some further processing is required on the scrap before it can be utilised for other jobs.
Control of Scrap
Scrap is also an unavoidable residue material arising in the process of manufacture. The basic difference
between scrap and waste is that while waste may not have any value, scrap must necessarily have
a value, though a comparatively small one. Scrap may be sold or re-used in some process. In some
industries, arising of scraps of various types in significant quantities is a regular feature and in such
cases, it would be worth while having a proper administrative set-up for control of scrap. A Scrap
Survey Committee may be constituted which would be responsible for such matters as (1) classifying
the various types of scrap; (2) Assessing the quantum of each; and (3) Deciding upon the manner of
their use or disposal.
Control of scrap should start from the designing stage of the products. At the designing stage, the
type, shape and form of materials which all result in the minimum of waste or the least quantity of scrap
in manufacturing process are decided. The quantity of scrap resulting from a process also depends
upon the manufacturing equipment used and the efficiency of the operative who performs the work.
In order to minimise scrap, production should be planned so that the best possible equipment is used
and properly trained personnel are employed on the job.
5. Spoilage
Definition: When production does not come up to the standard specifications or quality it has to be
rejected outright. The components or materials are so damaged in the manufacturing process that
they cannot be brought back to the normal specifications by repairs or reconditioning. Some spoiled
work may be sold as seconds but in most cases, the entire production is sold for small value in the form
of scrap or treated as waste if it has no market value. Spoilage involves not only loss of materials but
also of labour and manufacturing overhead incurred up to the stage when the spoilage incurred.
Illustration 8
From this information provided as under, you are required to prepare a statement showing how the
issues would be priced if LIFO method is followed.
Solution:
Stores Ledger Account [LIFO Method]
Illustration 9
Prepare Stores Ledger Account showing pricing of material issues on Replacement Price basis from the
following particulars.
15-3-2016 Issued 300 units to Job XY vide M.R.No.14 17-3-2016 Received 200 units at `4.30 each
26-3-2016 Issued 200 units to Job JK vide M.R.No.27 27-3-2016 Received 100 units @`4.60 each.
20-3-2016 `4.40
30-3-2016 `4.80.
Solution:
Stores Ledger Account [Replacement Price Basis]
Illustration 10
Stocks are issued at a standard price and the following transactions occurred for a specific material:
Solution:
(240 × 10) + 20
Standard Price =
10
= ` 242
Stores Ledger Account
Illustration 11
Receipts and issues of an item of stores are made as follows: There was no balance before 9th
January.
Receipts Issues
Quantity Price (`) Quantity
January 9th 10 17.0
19th 25 10.0
20th 10
29th 20
30th 15 8.0
February 13th 20 12.0
27th 10 16.9
28th 40
March 30th 20 20.0
31st 20
(ii) What are the moving monthly simple average price for January -February and February-March?
(iii) If a weighted average is used for pricing issues how does the value of the balance in stock change
during January?
(iv) If a weighted average price is calculated at the end of each month and is then used for pricing
the issued of that month, what will be the value of the month-end balance?
Solution:
(iii) Stores Ledger Account (under weighted average method for January)
Illustration 12
Two components A and B are used as follows:
Normal usage = 50 per week each
Re-order quantity = A- 300; B-500
Maximum usage = 75 per week each
Minimum usage = 25 per week each
Re-order period: A - 4 to 6 weeks; B - 2 to 4 weeks
Calculate for each component
(a) Re-order level; (b) Minimum level; (c) Maximum level; (d) Average stock level.
Solution:
Particulars A B
a) Reorder Level 450 units 300 units
[Max. Consumption × Max. Re-order Period] (75 x 6) (75 x 4)
b) Minimum Level
[ROL – (Normal Consumption x Normal Re-order 200 units 150 units
period)] [450 – (50x5)] [300 – (50x3)]
c) Maximum Level
[ROL + ROQ – (Min. Consumption x Min Re-order 650 units 750 units
period)] [450 + 300 – (25x4)] [300 + 500 – (25 x 2)]
d) Average Stock Level 425 units 450 units
[Min. Level + Max. Level] / 2 [200 + 650] / 2 (or) [150 + 750] / 2 (or)
or or or
[Min. Level + ½ × ROQ] 350 units 400 units
200 + ½ (300) 150 + ½ (500)
Illustration 13
Anil company buys its annual requirement of 36,000 units in six installments. Each unit costs `1 and the
ordering cost is `25. The inventory carrying cost is estimated at 20% of unit value. Find the total annual
cost of the existing inventory policy. How much money can be saved by using E.O.Q?
Solution:
2.A.O
EOQ =
C
2 × 36,000 × 25
=
1 × 20%
18,00,000
=
0.2
= 3,000 units
Statement Showing computation of comparative inventory cost of existing policy and proposed EOQ
policy:
Illustration 14
The annual demand for an item is 3,200 units. The units cost is `6 and inventory carrying charges is 25%
p.a. If the cost of one procurement is `150, determine:
(a) E.O.Q (b) No. of orders per year (c) Time between two consecutive orders.
Solution:
2.A.O
(a) EOQ =
C
2 × 3,200 × 150
=
6 × 25%
9,60,000
=
1.5
= 800 units
(b) No. of orders per year = A / EOQ = 3200 / 800 = 4 orders (A = Annual demand)
(c) Time between two consecutive orders = No. of months in years / No. of orders
= 12/4 = 3 Months
Illustration 15
A company manufactures a special product which requires a component ‘Alpha’. The following
particulars are collected for the year 2015.
Required:
(a) Compute the economic order quantity.
(b) Advise whether the quantity discount offer can be accepted.
Solution:
(a) Calculation of Economic Order Quantity
2AO
EOQ =
C
2 × 8,000 × 200
EOQ =
400 × 20%
= 200 units
Advise:
The total cost of inventory is lower if EOQ is adopted. Hence, the company is advised not to accept
the quantity discount.
Illustration 16
From the following particulars with respect to a particular item of materials of a manufacturing
company, calculate the best quantity to order:
The annual demand for the material is 4,000 tonnes. Stock holding costs are 20% of material cost p.a.
The delivery cost per order is `6.00
Solution:
Statement showing computation of total inventory cost at different order sizes (Annual Demand = 4000
tonnes)
Ordering Quantities
Particulars 200 250 800 2000 4000
(i) Purchasing cost 24000 23600 23200 22800 22400
(4000×6) (4000×5.9) (4000×5.8) (4000×5.7) (4000×5.6)
(ii) No. of orders 20 16 5 2 1
(iii) Ordering Cost (` 6) 120 96 30 12 6
(iv) Average size of order 100 125 400 1000 2000
(v) Inventory Carrying cost per unit 1.2 1.18 1.16 1.14 1.12
(6x20%) (5.9x20%) (5.8x20%) (5.7x20%) (5.6x20%)
(vi) Inventory carrying cost (iv x v) 120 147.5 464 1140 2240
(vii) Total Inventory Cost (iii + i + vi) 24240 23843.5 23694 23952 24646
For the above computations the best quantity to order is 800 units.
Illustration 17
The particulars relating to 1,200 kgs. of a certain raw material purchased by a company during June,
were as follows:-
Lot prices quoted by supplier and accepted by the Company for placing the purchase order :
Lot upto 1,000 kgs. @ `22 per kg.
Between 1,000 - 1,500 kgs, @ `20 per kg.
Between 1500 -2000 kgs. @ `18 per kg.
Trade discount – 20%.
Additional charge for containers @ `10 per drum of 25 kgs.
Credit allowed on return of containers, @ `8 per drum.
GST at 12% on raw material and 5% on drums.
Total fright paid by the purchaser `240/-
Insurance at 2.5% (on net invoice value) paid by the purchaser.
Stores overhead applied at 5% on total purchase cost of material.
The entire quantity was received and issued to production.
The containers are returned in due course. Draw up a suitable statement to show :-
(a) Total cost of material purchased and
(b) Unit cost of material issued to production.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of total cost of material purchased and unit cost of material issued for
production. Amount (`)
Illustration 18
From the following data for the year ended 31st Dec, 2016, calculate the inventory turnover ratio of the
two items, and put forward your comments on them.
Material A Material B
Amount (`) Amount (`)
Opening stock on 1-1-2016 10,000 9,000
Purchase during the year 2016 52,000 27,000
Closing on 31-12-2016 6,000 11,000
Solution:
Cost of Material used
Material Inventory Turnover Ratio = Av erage Stock
10,000 + 52,000 − 6,000
For A =
(10,000 + 6,000)/ 2
= 7 times
= 25,000 / 10,000
= 2.5 times
Material Inventory turnover ratio indicates the efficiency of the management with which they are able
to utilize their inventory. It indicates the existence or non-existence of non moving items, dormant items,
slow moving items etc. in inventory. If the ratio is high, the efficiency is said to be high and on the other
hand if the ratio is low, the efficiency is said to be low.
In view of above, in the instant case, we may say that Material A used better than Material B.
Illustration 19
From the details given below, calculate:
(i) Re-ordering level
(ii) Maximum level
(iii) Minimum level
(iv) Danger level
2 × 5,000 × 20
EOQ =
5
= 200 units
Illustration 20
M/s Tubes Ltd. are the manufacturers of picture tubes for T.V. The following are the details of their
operation during the year 2015:
5,200 units
5,200 units x ` 475 + ×` 100 + (1,500 units × 20% ×` 475 ) ÷ 2
1,500 units
= ` 24,70,000 + ` 346.67 + ` 71,250
= ` 25,41,596.67
Total cost (when order size is 102 units)
5,200 units
= 5,200 units × ` 500 + ×` 100 + (102 units × 20% ×` 500 ) ÷ 2
102 units
= ` 26,00,000 + ` 5,098.03 + ` 5,100 = ` 26,10,198.03
Since the total cost under quarterly supply of 1,500 units with 5% discount is lower than that when order
size is 102 units, the offer should be accepted. While accepting this offer capital blocked on order size
of 1,500 unit per quarter has been ignored.
Re-order Level:
= Maximum Consumption × Maximum Re-order Period
= 200 units × 8 weeks = 1,600 units.
GLOSSARY
ABC Analysis: A B C Analysis is the analysis of a range of items, e.g. stock levels, customers, etc. into
three groups, viz. A = most important, B = important, C = less important.
Bin Card: Bin Card is a prime entry record of the quantity of stocks, kept on in/out/balance, held in
designated storage areas.
Danger Level: Danger Level is the level where only emergency materials are issued and normal issue
of materials is stopped.
Danger Level = Normal Rate of Consumption × Maximum Re−order period for emergency purchases.
Defectives: Defectives are the goods that can be rectified and turned out as good units by using
additional labour or other services.
Direct Material Cost: Direct Material Cost is the cost of materials entering into and becoming constituent
elements of a product or saleable service and which can be identified separately in product costs.
First in First Out (FIFO): FIFO is a method of pricing material issues using the oldest purchase price first.
Goods Received Note: Goods Received Note is a document prepared by the Goods Receiving
Department that unpacks the goods received and verify the quantities and other details.
Indirect Material Cost: Indirect Material Costs are the materials costs which are not charged directly to
a product, e.g. cotton waste, cleaning materials, etc.
Just−in−Time (JIT) Inventory System: Just−in−Time (JIT) Inventory System is a system in which materials
are purchased when it is actually needed for production purpose. It is a Japanese philosophy which
is used for managing all types of inventory, purchase and production functions in an organisation.
The main purpose of this philosophy is to reduce inefficiency and unproductive time and cost in the
production process.
Last in First Out (LIFO): LIFO is a method of pricing material issues using the last purchase price first.
Material Control: Material Control is the systematic control on procurement, storage and usage of
materials with a view to maintaining even flow of materials and avoiding at the same time the excessive
investment in inventories.
Material Return Note: Material Return Note is a document accompanied with the goods returned from
the factory back to the stores.
Material Requisition Note: Material Requisition Note is a document used to authorise and record the
issue of materials from the store.
Material Transfer Note: Material Transfer Note is a document prepared when the material is transferred
from one department to another.
Maximum Level: Maximum Level is the maximum limit up to which the stock can be stored at any time.
Maximum Level = Re−order Level (ROL) + Re−order quantity (ROQ)− (Minimum Rate of Consumption ×
Minimum Re−order Period)
Minimum Level: Minimum Level is the minimum quantity that must be retained in stock.
Minimum Level = Re−order Level (ROL) − (Normal rate of Consumption × Normal Re−order Period)
Purchase Order: Purchase Order is a request in writing to the supplier to supply certain specified
materials at the specified rates and within a specified period.
Purchase Requisition: Purchase Requisition is a document prepared by the store keeper to initiate the
process of purchase by the purchasing department.
Re−order Level: Re−order Level is the quantity of materials fixed in advance at which level the stock
should be re−ordered.
Re−order Level = Minimum Level + Consumption During Lead Time
= Minimum Level + (Normal Rate of Consumption × Normal Re−order Period)
Or
Re−order Level = Maximum Rate of Consumption × Maximum Re−order Period (Lead Time)
Scrap: Scrap is the discarded material which has some recovery value and which is usually either
disposed of without further treatment or reintroduced into the production process in place of raw
material.
Simple Average Price: Simple Average Price is the average price of issuing materials which is computed
by dividing the total of all units rate by the number of units.
Simple Average Issue Price = Total of unit prices of each purchase ÷ Total number of units
Spoilage: Spoilage is the goods damaged beyond rectification to be sold without further processing.
Stores Ledger: Stores Ledger is a ledger containing a separate account for each item of material and
component stored giving details of the receipts, issues and balance both in terms of quantity and
value.
Vital, Essential and Desirable (VED) Analysis: VED analysis is an inventory analysis in which inventories
are classified on the basis of its criticality for the production function and final product.
Wastage: Wastage is the portion of basic raw material lost in processing having no recoverable value.
Weighted Average Price: Weighted Average Price is a method of pricing material issues using a price
calculated by dividing the total cost of material in stock by the total quantity in stock.
Weighted Average Issue Price = Total Cost of Materials in Stock ÷ Total Quantity of Materials in Stock
1. What is the prime objective of material control? It is said that in any system of material control
there are always two counteracting or opposing factors. What are these and why do these factors
arise?
2. What are the principal forms generally required to be used in connection with purchasing and
receiving of stores? Briefly describe them and design any one of the forms that are used.
3. Explain the meaning and importance of material control and mention the main requisites of an
adequate system of material control.
4. What is a purchase order? To whom should the copies of a purchase order be sent and why? Give
a specimen form of purchase order, assuming the particulars to be filled in.
5. Enumerate the advantages and disadvantages of a centralised stores system.
6. What is Re-ordering Level? Explain its relationships with Maximum and Minimum Stock Levels.
What are the factors to be considered in fixing Re-ordering Level and Quantity? Under what
circumstances would you recommend revision of levels?
7. What is Bin Card? Give a specimen form of the Bin Card and discuss its utility.
8. “The Perpetual Inventory System is an Integral part of material control”. Discuss this statement by
bringing out briefly the salient features and the advantages of this system.
9. What is Economic Order Quantity? How is it calculated?
10. What are the main factors which you would consider before selecting a method of pricing material
issues?
11. What is meant by Bill of Materials? When will you recommend drawal of stores under Bill of Materials
as opposed to individual requisition?
12. What are the stores that normally come under “Packing Materials”? What are the major
classifications of packing expenses and how they are treated in cost?
13. How would you deal with the following in Cost Accounts?
(a) Packing cost
(b) Cost of Tools
14. Write short notes on the following:
(a) ABC analysis.
(b) VED analysis.
(c) Treatment of Scrap in costing.
(d) Valuation of work in progress.
(e) Moving Average Price Method of material issue valuation.
(f) Just in time
(g) Bin Card vs. Stores Ledger
(h) Principles of valuation of receipt of material as per CAS – 6.
(i) Re−order level
76 THE INSTITUTE OF COST ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
Cost Ascertainment - Elements of Cost
PRACTICE PROBLEMS
18. Your factory buys and used a component for production at ` 10 per piece. Annual requirement
is 2,000 numbers. Carrying cost of inventory is 10% p.a. and ordering cost is ` 40 per order. The
purchase manager argues that as the ordering cost is very high, it is advantageous to place a single
order for the entire annual requirement. He also says that if we order 2,000 pieces at a time we can
get a 3% discount from the supplier. Evaluate this proposal and makes your recommendations.
Ans: Proposal of the purchase manager not acceptable because it increases cost by ` 10; buy 400
units (i.e., EOQ) at a time is not economical.
19. P Ltd. uses three types of materials A, B and C for production of ‘X’, the final product. The relevant
monthly date for the components are as given below:
A B C
Normal usage (in units) 200 150 180
Minimum usage (in units 100 100 90
Maximum usage (in units) 300 250 270
Re-order Quantity (in units) 750 900 720
Re-order period (in months) 2 to 3 3 to 4 2 to 3
Ans:
The purchases and issues of material X in the month of January 2015, is as follows:
The standard price per unit of material is ` 20 fixed for the year 2015. Show the Stores Ledger entries
and determine the price variance for the month of January.
(Ans: Value of Stock on January 31, 2015 ` 9,100; Price Variance ` 1,100 Un-favourable)
20. XYZ company buys in lots of 500 boxes which is a 3 month supply. The cost per box is `125 and the
ordering cost is `150. The inventory carrying cost is estimated at 20% of unit value.
How much money could be saved by employing the economic order quantity? (Ans: Saving by
adopting EOQ = ` 2,977)
Calculate EOQ, Reorder level and total annual inventory cost. How much does the total inventory
cost vary if the unit price is changed to `5 ?
(Ans: Variation in Inventory Cost = 42,201)
22. A cast iron foundry is importing forged steel moulds for making its castings. The moulds are of four
different sizes A,B,C and D and their CIF values are US $4,140; 4,160; 6,340, and 7,875 respectively.
Customs duty may be assumed at 45% and clearing charges 5% of CIF value. The number of
castings that can be made out of each mould it:
The weight of each casting out of A is 300 kg. B - 400 kg. C - 500 kg and D - 700 Kg. The casting
suffer a normal rejection of 10%. You are required to calculate the average cost of mould per
tonne of saleable casting.
(Ans: Cost per tonne of saleable castings = A = ` 184; B = ` 69.33; C = ` 93.93; D = ` 100
23. G Ltd. produces a product which has a monthly demand of 4,000 units. The product required a
component X which is purchased at ` 20. For every finished product, one unit of component is
required. The ordering cost is ` 120 per order and the holding cost is 10% p.a.
If the minimum lot size to be supplied is 4,000 units. What is the extra cost, the company has to
incur?
3. Direct material is a –
A. Adiministration Cost B. Selling and Distribution cost C. All of these D. None of these
8. In which of following methods of pricing, costs lag behind the current economic values?
A. Replacement price method B. Last−in−first out price method
C. First−in−first out price method D. Weighted average price method
E. None of the above
9. In which of the following methods, issues of materials are priced at pre−determined rate?
A. Replacement price method B. Inflated price method
C. Specific price method D. Standard price method
E. None of the above
10. Which of the following methods smoothes out the effect of fluctuations when material prices
fluctuate widely?
A. FIFO B. Simple Average C. LIFO D. Weighted average E. None of the above
11. Under the FSN system of inventory control, inventory is classified based on:
A. Value of items of inventory B. Criticality of the item of inventory for production
C. Frequency of items of inventory use D. Volume of material consumption
E. None of the above
12. Materials are issued from one process to another, based on:
A. Bill of Materials B. Material Requisition Note C. Purchase Requisition Note
D. Material Transfer Note E. None of the above
[Ans: C, A, D, C, C, C, D, C, D, D, C, D]
[Ans: (1) - (B); (2) - (A); (3) - (E); (4) - (C); (5) - (D).
Labour is an important element of cost and for overall cost control and cost reduction, Labour Cost
is of paramount importance. Labour Cost is also called as Employee Cost. However, for control and
reduction of Labour Cost, it is essential to compute the Labour Cost in a scientific manner and hence
there should be proper systems and processes and documentation, which will help computation of
Labour Cost in a scientific manner. It should be remembered that Labour is not like material as there is
a human aspect involved in it. Therefore, there should be a comprehensive study of all related aspects
of Labour Cost and then only computation and control over the same will be possible. Attention should
also be paid to the productivity aspect. Low productivity results in higher Labour Cost per unit while
higher productivity will reduce the Labour Cost per unit. All these aspects of Labour Cost are discussed
in detail in this chapter. Study of Labour or Employee Cost can better be explained as follows:
Labour
Control
1. Labour Turnover
2. Idle Time
3. Overtime
4. Payment by results
As per CAS-7, (limited Revision - 2017) Employee cost is the benefits paid or payable in all forms of
consideration given for the service rendered by employee (including temporary, part time and contract
employee) of an entity.
Various aspects of Labour Cost Control
In the modern competitive environment, it is essential to make efforts for controlling and reducing the
Labour Cost. Systematic efforts are required in order to achieve this target. The following steps will be
useful in controlling and reducing the Labour Cost.
A. Classification of Labour cost
The first step in the direction of controlling and reducing the Labour Cost is proper classification of the
same. The Labour Cost is classified into Direct Cost and Indirect Cost. Direct Labour Cost is the cost that
can be identified with a product unit. It can also be described as cost of all Labour incurred for altering
the construction, composition or condition of the product. Indirect Labour Cost is the cost, which cannot
be identified with a product unit. It represents the amount of wages which is paid to the workers who
are not directly engaged on the production but it includes wages paid to the workers and assistants
working in departments like purchasing, store keeping, time office, maintenance, and other service and
production departments. In other words, indirect wages are the wages paid to the workers who facilitate
the production rather than actually engaged in production. The Direct Labour Cost can be charged
directly to the job or product units and is included in the prime cost. Indirect Labour Cost is included in
the overhead cost. Direct Labour Cost is variable in nature and can be controlled by strictly adhering to
the norms and standards set by the management. Indirect Labour Cost can be controlled by establishing
Labour budgets and comparing the actual Indirect Labour Cost with the budgeted Labour Cost. Any
difference between the two is analysed carefully and suitable corrective action is taken.
B. Production Planning
Effective control over the Labour Cost Can be achieved through proper production planning. Production
planning includes activities like planning, scheduling, routing, machine loading, product and process
engineering, work study etc. With the help of work study, time and motion study can be conducted
which will help in fixation of standard time for a particular job. A comparison between the standard
time and actual time is constantly made to find out the difference between the two. Suitable corrective
action can be taken if it is noted that the actual time taken is constantly more than the standard time
allowed for the job.
C. Labour Budget
Budget and budgetary control are effective tools for cost control and cost reduction. A Labour budget
can be prepared which will set the target for the Labour Cost which will again facilitate comparison
between the Budgeted Labour Cost and the Actual Labour Cost.
D. Labour Standards
Standards can be set for Labour Cost against which the Actual Labour Cost can be compared.
Standard Labour Cost is the cost, which should have been incurred for producing a particular quantity
of production. While fixing the Standard Labour Cost, use of time and motion study is made to fix up the
standard time that should be taken for the actual production.
E. Labour Performance Report
There should be a system of periodic Labour efficiency and utilisation reports. These reports will give an
idea about the efficiency and productivity of the Labour.
F. Incentive Schemes
Improving the Labour productivity is one of the important ways to reduce the Labour Cost per unit.
Productivity can be improved by motivating the workers. Offering monetary and non monetary incentives
can help to improve the productivity substantially. However, there should be a periodic review of the
incentive schemes and therefore incentive schemes report should be prepared at periodic intervals.
G. Labour Cost Accounting
There should be a proper cost accounting system, which will identify the Direct and Indirect Labour
Cost. Similarly the cost accounting department should be able to generate and maintain records for
time keeping, time booking, idle and overtime, impact of incentive schemes, per unit of Labour, cost
due to Labour Turnover and other relevant records.
Thus from the above mentioned points, it will be clear that there is a need to control the Labour Cost
and it can be done by the combined efforts of various departments.
the board of directors or executive committee. It normally maintain detailed records of attendance,
leave records, overtime and shift records from which various calculations of wages, allowances,
overtime, incentives are made. Reports concerning labour turnover, recruitment, productivity, utilization,
absenteeism as well as reports on labour cost, idle time, various cost ratios etc., are prepared here for
submission to higher authorities for necessary action.
(b) Engineering, Industrial Engineering Department
This department helps to maintain control over working conditions, production methods, job performances
by preparing plans and specification for each job scheduled for production, maintaining safety and
efficient working conditions, initiating and supervising research and development activities, making
method study, motion study, and time study, setting piece-rates, making job evaluation, merit rating
and job analysis, measuring labour productivity and in general suggesting ways and means to improve
labour efficiency/productivity thereby cutting down the effective labour cost.
(c) Time Keeping Department
The function of this department is mainly to keep, maintain the time for which each and every worker
has worked including the check-in and check-out time. The records are kept separately for different
shift and irregular working periods like overtime period. The records are such kept that the departments
wise/product wise/process wise/ batch wise/job wise/operation wise allocation of labour cost is possible.
The entire correctness of calculation of payroll, overtime payments, incentive payments, overhead
allocation depend on the records maintained by this department and as such the importance of the
functions rendered by this department cannot be over emphasised.
(d) Payroll Department
This departments is responsible for preparation of payroll and also basically to maintain records of job
classification, department wage rates to prepare each man’s earnings, to allocate those earnings to
various cost centres to summarise various deductions and employers’ share of provident fund, state
insurance and other items, and also to summarise overtime payments and incentive payments wherever
applicable.
(e) Cost-Accounting Department
This department is responsible for the accumulation and compilation of all cost data relating to the
element Labour. It analyses the payroll cost to effectively render routine and special labour, cost reports
thereby disclosing the amount of normal, and abnormal idle time, direct labour, indirect labour, overtime
and departmental labour costs and variances between actual and standard labour costs. These reports
are used by the top management to effectively control the labour cost and also to improve the labour
productivity/efficiency.
Important factors for the control of Employee Cost
The factors which need consideration for the purpose of controlling employee cost effectively are as
follows:
(a) Assessment of manpower requirements
(b) Control over time−keeping and time−booking
(c) Time & Motion Study
(d) Control over idle time and overtime
(e) Control over employee turnover
(f) Wage and Incentive systems
(g) Job Evaluation and Merit Rating
(h) Employee productivity
(2) Disc Method: This is one of the older methods of recording time. A disc, which bears the identification
number of each worker, is given to each one. When the worker comes in, he picks up his disc from
the tray kept near the gate of the factory and drops in the box or hooks it on a board against his
number. Same procedure is followed at the time of leaving the factory. The box is removed at starting
time, and the time keeper becomes aware of late arrivals by requiring the workers concerned to
report him before starting. The time keeper will record in an Attendance Register any late arrivals
and workers leaving early. He will also enter about the absentees in the register on daily basis. The
main limitation of this method is that there is a possibility of marking the attendance of a worker by
his friend i.e. by a proxy. Secondly if the number of workers is large, there will be a delay in recording
time due to manual operation of this system.
(3) Time Recording Clocks or Clock Cards: This is mechanized method of time recording. Each worker
punches the card given to him when he comes in and goes out. The time and date is automatically
recorded in the card. Each week a new card is prepared and given to the worker so that weekly
calculation of wages will be possible. If wages are paid on monthly basis, a new card may be
given in each month. Due to advancement of technology, giving a new card each month is
also not required as the same card continued till the worker either leaves the service or retires
from the service. The only limitation of this method, [in fact it is the limitation of all the methods of
time keeping] is that though the time in and time out are recorded, the records do not show the
productive time of the worker, i.e. how he has spent the time in the factory. Thus if a worker comes
in at 8 am and leaves at 5 pm, he has spent 9 hours in the company, which can be ascertained
from the time keeping records. However, how he has spent time, is not shown by these records.
For showing the productive time, separate records showing time booking are to be prepared. The
time booking records can also be combined with time keeping records so that there is no need to
keep dual records.
(4) Bio−metric Attendance System: According to Bio−metric attendance system, attendance of the
employees is marked by recognising an employee based on physical and behavioural traits. An
employee’s unique identity like finger print, face and retina image etc. are kept in a database which
is matched at the time of marking of attendance before the attendance device for this purpose.
Bio−metric attendance system includes finger print recognition system, face recognition system, Time
and attendance tracking technology etc. This system reduces the risk of time manipulation and
proxy attendance. However, it may not be possible for small organisations due to cost associated
with set−up and maintenance of this system.
(i) System of time−keeping should be such as not to allow proxy for another employee under any
circumstances.
(ii) There should be a provision of recording of time of piece employees so that regular attendance
and discipline can be maintained.
(iii) Time of arrival as well as time of departure of employees should be recorded so that total time of
employees can be recorded and wages can be calculated accordingly.
(iv) Method of recording of time should be mechanical as far as possible so that chances of disputes
regarding time may not arise between employees and the time−keeper.
(v) Late−comers should record late arrivals. The time−keeper should adhere to this discipline strictly.
(vi) The system should be simple, smooth and quick. Unnecessary queuing for marking attendance
should be avoided.
(vii) The system should be reviewed periodically to prevent any error or loophole.
Time Booking
In time keeping we have seen that the basic objective of time keeping is to mark the attendance time,
i.e. time in and time out. Time keeping aims at keeping a check on the number of hours spent by a
worker in the factory. However, it does not record the productive time of the workers. It means the time
keeping methods do not provide information about how the time is spent by the workers in the factory.
For example, the time keeping record will show that the worker has reported for duty at 8 am and left
at 6 pm, thus, he has spent 10 hours in the company. But the analysis of these 10 hours is not provided
by the time keeping. In view of this there is a need to have a system, which will tell about the productive
time spent by the workers in the factory. The method, which supplies this information, is known as ‘Time
Booking Methods’ and the recording the time spent by a worker in each job, process or operation is
known as ‘Time Booking’. The objects of time booking are as follows:-
(i) To determine the productive time spent by the worker on the job or operation. This helps in finding
out the idle time and controls the same
(ii) To determine the quantity and value of work done
(iii) To determine earnings like wages and bonus
(iv) To determine the efficiency of workers
Time Booking Methods
The following methods are used for time booking:-
(1) Daily Time Sheet: In this method, each worker records the time spent by him on the work during the
day, for which a sheet is provided to each worker. The time is recorded daily and hence accuracy
is maintained. However, the main limitation of this method is lot of paper work is involved as daily
sheets are maintained on daily basis by each worker.
(2) Weekly Time Sheets: The only difference between the daily time sheet and weekly time sheet is
that these time sheets are maintained on weekly basis. This means that each worker prepares these
sheets weekly rather than daily. This helps in reducing the paper work to a great extent.
The only care to be taken is that since the information is filled up on daily basis, there may be
inaccuracies and hence filling the information should be done on daily basis only.
(3) Job Ticket: Job tickets are given to all workers where time for commencing the job is recorded as
well as the time when the job is completed. The job tickets are given for each job and the recording
of the time as mentioned above helps to ascertain the time taken for each job. After completing
one job, the worker is given another job.
(4) Labour Cost Card: This card is meant for a job, which involves several operations or stages of
completion. Instead of giving one card to each worker, only one card is passed on to all workers
and time taken on the job is recorded by each one of them. This card shows the aggregate labour
cost of the job or the product.
(5) Time and Job Card: This card is a combined record, which shows both, the time taken for completion
of the job as well as the attendance time. Therefore there is no need to keep separate record of
both, time taken and attendance time.
Thus we may distinguish time keeping and time booking, that the time keeping is simply maintaining
attendance of the workers i.e the time of arrival and the time of departure and there by the time spent
by the worker in the organization is measured, where as time booking is not only maintaining the time
spent by the workers in the organization, but also the time spent on each & every job including the idle
time with reasons are recorded.
Work Study
In order to motivate workers, it is necessary to design a proper incentive system of payment of wages.
Money is the strongest motivating factor and hence monetary incentive system become essential. In
any incentive system, the bonus is paid by comparing the standard performance/production with the
actual performance, i.e. actual production. Bonus is paid if the actual performance is higher than the
standard one. However, for deciding the standard performance, standard time, i.e. time that is allowed
doing a particular job should be fixed against which the actual time taken should be compared. The
Work Study which includes, the Job Study, and the Method Study ensures the fixation of standard time to
do a particular job and thus has become extremely important in the designing of the incentive system.
Work Study components are discussed below.
Method Study
Method Study is done to improve the methods of production and to achieve the most efficient use of
the resources like, manpower, machines and materials. Method Study has the following stages:-
(a) Method Study is generally conducted for the jobs, which involve complex operations as well as
costly operations. Hence the first step is to select jobs, which are having complexity of operations.
(b) There should be a detailed study of related aspect of the selected job. Information about the job
like, purpose, location, sequence, relationship with other work, methods of working, operators,
requirement of skilled workers, facilities required etc. should be collected.
(c) The crucial step is that after studying the relevant aspects of the job, there should be development
of the improved method of doing the job. An improved method of job might change the location
and sequence of the work, methods of production and the layout for the job. The improved method
will result in more efficiency, more simplicity and effectiveness and job will be done in a better
manner.
(d) The developed method should be applied in doing the job.
(e) For any new method, a follow up is always required. For method study also a constant follow up is
necessary to ensure that the method selected is implemented properly. Thus method study ensures
efficient use of resources by reducing unnecessary work and helps to achieve highest production.
Work Measurement
The Work Measurement aims at determining the effective time required to perform a job. The ineffective,
wasteful or avoidable time is separated from required time to complete the work. The effective time so
established in work measurement can be used for the following purposes:-
(a) Incentive wage schemes which require data about the time allowed and time taken for a particular
job
(b) Improving utilization of men, machines and materials
(c) Assisting in production control
(d) Assisting in setting labour standards
(e) Cost control and reduction
Job Evaluation
It is necessary for the management of any organization to establish proper wage and salary structure for
various jobs. For doing this in a scientific manner, it is necessary to determine the relative value of jobs
and hence a job evaluation is done. Job Evaluation is a technique of analysis and assessment of jobs
to determine their relative value within the firm. It aims at providing a rational and equitable basis for
differential salaries and wages for different classes of workers. Job Evaluation has the following objectives:-
(a) It helps in developing a systematic and rational wage structure as well as job structure.
(b) Job Evaluation aims at removing the controversies and disputes relating to salary between the
employers and employees. Thus the employees and also the employer remain satisfied.
(c) Another important objective of Job Evaluation is to bring fairness and stability in the wage and
salary structure so as to ensure full cooperation of workers in implementing various policies of the
employers.
(d) Job Evaluation discloses characteristics and conditions relating to different jobs. This is very useful at
the time of recruiting of workers as only suitable workers can be recruited. This avoids square pegs
in round holes.
Methods of Job Evaluation
Methods of job evaluation are as follows:-
(1) Point Ranking Method: In this method each job is analyzed in terms of various job factors or
characteristics. The characteristics are skills required, efforts involved, working conditions, hazards,
responsibility and so on. In other words the job factors are the requirements needed for performing the
job effectively. Each job factor is given weightage or points depending upon its value for the job. For
example, for certain jobs, maximum value is assigned to experience while for some jobs, education
may be the most crucial factor. Finally each job is ranked in the order of points or weights secured by
them. The wage structure can be suitably designed according to the points assigned to each job. The
method is quite sound in principle but difficulties may be faced assigning the weights to each job.
(2) Ranking Method: In this method, jobs are ranked in order of importance on the basis of skills required,
experience requirements, working conditions etc. Jobs are rearranged in an order, which can be either
from the lowest to the highest or in the reverse. Wage scales are determined in terms of ranks. Though
this method is quite simple to operate and less costly as well as easy for understanding, it is suitable when
the size of the organization is small and jobs are few and well defined. In a large organization, where
jobs are quite complex, this method is not beneficial.
(3) Grading Method: This method is an improvement over the ranking method. Under this method,
each job is analyzed in terms of a predetermined grade and then assigned a grade or class. Grades
are established after making an investigation of job factors, such as complexity in the job, supervision,
responsibility, education etc.
Merit Rating
Job Evaluation is the rating of the job in order to bring rationality in the wage and salary structure in the
organization. On the other hand Merit Rating is the comparative evaluation and analysis of individual
merits of the employees. The Merit Rating aims at evaluation and ranking the individual employees
in order to plan and implement rational promotional policies in the organization. Merit Rating has the
following objectives:-
(a) To evaluate the merit of an employee for the purpose of promotion, increment, reward and other
benefits
(b) To establish and develop a wage system and incentive scheme
(c) To determine the suitability of an employee for a particular job
(d) To analyze the merits or limitations of a worker and help him to develop his capability and
competence for a job
(e) To examine characteristics like cooperation, quality of work done, attendance and regularity,
education, skill, experience, character and integrity and initiative
Thus it can be understood that Merit Rating is extremely useful for organizations for evaluating the
employees. However the main limitations are that the rating can be subjective which will give rise to
the disputes and there is a possibility that past performance of an employee may be given too much
importance.
Payroll Department
Roll of Payroll Department is of crucial importance in overall Labour Cost computation and control. The
main responsibilities of this department are preparation of payroll from clock cards, job or time tickets,
or time sheet. The payroll shows the amount of wages payable to each worker showing the gross wages
payable, the deductions and the net wages payable. For doing this calculation, they have to work in
collaboration with the time office, personnel department, Cost Accounting department and with the
concerned department in which the worker is working. The functions of this department are given below:-
(a) To compute the wages of the employees
(b) To prepare a detailed wages sheet showing the gross wages payable, various deductions and
other payroll liabilities
(c) To maintain individual employee payroll records
(d) To prepare department wise summaries of wages
(e) Compilation of Labour statistics for management
(f) To install and implement an effective internal check system for preventing frauds and irregularities
in payment of wages
(g) To detect and prevent ghost workers
Payroll Procedure
Following activities and the responsibility to discharge such activities are mentioned hereunder:
Activity Responsibility
(i) Attendance and time details (i) Time−keeping department
(ii) Preparation of list of employees and (ii) Personnel/HR department
other details
(iii) Computation of wages and other incentives (iii) Payroll department
(iv) Payment to employees (iv) Cost/Accounting department
(v) Discharge of statutory liabilities (v) Cost/Accounting department
Idle Time
Idle Time Cost represents the wages paid for the time lost during which the worker does not work, i.e
time for which wages are paid, but no work is done. As per CAS-7 (Limited Revision 2017), Idle Time is
‘The difference between the time for which the employees are paid/payable to employees and the
employees time booked against the cost object’. This happens because due to various causes for which
he is not responsible, the worker remains idle but full wages are paid to him. Even for workers who are
paid on the basis of output, idle time payment may be required to be made.
The causes leading to idle time may be broadly classified into four categories, viz. :-
(i) Normal, inherent or unavoidable idle time: Time lost between the gate and place of work, break
for tea, time interval between one job and another, time for tool setting, adjustment of machine,
etc.
(ii) Normal idle time such as waits for jobs, tools, materials or instructions, small power failures, small
breakdown of machines and tools, and atmospheric conditions
(iii) Abnormal idle time such as those arising due to breakdown for considerable period, non-availability
of raw materials, slack supervision, strikes or lock-outs, fire flood, storm, etc.
(iv) Concealed idle time such as manipulation of job breaking, wastage of time due to under-
employment, i.e., unnecessary work like cleaning, grass cutting and gardening to employ idle men,
and employment of skilled workers on unskilled jobs
Idle time should not be booked directly to jobs or production orders because such a practice not only
increases the cost of direct labour, but also vitiates comparison of idle time costs from time to time. In
booking of time, idle or waiting time should not normally record in the job card but on separate idle
time cards. Separate cards or registers may be provided for recording idle time according to the causes
which give rise to it.
B. Piece Rate
(a) Straight Piece Rate
C. Bonus Systems
(a) Individual Bonus for Direct Workers
(b) Group Bonus for Direct Workers and
(c) Bonus for Indirect Workers
E. Non monetary incentives like job security, social and general welfare, sports, medical facilities etc.
These methods are discussed in the following paragraphs:-
(b) Productivity can be increased substantially if the rate of pay includes a really adequate incentive.
(c) Higher productivity will result in lowering the cost per unit.
However, the main limitation of this method is that if a worker is not able to work efficiently due to reasons
beyond his control, he will be penalized in the form of lower wages.
Differential Piece Rates
Under these methods, the rate per standard hour of production is increased as the output level rises.
The increase in rates may be proportionate to the increase in output or proportionately more or less
than that as may be decided. In other words, a worker is paid higher wages for higher productivity as
an incentive. The rate per unit will be higher in this case as compared to the rate paid to a worker with
lower productivity. For deciding the efficiency, comparison is made between the standard production
and actual production of the worker. If the actual production is more, the worker qualifies for higher rate
of wages. The Differential Piece Rate methods will be useful when the production is of repetitive type,
methods of production are standardized and the output can be identified with individual workers. The
following are the major systems of differential piece rate system:-
(i) Taylor (ii) Merrick (iii) Gantt Task and Bonus
Taylor’s Differential Piece Rate System
Taylor is regarded as father of scientific management and he has recommended a system of Differential
Piece Rate. According to him, there are only two classes of workers, efficient and inefficient. He suggests
that while efficient workers should be encouraged to the maximum possible extent, the inefficient workers
should be penalized. In order to do this, he has suggested two rates for the two classes of workers. Thus
according to Taylor, if the workers are efficient, they should be paid @ 120% of the normal piece rate
and if they are inefficient, they should be paid @ 80% of the normal piece rate. For measuring efficiency,
each worker will be given a standard production quantity to be produced in the time allowed and
the actual production should be compared with the same. If a worker exceeds the standard, he will
be regarded as efficient while if he fails to do so, he will be regarded as inefficient. The positive and
negative points of this system are as follows:-
Merits:-
(a) There is a very strong incentive to the workers, which helps to achieve higher productivity.
(b) Due to the incentive, best workers are attracted to the company.
(c) This method is quite simple and hence easy to understand.
Limitations:
(a) Slow workers and beginners are penalized severely. Similarly workers get penalized for reasons
beyond their control, e.g. medical reasons, accidents etc. Therefore it is said that there is no human
element in this system.
(b) In an anxiety to produce more, quality may be neglected in order to achieve higher quantity of
production.
Illustration 1
From the following particulars, calculate the earnings of workers X and Y and also comment on the
labour cost.
Standard time allowed: 20 units per hour
Normal time rate: `30 per hour
Differential Rate to be applied:
80% of piece rate when below standard
limitation is that the method is complicated to understand by the workers and hence may create
confusion amongst them.
Illustration 2
X, Y and Z are three workers working in a manufacturing company and their output during a particular
40 hours week was 96, 111 and 126 units respectively. The guaranteed rate per hour is `10 per hour, low
piece rate is `4 per unit, and high piece rate is `6 per unit. High task is 100 units per week. Compute the
total earnings and labour cost per unit under Taylor, Merrick and Gantt Task Bonus Plan.
Solution:
(a) Taylor Plan:
High task is 100 units
Worker X = Actual output is 96 units, which is less than the standard. This means he is inefficient
and will get 80% of the normal piece rate i.e. @ `4.80 per unit. His wages will be = `4.80 ×96 units =
`460.80.
Worker Y = Actual output is 111 units which is more than the standard. This means he is efficient
and will get 120% of the normal piece rate i.e. `7.20 per unit. His wages will be = `7.20 × 111 units =
`799.20
Worker Z = Actual output is 126 units, more than the standard. This means his wages will be = `7.20
×126 units = `907.20.
(b) Merrick Plan:
Worker X = High task is 100 units, actual output is 96, this means that the efficiency level is 96%. As
per Merrick Plan, wages of X will be 110% of normal piece rate which is `6.60 per unit = `6.60 × 96
units = `633.6
Worker Y = High task is 100 units, actual output is 111 units, efficiency level is 111%. Y will be entitled
for wages @ 120% of normal piece rate i.e. @ `7.20 per unit. His wages will be, `7.20 × 111 units =
`799.2
Worker Z = High task is 100 units, actual output is 126 units, efficiency level is 126%. Z will get at higher
piece rate @ `7.20 per unit. His wages will be `7.20 × 126 units = `907.2
(c) Gantt Task and Bonus Plan:
Worker X = `10 × 40 hours = `400 [X will get guaranteed time rate as his output is below the high
task]
Worker Y = `6 × 111 units = `666 [High piece rate as output is above standard]
Worker Z = `6 × `126 units = `756 [High piece rate as output is above standard]
(iii) above 100% efficiency level, bonus of 20% of basic wages + 1% for each 1% increase in efficiency
is admissible
Emerson’s Efficiency System is superior to other differential piece rate as it encourages the slow worker
to do better than before. It does not pre−suppose a high degree of average performance. The wages
are guaranteed on time basis.
Points Scheme−Bedaux System
Under this system the quantum of work that can be performed by a worker is expressed in Bedaux
Points or B’s. These points represent the standard time expressed in terms of minutes that are necessary
to perform a job. The standard numbers of points in terms of minutes are determined after analysing
each operation or job in detail. Each such minute consists of the time required to complete a fraction
of the operation or the job and also an allowance for rest due to fatigue. The workers who are not able
to complete the tasks allotted to them within the standard time are paid only the normal daily rate of
wages. Those workers who are able to increase their efficiency rate which is equal to the wages for
time saved as indicated by excess of B’s earned (i.e. standard time for work done − over actual time)
are paid 75% of the time saved.
Illustration 3
Time allowed for a job is 48 hours; a worker takes 40 hours to complete the job. Time rate per hour is `15.
Compute the total earnings of the worker.
Solution:
Total Earnings = H X R + 50% [S – H] R
Total Earnings = 40 X `15 + 50% [48 – 40] `15
Total Earnings = `600 + `60 = `660
payable if actual production does not exceed the standard production. This method is mainly used
in foundries.
(iv) Towne Profit Sharing Plan: In this method standards are set for costs [mainly labour cost] and the
actual cost is compared with the standards. If there is a saving in the costs, the saving is shared by
workers and supervisory staff in agreed proportion. The principle behind this method is that if there
is a saving in the cost, not only the workers but the supervisory staff should also get the reward
because the cost reduction is the joint efforts of both the types of staff. Hence both, workers and
supervisors share it.
(v) Waste Reduction Bonus: This system of bonus is based on savings in the material cost. If there is
a saving in the material cost, the workers share the same in the agreed proportion. This system is
generally used in industries where cost of material is very high.
(vi) Rucker Plan: The amount of bonus is linked with ‘value added’ in this system. The ‘value added’
is obtained by deducting the cost of material and services from sales value. In other words, value
added is the total of labour, overheads and profits. Under this plan, employees receive a constant
proportion of value added. For example, if the target ratio of labour cost to value added is 70%, and
the actual ratio comes to 68%, 2% of the actual value added is distributed as group bonus, so that
the ratio of direct labour cost to value added is maintained at 70%. Normally instead of distributing
the entire bonus, some proportion is distributed and the remaining is transferred to reserve fund.
(vii) Scanlon Plan: This method is similar to the Rucker plan as discussed above except that the ratio
of labour cost to the sales is taken instead of direct labour cost to added value. Normally bonus is
paid based on average of last three years ratios. A part of the bonus may be transferred to bonus
equalization fund for future use when the workers do not get bonus under this scheme.
Bonus System for Indirect Workers
Indirect workers do not take part in the production process directly but they play important role in the
production process. It is difficult to chalk out a bonus system for indirect workers, as there is a difficulty
in measuring their output. However it is advisable to plan a bonus system for indirect workers in order
to motivate them for better productivity. Bonus to indirect workers is paid on the basis of output of the
department, saving in time or expenditure against the budgeted, product quality, reduction of waste
and scrap and reduction of labour turnover.
Indirect Monetary Incentives
These methods aim at giving additional remuneration based on the prosperity of the concern. The
following schemes fall in this category:-
(a) Profit Sharing: In this system, the profits of the organization are shared by workers in agreed proportion.
The Payment of Bonus Act 1965 in India makes it mandatory to pay minimum bonus of 8.33% of
salary and maximum bonus of 20% of salary to the workers.
(b) Co-partnership: In this system, the workers get an opportunity to participate in the ownership of
the organization and to receive the part of share of profits. The employees are given assistance to
purchase shares of the company. Thus the employees get dividend and bonus also. These schemes
help to boost the morale of workers to a great extent.
Non-Monetary Incentives
These incentives are given in addition to monetary incentives for further boosting the moral of the
employees. Though these benefits do not result in additional remuneration, they help to improve
productivity by boosting the morale of the employees.
Some of the non-monetary incentives are as follows:-
(a) Free education and training
(b) Medical benefits
(d) Flux Method: Under this method Labour Turnover is computed by taking into consideration the
additions as well as separations. The turnover can also be computed by taking replacements and
separations also. Computation is done as per the following methods.
Labour Turnover = ½ [Number of additions + Number of separations] /Average number of workers
during the period ×100
Labour Turnover = ½ [Number of replacements + Number of separations] /Average number of
workers during the period × 100
Cost of Labour Turnover
Increasing Labour Turnover is a double edged malady. It reduces the productivity of labour and resulting
in high costs. The cost of Labour Turnover may be analyzed under two broad headings, Preventive Cost
and Replacement Costs. Preventive Costs refer to all those items of expenditure which are incurred in
order to keep the workers satisfied and thus to act as discouragement against leaving employment.
Replacement Costs are those costs which are incurred for the recruitment and training of new hands
and the resulting losses, wastages and lowering of productivity due to the inexperience and inefficiency
of the new labour force.
Illustration 4
During October 2015, the following information is obtained from the Personnel Department of a
manufacturing company. Labour force at the beginning of the month 1900 and at the end of the month
2100. During the month, 25 people left while 40 persons were discharged. 280 workers were engaged
out of which only 30 were appointed in the vacancy created by the number of workers separated and
the rest on account of expansion scheme. Calculate the Labour Turnover by different methods.
Solution:
Computation of Labour Turnover
Additions Method:
Number of Additions/Number of average workers during the period = 280 / 2000 X 100 = 14%
Separation Method:
Number of Separations/Number of average workers during the period = (25+40)/2000 × 100 = 3.25%
Replacement Method:
Number of Replacements / Number of average workers during the period = 30/2000 X 100 = 1.5%
Flux Method:
½ [Number of Additions + Number of Separations] / Number of average workers during the period
= [½(280 + 65) / 2000]×100 = 173/2000 X 100 = 8.63%
Note: Average number of workers in all the above methods is computed by taking Opening number of
workers + Closing number of workers / 2 = 1900 + 2100/2 =2000
Illustration 5
The management of XYZ Ltd. is worried about the increasing Labour Turnover in the factory and before
analyzing the causes and taking remedial steps; they want to have an idea of the profit foregone as a
result of Labour Turnover during the last year. Last year’s sales amounted to `83, 03,300 and the profit/
volume ratio was 20%. The total number of actual hours worked by the direct Labour force was 4.45
lakhs. As a result of the delays by the Personnel department in filling vacancies due to Labour Turnover,
1,00,000 potentially productive hours were lost. The Actual Direct Labour hours included 30, 000 hours
attributable to training new recruits, out of which, half of the hours were unproductive. The cost incurred
consequent on Labour turnover revealed, on analysis the following. Settlement cost due to leaving: `43,
820 & Recruitment costs: `26,740. Selection costs: `12,750, & Training costs: `30,490
Assuming that the potential production lost as a consequence of Labour Turnover could have been
sold at prevailing prices, find the profit foregone last year on account of Labour Turnover.
Solution:
We will have to calculate the profit foregone by calculating the amount of contribution lost and the
additional cost that was incurred as a result of the Labour Turnover. This is done in the following manner.
I. Actual productive hours: Actual hours worked – Unproductive training hours
= 4,45,000 – 15,000 [50% of 30, 000]
= 4,30,000 actual productive hours.
Illustration 6
Calculate the total earnings and effective rate of earnings per hour of three operators under Rowan
System and Halsey System from the following particulars.
The standard time fixed for producing 1 dozen articles is 50 hours. The rate of wages is `1/- per hour.
The actual time taken by three are as follows:-
A 45 hours
B 40 hours
C 30 hours.
Solution:
Computation of Total Earnings of workers under Halsey Plan
Earnings under Halsey Plan = Hours worked × Rate per hour + (50% × Time saved × Rate per hour)
Worker Earnings Effective Rate
A E = (45 x 1) + 50/100 (50-45) x 1 Effective Rate = 47.5/45
= 47.5 = 1.06
B E = (40 x 1) + 50/100 (50-40) x 1 Effective Rate = 45/40
= 45 = 1.125
C E = (30 x 1) + 50/100 (50-30) x 1 Effective Rate = 40/30
= 40 = 1.33
Time saved
Hours worked × Rate per hour + ( × Hours worked × Rate per hour)
Time allowed
Earnings Effective Rate
A E = (45 x 1) + [50-45 / 50] 45 x 1 Effective Rate = 49.5/45
= 45 + 4.5 = 1.1
= 49.5
B E = (40 x 1) + [50-40 / 50] 40 x 1 Effective Rate = 48/40
= 40 + 8 = 1.2
= 48
C E = (30 x 1) + [50-30 / 50] 30 x 1 Effective Rate = 42/30
= 30 + 12 = 1.4
= 42
Illustration 7
A workman takes 9 hours to complete a job on daily wages and 6 hours on a scheme of payment by
results. His hourly rate is 25 p. The Material cost of the product is `4 and factory overheads are recovered
at 150% of the total direct wages. Calculate the factory cost of the product under following methods:-
(a) Time rate system (b) Halsey Plan (c) Rowan Plan.
Solution:
Computation of factory cost under three systems: Amount (`)
Illustration 8
A worker under the Halsey method of remuneration has a day rate of `12 per week of 48 hours, plus
a cost of living bonus of 10 p. per hour worked. He is given 8 hours task to perform, which he performs
in 6 hours, he is allowed 30% of the time saved as premium bonus. What would be his earnings under
Halsey Plan and Rowan Plan.
Solution:
Computation of earnings of worker under Halsey Plan:
Earnings under Halsey Plan = Hours worked × Rate per hour + (30% × Time Saved × Rate per hour)
= (6 x 0.25) + 30/100 (8-6) x 0.25 = 1.65
(+) Cost of Living Bonus (6 x 0.1) = 0.60
Earnings under Halsey Plan = `2.25
Time saved
Hours worked × Rate per hour + ( × Hours worked × Rate per hour)
Time allowed
= (6 × 0.25) + (8-6 / 8) × 6 × 0.25 = 1.88
(+) Cost of Living Bonus (6 × 0.1) = 0.60
= `2.48
Earnings under Halsey Plan = ` 2.25
Earnings under Rowan Plan = ` 2.48
Illustration 9
In a factory guaranteed wages at the rate of ` 1.80 per hour are paid in a 48 hour week. By time and
motion study it is estimated that to manufacture one unit of a particular product 20 minutes are taken,
the time allowed is increased by 25% . During the week A produced 180 units of the product. Calculate
his wages under the following methods:
(a) Time Rate
(b) Piece Rate with a guaranteed weekly wage
(c) Halsey premium Bonus
(d) Rowan Premium Bonus
Solution:
(a) Calculation of wages under Time Rate System
Earnings under time wages = TR
= 48 × 1.8 = ` 86.4
(b) Calculation of wages under Piece Rate with a Guaranteed Wage Rate
Normal Time for one unit = 20 minutes
(+) Relaxation allowance @ 25% = 5 minutes
Standard Time = 25 minutes
Illustration 11
The following particulars apply to a particular job:
Standard production per hour - 6 units
Normal rate per hour - ` 1.20
Mohan produced 32 units
Ram produces 42 units
Prasad produces 50 units
Calculate the wages of these workers under Merrick Differential Piece Rate System.
Solution:
Calculation of wages of workers under Merrick Differential Piece Rate System
Normal Piece rate = 1.2 / 6 = 0.20
Standard Production = 6 x 8 (assumed hrs) = 48 units
Mohan’s efficiency = 32/48 x 100 = 66.67% (< 83%)
Mohan’s Earnings = 32 x 0.2 = ` 6.4
Ram’s efficiency = 42/48 x 100 = 87.5% (> 83 but < 100%)
Ram’s Earnings = 42 x 0.2 x 110/100 = ` 9.24
Prasad’s efficiency = 50/48 x 100 = 104.17 (> 100%)
Prasad’s Earnings = 50 x 0.20 x 120/100 = ` 12
Illustration 12
In a manufacturing concern the daily wage rate is `2.50. The standard output in a 6 day week is 200 units
representing 100% efficiency. The daily wage rate is paid without bonus to those workers who show up to
66 2/3% of the efficiency standard. Beyond this there is a bonus payable on a graded scale as below:-
82% efficiency - 5% bonus
90% Efficiency - 9% bonus
100% efficiency - 20% bonus
Further increase of 1% for every 1% further rise in efficiency. In a 6 day week A produced 180 units; B 164
units; C 200 units; D 208 units and E 130 units.
Calculate the earnings of these workers.
Solution:
A’s efficiency = (180 / 200) x 100 = 90%
A’s Earnings = (6 x 2.5) + 9% of (6 x 2.5) = ` 16.35
B’s efficiency = (164 / 200) x 100 = 82%
B’s Earnings = (6 x 2.5) + 5% of (6 x 2.5) = ` 15.75
C’s efficiency = (200 / 200) x 100 = 100%
Particulars A B C D
I Standard output (6 x 60 / 6) 60 60 60 60
II Actual output 48 60 75 90
III Performance level 80% 100% 125% 150%
IV Wages for measured work (6 x 4) 24 24 24 24
V Bonus [C = 24 x 25%] [D = 24 x 50%] -- -- 6 12
VI Wages for unmeasured work (2 x 4) 8 8 8 8
VII Total earnings (IV + V + VI) 32 32 38 44
Illustration 14
The following particulars for the first week of September, 2015 relate to X and Y two workers employed
in a factory:
X Y
a) Job Completed — units 3,600 4,200
b) Out of above output rejected and unsalable 540 420
c) Time allowed 12 Mts/dozen 3 Hrs./200 units
d) Basic wage rate per hour `5 `6
e) Hours worked 45 50
The normal working hours per week are fixed at 42 hours. Bonus is paid @ 2/3 of the basic wage rate
for gross time worked and gross output produced without deduction for rejected output. The rate of
overtime for first 4 hours is paid at time plus 1/3 and for next 4 hours is paid at time plus 1/2.
From the above data calculate for each employed
a) Number of bonus hours and amount of bonus earned;
b) Total wages earned including basic wages overtime premium and bonus;
c) Direct wages cost per 100 saleable units.
Solution:
Particulars X Y
1. No. of units completed 3,600 4,200
2. Rejected units 540 420
3. Saleable units 3,060 3,780
4. Standard time 60 hrs 63 hrs
5. Actual time worked 45 hrs 50 hrs
6. Bonus hours 15 hrs 13 hrs
7. Amount of bonus 50 52
(15 x 5 x 2/3) (13 x 6 x 2/3)
8. Overtime wages 20 68
(3 x 5 x 4/3) [(4 x 6 x 4/3) + (4 x 6x 3/2)]
9. Basic wages 210 252
(42 x 5) (42 x 6)
10. Total wages (7 + 8 + 9) 280 372
11. Direct wage cost of 100 saleable units. 9.15 9.84
(280 / 3060) x 100 (372 / 3780) x 100
Illustration 15
From the following particulars work out the earnings for the week of a worker under
(a) Straight Piece Rate
(b) Differential Piece Rate
(c) Halsey Premium System
(d) Rowan System
Number of working hours per week — 48
Wages per hour — ` 3.75
Normal time per piece — 20 Min
Normal output per week — 120 pieces
Actual output for the week — 150 pieces
Differential piece rate — 80% of the piece rate when output is below standard and
120% above standard.
Solution:
(d) Earnings under Rowan Plan = (48 x 3.75) + [(60-48 / 60) x (3.75 x 48)]
= 180 + 36 = ` 216
Illustration 16
Ten men work as a group. When the weekly production of the group exceeds standard (200 pieces
per hour) each man in the group is paid a bonus for the excess production in addition to his wages at
hourly rates. The bonus is computed thus:
The percentage of production in excess of the standard amount is found and one-half of this percentage
is considered as the men’s share. Each man in the group is paid as bonus this percentage of a wage
rate of ` 3.20 per hour. There is no relationship between the individual workman’s hourly rate and the
bonus rate. The following is the week’s records.
Hours Worked Production
Monday 90 22,100
Tuesday 88 22,600
Wednesday 90 24,200
Thursday 84 20,100
Friday 88 20,400
Saturday 40 10,200
480 1,19,600
(a) Compute the rate and amount of bonus for the week;
(b) Compute the total pay of Jones who worked 41 ½ hours and was paid `2 per hour basic and of
Smith who worked 44 ½ hours and was paid ` 2.50 per hour basic.
Solution:
Standard production in actual time = 480 x 200 = 96,000
Excess of actual production over standard = 1,19,600 – 96,000 = 23,600.
% of excess over standard = (23,600 / 96,000) x 100 = 24.58%
% of bonus = 1/2 x 24.58 = 12.29%
Bonus rate per hour = 3.2 x 12.29% = 0.393
Total bonus for week = 480 x 0.393 = ` 188.64
Illustration 17
A manufacturer introduces a new machinery into his factory with the result that production per worker
is increased. The workers are paid by results and it is agreed for every 2% increases in average individual
output, an increase of 1% on the rate of wages will be paid.
At the time the machinery is installed the selling price of the products falls by 8-1/3%. Show the net saving
in production costs which would be required to offset the losses expected from the turnover and bonus
paid to workers.
Ist period IInd period
No.of workers 175 125
Number of articles produced 16,800 14,000
Wages paid 33,600
Total Sales 75,600
Solution:
No. of units per worker in period I — = 16,800 / 175 = 96
No. of units per worker in period II — = 14,000 / 125 = 112
Increase in production per worker — = 16 units
% of increase in output = 16/96 x 100 — = 16 2/3 %
Wages in Period I = 33,600
Wages in Period II = 33,600 x (125 / 175) = 24,000
Increase in wages = 24,000 x 8.33% [16.67 x ½ = 8.33] = 2,000
Sales in Period I = 75,600
Sales in Period II = 75,600 x (14,000 / 16,800) = 63,000
Decrease in Sales = 63,000 x 8 1/3 % = 5,250
Total loss due to increase in wages & reduction in sales = 5,250 + 2,000
= 7,250
To offset the loss, the saving in other must be ` 7,250
Illustration 18
A work measurement study was carried out in a firm for 10 hours and the following information was
generated.
Units produced : 350
Idle time : 15%
Performance rating : 120%
Allowance time : 10% of standard time.
What is the standard time for task?
Solution:
Calculation of standard time for task
Total time = 10 x 60 = 600 minutes
(-) Down time or Idle time @ 15% = 90 minutes
Actual time = 510 minutes
Normal Time = 510 x 120% = 612 minutes
(+) Relaxation allowance
(10% or 1/10 on standard time
i.e. 1/9 on normal time) = 68 minutes
Standard time for job = 680 minutes
Standard time for each unit = 680/350 = 1.943 minutes
Illustration 19
“ “ resigned 20
“ “ discharged 5
Calculate the Labour Turnover Rate for the factory by different methods.
Solution:
1) Separation Method = 25 ÷ (150 + 200 / 2) x 100
= 0.1429 x 100
= 14.29 %
2) Replacement Method = (20 / 175) x 100
= 11.43%
3) Flux Method = (25 + 20) ÷ 175 x 100
= 25.71%
Illustration 20
In a factory bonus to workman is paid according to Rowan Plan. Time allotted for a job is 40 hours and
the normal rate of wages is ` 1.25 per hour. The factory overhead charges are 50 paise per hour for the
hours taken.
The factory cost of a work order, executed by a worker is ` 161.875. The cost of material in each case
is `100.
Calculate the hours of time taken by the workman to complete the work order.
Solution:
= [50T + 50 T – 1.25T2] / 40
= [100 T – 1.25T2] / 40
⇒ T2 – 96T + 1980 = 0
96 ± 9216 − 7920
T=
2
96 ± 36
T=
2
T = 66 (or) 30
T = 30 hours (because actual time should not be more than standard time).
Illustration 21
Two fitters, a labourer and a boy undertake a job on piece rate basis for `1,290. The time spent by each
of them is 220 ordinary working hours. The rates of pay on time rate basis, are `1.50 per hour for each
of the two fitters, `1 per hour for the labourer and `0.50 per hour for the boy.
The amount of piece-work premium and the share of each worker, when the piece -work premium is
divided proportionately to the wages paid.
Compute the selling price of the above job on the basis of the following additional data:-
Cost of the direct material `2,010; works overhead at 20% of prime cost; selling overhead at 10% of works
cost and profit at 25% on cost of sales.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of earnings of each person Amount (`)
Illustration 22
Two workmen, Vishnu and Shiva, produce the same product using the same material. Their normal wage
rate is also the same. Vishnu is paid bonus according to the Rowan System, while Shiva is paid bonus
according to Halsey System. The time allowed to make the product is 100 hours. Vishnu takes 60 hours
while Shiva takes 80 hours to complete the product. The factory overhead rate is `10 per man-hour
actually worked. The factory cost for the product for Vishnu is `7,280 and for Shiva it is ` 7,600.
You are required:-
(a) to find the normal rate of wages;
(b) to find the cost of materials;
(c) to prepare a statement comparing the factory cost of the products as made by the two works
men.
Solution:
Let ‘R’ be the wage rate and ‘M’ be the material cost.
Earnings of Vishnu = 60 R + [(100-60) / 100] x [60R]
= 60R + 24R = 84R
Material + Wages + Factory Overheads = Factory Cost.
M + 84R + 600 = 7,280
⇒ M + 84 R = 6,680 → (1)
Earnings of Shiva = 80 R + 50% of (100-80) x R
= 80 R + 10 R
= 90 R
Material + Wages + Factory Overheads = Factory Cost.
M + 90R + 800 = 7,600
⇒ M + 90 R = 6,800 → (2)
Solving Equation (1) & (2), we get
M + 84 R = 6,680
M + 90 R = 6,800
- 6R = -120
R = 20
120 THE INSTITUTE OF COST ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
Cost Ascertainment - Elements of Cost
Principles of Measurement of Employee Cost: The principles to be followed for measurement of employee
cost are:
Illustration 23
Measurement of Employee Cost
Basic pay `5,00,000; Lease rent paid for accommodation provided to an employee `2,00,000, amount
recovered from employee `40,000, Employer’s Contribution to P.F. `75,000, Employee’s Contribution to
P.F. `75,000; Reimbursement of Medical expenses `67,000, Hospitalisation expenses of employee’s family
member borne by the employer `19,000, Festival Bonus Rs.20,000, Festival Advance `30,000. Compute
the Employee cost.
Solution:
Computation of Employee Cost
Note:
(i) Festival advance is a recoverable amount, hence not included in employee cost.
(ii) Employee’s contribution to PF is not a cost to the employer, hence not considered.
Illustration 24
Measurement of Employee Cost (with special items)
Gross pay `10,30,000 (including cost of idle time hours paid to employee `25,000); Accommodation
provided to employee free of cost [this accommodation is owned by employer, depreciation of
accommodation `1,00,000, maintenance charges of the accommodation `90,000, municipal tax paid
for this accommodation `3,000], Employer’s Contribution to P.F. `1,00,000 (including a penalty of `2,000
for violation of PF rules), Employee’s Contribution to P.F. `75,000. Compute the Employee cost.
Solution:
Computation of Employee Cost
Particulars Amount (`)
Gross Pay ( net of cost of idle time) =[10,30,000 (-) 25,000] 10,05,000
Add Cost of accommodation provided by employer 1,93,000
Illustration 25
Measurement of Employee Cost (with special items)
Trial Balance as on 31.3.2017 (relevant extracts only)
Solution:
Computation of Employee Cost
Note:
(i) Recoverable amount from employee is excluded from the cost of perquisites.
(ii) Employee training cost is not an employee cost. It is to be treated as an Overhead, hence, not
included.
(iii) Special subsidy received is to be excluded, as it reduces the cost of the employer.
(iv) Unamortized amount of employee cost related to a discontinued operation is not an includible
item of cost.
Employees whose services are indirectly related to production include product designers, job
supervisors, foreman, product inspectors, and the like. Employee cost of such employees is
considered part of Production overheads. Salaries of employees working on administrative
activities such as administration, personnel, accounts, and the like are classified as part of
administrative overheads. Similarly, salaries of employees engaged in marketing / selling activities
and distribution activities are part of Selling and Distribution Overheads.
3. The cost statement shall furnish the resources consumed on account of Employee cost, category
wise such as wages salaries to permanent, temporary, part time and contract employees piece
rate payments, overtime payments, Employee benefits (category wise) etc wherever such items
form a material part of the total Employee cost: Direct employee cost is to be exhibited as a
separate item in the cost statement as per CAS 7 (Limited Revision 2017).
Measurement of efficiency
For many businesses, including most small businesses, the most significant cost is labour. Salaries and
wages comprise the major line-item expense for most retail and small-scale manufacturing companies,
but labour also tends to be responsive to productivity improvements. To reduce labour costs,
entrepreneurs should consider measuring employee efficiency and setting aggressive performance
targets to get most of their Employee Costs.
Measuring Productivity
Productivity is simply the amount of units of a product or service that an employee handles in a defined
time frame. An employee who makes mechanical device might make 20 mechanical devices per hour,
or an employee at a coffee shop might service 15 customers per hour. Simple productivity is neither
good nor bad, and in service industries, it might vary according to factors beyond the employee’s
control, like the number of customers who present for service. Productivity is the basic measure of
employee work output.
Determining Unit of Service (UOS)
Productivity and efficiency require a defined unit of service. UOS analysis is usually job-specific, and
is most relevant to employees who have jobs that are repetitive. For example, a spot welder might
have “welds completed” or “parts completed” as his UOS, whereas a housekeeper in a hotel might
have “rooms cleaned per shift” as her UOS. Some jobs, particularly professional jobs that have variable
output, defy reasonable UOS measurements.
Measuring Efficiency
Efficiency is a ratio of an employee’s actual time to perform each UOS against the theoretical time
needed to complete it. For example, an employee who packages DVDs might put together 80
DVDs in one hour. If the best-practice target is 100 DVDs in an hour--measured by a time study--then
the employee is 80 percent effective and has the capacity to produce 20 more units per hour. It is
usually helpful to report separately the percentage of an employee’s paid time that is actually spent
performing direct work. For example, an employee who is paid for working 8.0 hours but because of
meetings and lunch breaks only works 6.0 hours only spends 75 percent of her time being “productive”
in terms of UOS analysis. Only the six hours spent working should be factored into efficiency scoring.
Benchmarks and Targets
Some industries have basic benchmarks already established. For example, telephone call centers
have service levels that identify the ideal amount of time that common transactions should take, that
are consistent across industries. However, most companies will have to establish for themselves how
long basic tasks should take, and set performance targets accordingly. The task of baseline measuring
should be done with a time study, which averages the amount of time that multiple transactions take
or assesses the amount of time an average employee performs the task. It may not be ideal to require
employees to be 100 percent efficient, particularly when the employees lack control over their own
productivity--like in customer-service jobs when employees wait for customers to call or stop by. If an
employee can never hit 100 percent, then morale may suffer.
Longitudinal Reporting
The real benefit to measuring employee efficiency is in longitudinal reporting. Calculating efficiency
over a period of time can identify opportunities to reorganize staffing, or add or remove employees
based on the company’s volume of business, and an individual employee’s long-term productivity
can factor into merit increases and bonuses. Efficiency scoring can also help with predictive modeling.
If it takes 90 seconds to produce a mechanical device, and employees are operating at 75 percent
efficiency, then instead of producing 40 widgets per hour, only 30 will be produced.
GLOSSARY
Abnormal Idle Time: Abnormal Idle Time arises on account of abnormal causes and is generally
charged to Costing Profit & Loss Account.
Differential Piece Rate: Differential Piece Rates are applicable for different levels of output below and
above the standard.
Differential Time Rate: Under Differential Time Rate System of wage payment different hourly rates are
fixed for different levels of efficiency. A fixed rate is paid up to a certain level and thereafter the hourly
rate increases gradually depending on the efficiency level.
Direct Labour Cost: Direct Labour Cost is the cost of remuneration for employee’s efforts and skills
applied directly to a product or saleable service and which can be identified separately in product
costs.
Direct Labour Cost Rate: Direct Labour Cost Rate is the rate calculated by dividing the budgeted or
estimated overhead cost attributable to a cost centre by the amount of direct labour cost expected
to be incurred.
Employee Cost: Employee Costs are the benefits paid or payable to the employees of an entity,
whether permanent or temporary, for the services rendered by them. It includes payments made in
cash or kind.
Idle Time: Idle Time is the period of time for which the shop floor is available for production but is not
utilised due to shortage of materials, tools, operators etc.
Indirect Labour Cost: Indirect Labour Costs are the labour costs which are not charged directly to a
product, e. g. supervision.
Labour Turnover: Labour Turnover is the rate of change in employee force during a specified period
due to resignation, retirement and retrenchment. If the employee turnover is high, it is a signal of
instability and may affect the profitability of the firm.
Normal Idle Time: Normal Idle Time is the time which cannot be avoided or reduced in the normal
course of business. The cost of normal idle time is generally charged to the cost of production.
Overtime: Overtime is the time an employee works beyond the normal working hours.
Generally, over time is to be paid to the employees’ at double the rate of normal hours.
Overtime Premium: Overtime Premium is the amount of extra payment paid to an employee for extra
work done.
Straight Piece Work: Straight Piece Work system of wage payment is the system whereby wages is
paid to the workers on the basis of number of units produced by them irrespective of time spent for
production.
Time Booking: Time Booking refers to the recording of details of work done and the time spent by an
employee on each job or process.
Time Keeping: Time Keeping refers to recording and keeping of the employees’ attendance time.
Time Rate System: Time Rate System is the system of wage payment whereby wages to an employee
is paid on the basis of time irrespective of production volume.
(f) In India, if a worker works for more than 8 hours on any day or for more than 40 hours in a week,
he is treated to be engaged in overtime.
(g) The two principal systems of wage payment are payment on the basis of time and payment
on the basis of work done.
(h) The piece rate system of wage payment cannot be successfully applied where quantity of
output can be measured.
(i) A good system of wage payment should not ensure equal pay for equal work.
[Ans: (True : a; b; c; d; g) (False : e; f; h; i)]
13. How to report the employee cost in the Cost Statement?
14. Discuss the means to measure Employee efficiency?
15. “High wages do not necessarily mean high Labour Cost”. Comment.
16. Explain in detail “Work Study”.
17. Write a short note on Job Evaluation and Merit rating.
PRACTICE PROBLEMS:
18. What will be the earnings of a worker at 60 paise per hour when he takes 100 hours to do a volume
of work for which the standard time is 160 hours the plan of payment for bonus is on a sliding scale
as under:
Within the first 10% saving in the Standard time, the Bonus is : 40% of the Time Saved.
Within the second 10% saving in the Standard Time, the bonus is : 50% of the Time Saved.
Within the third 10% saving in the Standard Time, the bonus is : 60% of the Time Saved.
Within the Fourth 10% saving in the Standard Time, the Bonus is : 70% of the Time Saved.
For the rest of the time saved : 75% of the Time Saved.
[Ans: Total earnings ` 79.44]
19. Using Taylor’s differential piece rate system find out the earnings of X and Y from the f o l l o w i n g
particulars:
Standard time per piece - 20 minutes
Normal rate per hour - 90 paise
In a 9 hour day : X produced - 25 units
Y produced - 30 units
[Ans: X : ` 6.23; Y : ` 15.75]
20. The following are particulars applicable to a work process.
Time rate - `5 per hour.
High task - 40 units per week.
Piece rate above high task - `6.50 per unit.
In a 40 hour week, the production of the workers:
A - 35 units B - 40 Units C - 41 units D - 52 units
Calculate the wages of the workers under Gantt Task Bonus.
[Ans: A : ` 200; B : ` 240; C : ` 266.5; D : ` 338]
128 THE INSTITUTE OF COST ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
Cost Ascertainment - Elements of Cost
21. In a unit, 10 men work as a group. When the production of the group exceeds the Standard output
of 200 pieces per hour, each man is paid an incentive for the excess production in addition to
his wages at hourly rates. The incentive is at half the percentage, the excess production over the
standard hours bears to the standard production. Each man is paid an incentive at the rate of this
percentage of a wage rate of `2 per hour. There is no relation between the individual work man’s
hourly rate and the bonus rate.
In a week, the hours worked are 500 hours and total production is 1,20,000 units.
a) Compute the total amount of bonus for the week.
b) Calculate the total earnings of two workers A and B of the group:
A worked 44 hours and his basic rate per hour was ` 2.20
B worked 48 hours and his basic rate per hour was ` 1.90
[Ans: a) Total Bonus for the week is ` 100
b) Earnings of A : ` 105.6; B : ` 100.8]
22. In a factory bonus system, bonus hours are credited to the employee in the proportion of time taken
which time saved based to time allowed. Jobs are carried forward from one week to another. No
overtime is worked and payment is made in full for all units worked, and including those subsequently
rejected.
From the following information you are required to Calculate for each employee
(a) The bonus hours and amount of bonus earned;
(b) The total wages cost; and
(c) The wages cost of each good unit produced.
A (`) B (`) C (`)
Basic wage rate/hour 0.25 0.40 0.30
Units produced 2,500 2,200 3,600
Time allowed/100 units 2 hr.36 min 3 hrs. 1 hrs.30 min.
Time taken 52 hrs. 75 hrs. 48 hrs.
Rejects 100 units 40 units 400 units.
[Ans: A : 13 hrs; B : Nil; C : 6 hrs
Amount of bonus A : ` 2.6; B : Nil; C : ` 1.6
Total wages cost A : ` 15.6; B : ` 30; C : ` 16
Cost of good units produced A : ` 0.0065; B : ` 0.0139; C : ` 0.005]
23. In a factory bonus to workman is paid according to using the Rowan plan. Time allotted for a job
is 40 hours and the normal rate of wages is ` 1.25 per hour. The factory overhead charges are 50
paise per hour for the hours taken.
The factory cost of a work order executed by a worker is ` 155.468. The cost of material is `100.
Calculate the hours of time taken by the workman to complete the work order.
[Ans: Actual hrs 25]
9. Over time is
A. Actual hours being more than normal time
B. Actual hours being more than standard time
C. Standard hours being more than actual hours
D. Actual hours being less than standard time
10. Time keeping refers to
A. Time spent by workers on their job
B. Time spent by workers in factory
C. Time spent by workers without work
D. Time spent by workers on their job
11. Time and motion study is conducted by
A. Personal department
B. Time keeping department
C. Engineering department
D. Payroll department
E. None of the above
12. Labour productivity is measured by comparing
A. Total output with total man−hours
B. Added value for the product with total wage cost
C. Actual time and standard time
D. All of the above
13. If the time saved is less than 50% of the standard time, then the wages under Rowan and Halsey
premium plan on comparison gives:
A. Equal wages under two plans
B. More wages to workers under Halsey plan than Rowan plan
C. More wages to workers under Rowan plan than Halsey Plan
D. None of the above
14. Idle time is the time under which
A. No productivity is given by the workers
B. Full wages are paid to workers
C. None of the above
D. All of the above
15. Identify, which one of the following, does not account for increasing labour productivity
A. Motivating workers
B. Job satisfaction
C. Proper supervision and control
D. High labour turnover
E. None of the above
16. Under Taylor’s differential piece rate scheme, if a worker fails to complete the task within the
standard time, then he is paid
A. 83% of the piece work rate
B. 175% of the piece work rate
C. 67% of the piece work rate
D. 125% of the piece work rate
E. None of the above
[Ans: C, A, A, B, C, D, A, C, A, B, C, D, C, D, D, A]
[Ans: 1. D; 2. E; 3. A; 4. B; 5. C]
Direct expense or chargeable expense is that which can be allocated to a cost centre or cost unit
and indirect expense is that which needs to be apportioned. There may be items of expense direct
in relation to some cost centre. Thus rent and rates, heating & lighting, depreciation & insurance
are often allocated or charged directly to the appropriate service cost centre, the totals of service
department cost are however, apportioned to other cost centres before being absorbed by cost units
as overheads. These costs are direct costs of the first cost centre, but indirect costs of other production
cost centres, as well as being indirect cost of cost units.
Direct expenses as defined in CAS-10 (Limited Revision 2017), ‘Expenses relating to manufacture of a
product or rendering a service, which can be identified or linked with the cost object other than direct
material cost and direct employee cost’.
The more a factory is departmentalized, the greater will be the proportion of expenses which can
be classified as direct. Thus cost of medicines, first aid, and other expenses in connection with the
medical service are direct expenses of medical service department, but if there is no medical service
department, the expenses would have been distributed to all the cost centres at the very beginning.
The following expenses may be treated as direct expenses:-
(a) Cost of patents, royalty payment;
(b) Hire charges in respect of special machinery or plant;
(c) Cost of special patterns, cores, designs or tools;
(d) Experimental costs and expenditure in connection with models and pilot schemes;
(e) Architects, surveyors and other consultants fee;
(f) Travelling expenses to sites;
(g) Inward charges and freight charges on special material.
A direct expense in relation to a product forms part of the Prime Cost. Indirect expenses are treated as
Overheads. In relation to products, direct material is a material that becomes a part of it and can be
physically traced in some form in the finished products, where as the direct expenses are cost providing
services or other kinds of special charges, but no trace of them can be obtained in the finished product
like raw material. Both the direct material and direct expenses forms part of the Prime Cost.
(f) Penalties / damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not be form part of the
direct expenses.
(g) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for measurement of the direct expenses
should be made only if it is required by law or for compliance with the requirements of a Cost
Accounting Standard or a change would result in a more appropriate preparation or presentation
of Cost Statement of the organization.
(h) Credit / recoveries relating to direct expenses, material and quantifiable shall be deducted to
arive at the net direct expenses.
(i) Any abnormal portion of direct expenses where is material and quantifiable shall not form part of
the direct expenses.
The Cost Statement shall disclose the following items of Direct Expenses as per CAS-10:
(a) The basis of distribution of direct expenses to cost objects / cost units
(b) Quantity and rates of items of direct expenses as applicable
(c) Where direct expenses are accounted at standard cost the price and usage variance
(d) Direct expenses representing procurement of resources and expenses incurred in connection with
resources generated
(e) Direct expenses paid or payable to related parties
(f) Direct expenses incurred in foreign currency
(g) Any subsidy / incentive and any such payment received from direct expenses
(h) Credits or recoveries relating to the direct expenses
(i) Any abnormal portion of direct expenses
(j) Penalties and damages excluded from the direct expenses
(k) Disclosure shall be made only when material, significant and quantifiable. Disclosures shall be
made in the body of the Cost Statement or as a foot note or as a separate schedule.
Cost Accounting Standard-10 : Direct Expenses
Direct Expenses: Expenses relating to manufacture of a product or rendering a service, which can be
identified or linked with the cost object other than direct material cost and direct employee cost.
Examples of Direct Expenses are royalties charged on production, job charges, hire charges for use of
specific equipment for a specific job, cost of special designs or drawings for a job, software services
specifically required for a job, travelling Expenses for a specific job.
Measurement of Direct Expenses: Inclusions and Exclusions
The following items are to be ‘included’ for the purpose of measuring employee cost:
(i) Costs which are directly traceable/identifiable with the cost object
(ii) Expenses incurred for the use of bought in resources
(iii) Price variance if such expenses are accounted for at standard cost
The following items are to be ‘excluded’ for the purpose of measuring employee cost:
(i) If not traceable/identifiable should be considered as overheads
(ii) Finance cost is not a direct expense
(iii) Imputed cost (example, if the owner of a company engages himself for facilitating the production
or gets actively engaged in production or rendering of services, this would be an imputed cost)
(iv) Recoveries, credits, subsidy, grant, incentive or any other which reduces the cost
(v) Penalty, damages paid to statutory authorities
Solution:
Computation of Direct Expenses
Illustration 2: Measurement of Direct Expenses – allocation to cost object products (in a multi-product
situation)
A manufacturing unit produces two products X and Y. The following information is furnished:
Solution:
Computation of Direct Expenses
Note:
(i) Royalty on production and royalty on sales are allocated on the basis of units produced and units
sold respectively. These are directly identifiable and traceable to the number of units produced
and units sold. Hence, this is not an apportionment.
(ii) No adjustments are made related to units held, i.e. closing stock.
An overhead is the amount which is not identified with any product. The name overhead might have
come due to the reason of over and above the normal heads of expenditure. It is the aggregate of
indirect material, indirect labour and indirect expenditure. The generic term used to denote indirect
material, indirect labour and indirect expenses. Thus overheads forms a class of cost that cannot be
allocated or absorbed but can only be apportioned to cost units.
In earlier days, overheads were not given much importance, because the prime cost constitutes 50-80%
of the total cost. However, with the modern trend towards the mechanisation, automation, and mass
production, overhead costs have grown considerably in size and in many undertakings the proportion
of overhead costs to the total costs of products is appreciably high. High overheads do not indicate
inefficiency if the increase in overheads is due to the following likely causes:
(a) Improved methods of managerial control like Accountancy, Production Control, Work Study, Cost
and Management Accountancy...etc. In the process of reducing costs of other elements, viz. direct
material and direct labour, overhead costs are likely to increase.
(b) Large scale production or mass production.
(c) Use of costly machines and equipments increases the amounts of depreciation, maintenance
expenditure and similar other items of overhead costs.
(d) Less human efforts are necessary with automatic machines. A major portion of the cost is allocated
direct to machines, thus increasing the machine overhead costs.
(e) Increased efficiency and productivity of labour has the effect of pushing up the overhead to direct
labour ratio.
According to CIMA, overhead costs are defined as, ‘the total cost of indirect materials, indirect labour
and indirect expenses’. Thus all indirect costs like indirect materials, indirect labour, and indirect expenses
are called as ‘overheads’. Examples of overhead expenses are rent, taxes, depreciation, maintenance,
repairs, supervision, selling and distribution expenses, marketing expenses, factory lighting, printing
stationery etc. As per CAS-3, overheads are defined as follows ‘Overheads comprise costs of indirect
materials, indirect employees and indirect expenses which are not directly identifiable or allocable to
a cost object in an economically feasible manner’
Overhead Accounting
The ultimate aim of Overhead Accounting is to absorb them in the product units produced by the firm.
Absorption of overhead means charging each unit of a product with an equitable share of overhead
expenses. In other words, as overheads are all indirect costs, it becomes difficult to charge them to
the product units. In view of this, it becomes necessary to charge them to the product units on some
equitably basis which is called as ‘Absorption’ of overheads. The important steps involved in Overhead
Accounting are as follows:-
(a) Collection, Classification and Codification of Overheads.
(b) Allocation, Apportionment and Reapportionment of overheads.
(c) Absorption of Overheads.
As mentioned above, the ultimate of Overhead Accounting is ‘Absorption’ in the product units. This
is extremely important as accurate absorption will help in arriving at accurate cost of production.
Overheads are indirect costs and hence there are numerous difficulties in charging the overheads to
the product units.
THE INSTITUTE OF COST ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA 137
COST ACCOUNTING
Overheads
Classification
1. Repetitive distribution
2. Simultaneous equation
3. Trial & Error
Collection of Overheads
Overheads collection is the process of recording each item of cost in the records maintained for the
purpose of ascertainment of cost of each cost centre or unit.
The following are the source documents for collection of overheads:-
(i) Stores Requisition
(ii) Wages Sheet
(iii) Cash Book
(iv) Purchase Orders and Invoices
(v) Journal Entries
(vi) Other Registers and Records
Source document and the nature of overheads are enumerated as below.
For the purpose of overhead accounting, collection of overheads is very important. It is necessary to
identify the indirect expenses and the above mentioned source documents are used for this. Proper
collection of overhead expenses will help to understand accurately the total overhead expenses.
Classification of Overheads
Classification is defined by CIMA as, ‘the arrangement of items in logical groups having regard to
their nature (subjective classification) or the purpose to be fulfilled (Objective classification). In other
words, classification is the process of arranging items into groups according to their degree of similarity.
Accurate classification of all items is actually a prerequisite to any form of cost analysis and control
system. Classification is made according to the following basis:
Based on Elements: Indirect Materials, Indirect labour and Indirect expenses.
Based on Functions of the organisation: Manufacturing overheads, Administrative overheads, Selling
and Distribution overheads, Research & Development overheads.
Based on the Behaviour: Fixed Overheads, Variable Overheads & Semi variable overheads.
Classification according to Elements
According to this classification overheads are divided according to their elements. The classification is
done as per the following details:-
Indirect Materials
Materials which cannot be identified with the given product unit of cost centre is called as indirect
materials. As per CAS-3 indirect material cost is defined as ‘Materials, the cost of which cannot be
directly attributed to a particular cost object’. For example, lubricants used in a machine is an indirect
material, similarly thread used to stitch clothes is also indirect material. Small nuts and bolts are also
examples of indirect materials.
Indirect Labour
As per CAS-3, indirect employee cost is the employee cost, which cannot be directly attributed to a
particular cost object. Wages and salaries paid to indirect workers, i.e. workers who are not directly
engaged on the production are examples of indirect wages.
Indirect Expenses
As per CAS-3, Indirect Expenses are expenses, which cannot be directly attributed to a particular cost
object. Expenses such as rent and taxes, printing and stationery, power, insurance, electricity, marketing
and selling expenses etc. are the examples of indirect expenses.
Functional Classification
Overheads can also be classified according to their functions.
Company Secretary, Human resources, Legal, General Administration. The overheads that are common
to all these departments are apportioned on some suitable basis e.g. in the following manner:
(a) For Office rent, rates & taxes - Floor space as the basis,
(b) For Depreciation on office building - Floor space as the basis
(c) For Legal fees - No of cases handled as the basis
(d) For Salaries of common staff - Ratio of salaries of departments as the basis
(e) For Typist pool - No of documents typed as the basis
Absorption of the Administrative Overheads into cost units is very difficult. Many times it is advised that
these overheads may not be absorbed into product units because of the difficulty and non-relevance
of them with production activity. Normally, the Administrative Overheads are totalled together and
then using a suitable basis, a rate of recovery is arrived at to absorb the same. It could be mostly a
percentage of Works cost or factory cost. Based on the principle of ‘charging what the traffic can bear’,
the absorption could be on the basis of a percentage of gross profit. Whatever method selected, it will
be arbitrary and could lead to erroneous conclusions. A Cost Accountant has to use all the experience
and history of the organisation before he selects a particular method to adopt.
The costs are collected through various source documents under the above heads and for the above
departments. For absorption, the basis to be used will have practical difficulties, as one will have to look
for a relationship between the expenses and the cost unit. Some expenses like sales commission, shipping
costs, and direct selling expenses can be absorbed directly. The other expenses can be absorbed on
the basis of either sales value, cost of goods sold, gross profit or number of units sold. Out of these the
sales value method is the most commonly used.
Control over Selling & Distribution Expenses
The S & D Expenses are related to sales and distribution activity which is externally focused. The extent of
these expenses depend mainly on external factors like consumer profile, changing habits, technology
improvements etc. Controlling these expenses does not mean capping them. It aims at increasing the
effectiveness of these expenses e.g. getting maximum sales per rupee of S & D Expenses. For control
purpose, a great care should be taken to ensure correct classification and collection of S & D Overheads.
The collected expenses must be analysed to assess the effect of them on sales. Such analysis could be
done as follows:
(a) Analysis of sales and S & D Expenses by geographical locations – This could be regions, zones,
domestic and international etc.
(b) Analysis by type of customers - This could be done as institutional, government, retail etc.
(c) Analysis by products or services – This may be done as range of products, the application of products,
brands etc.
(d) Analysis by salesmen.
(e) Analysis by channel of distribution – This analysis pertains to wholesalers, retailers, commission agents
etc.
The analysis of sales, profits and S & D expenses on the basis of above factors will give a good insight into
the performance as well as control over expenses. All these three parameters may be compared with
l Previous year;
l Budget for the current year or
l Standards for the current year
Research and Development Overheads
Research Cost is defined as the cost of searching for new or improved products, new applications of
material, or new or improved methods, process, systems or services. In the modern days, firms spend
heavily on Research and Development. Expenses incurred on research and development is known as
Research and Development Overheads. Research may be of the following types:
(i) Pure or basic research to gain general know-how regarding the production or market, not directed
towards any particular product.
(ii) Applied research which applies the basic knowledge in practice. i.e improvement of existing
products, new process, exploring of new products, improved measures of safety, etc.
Development cost is the cost of the process which begins with the implementation of the decision to
use scientific or technical knowledge to produce a new or improved product or to employ a new or
improved method, process, system, etc. and ends with the commencement of formal production of
that product by that method. Development starts where the research ends. Development cost is the
expenditure incurred for putting the results of research on a practical commercial basis.
Special features of Research & Development Costs
The features are as follows:-
(a) Expenditure is incurred ahead of the actual production and may not be charged to current
production.
(d) It is difficult to assess the period over which the know-how or knowledge acquired may be spread
over.
(e) It may be more advantageous to recover a substantial portion of the cost immediately, as the life
of the new products are uncertain.
(f) In certain cases, the effect of these research costs on future revenues may be doubtful.
The classification used for cost collection is mostly combination of elemental and functional. The
behavioural classification cannot be used for booking of costs; it is used only for analysis and decision
making.
X
O Volume of Production
Variable Overheads
Variable Costs are those which vary totally in direct proportion to the volume of output. These costs per
unit remain relatively constant with changes in production. Thus Variable Costs fluctuate in total amount
but tend to remain constant per unit as production activity changes. Examples are indirect material,
indirect labour, lubricants, cost of utilities, etc.
The variable overhead costs seldom reveal the characteristics of perfect variability. i.e an expenditure
which varies directly with variation in the volume of output. They simply tend to vary rather than vary
directly in direct proportion of output. We come across three types of variable overhead expenses in
actual practice as explained below:-
(i) 100% variable expenses. For all production the variable expenditure remains constant.
(ii) The expense per unit of production is low at lower ranges of output but gradually increases as
production goes up.
(iii) The expenses per unit of production are more at lower ranges of output but gradually decrease
with the decrease with the increase in production.
Nature of variable expenses is shown as below:-
Overhead (`) Y
The relationship of fixed and variable overheads with the volume of output is exhibited in the following
table. The range of output is considered as 5000-10000 units. Variable overheads are taken at `2 per
unit and fixed overheads are assumed to be at the level of `25000. Can you check for yourself how the
graph will look like for the following figures?
Semi-Variable Overheads
These are a sort of mixed or hybrid costs, partly fixed and partly variable costs. For example Telephone
expenses, include a fixed portion of annual charge plus variable charge according to the calls. Thus
total telephone expenses are semi-variable.
Semi-variable overheads are of two types:-
(i) The expenses which change with the change in volume of output, but the variation cost is less than
proportionate to change in output. Examples are power & fuel, lighting, repairs and maintenance
of buildings, etc.
(ii) The costs tend to remain constant within certain range of output, then jump up and remain constant
for another range and so on.
Y
Semi-variable overheads
Overhead (`)
X
Output or Volume in units
Semi variable cost need to be classifed into fixed and variable due to the following reasons:
(a) Effective Cost Control: Fixed costs are in the nature of policy costs or discretionary costs and as
such can be controlled by the management. However variable costs can be controlled at lower
levels. Separation of two elements facilitate the fixation of responsibility, preparation of overhead
budget and exercise effective control.
(b) Decision Making: The classification is very useful in management decisions relating to utilization of
capacity. If cost information is to be of use in such problems, it is essential that fixed and variable
costs which behave differently with changes in volume should be segregated.
(c) Preparation of Break-even Charts: Separation of fixed and variable cost is essential for the study of
cost volume profit relationship and for the preparation of breakeven charts and profit charts.
(d) Marginal Costing: The basic requirement of the technique of Marginal Costing is the separation
of fixed and variable costs. While the latter are taken into consideration for the determination of
Marginal Cost and contribution, the fixed costs are treated separately.
(e) Method of Absorption Costing: Separate method may be adopted for determination of rates for
fixed and variable costs for absorption in production. Further a separate fixed overhead rate also
serves as a measure of utilization of the facilities of the undertaking; any under recovery or under
absorption denotes the idle or surplus capacity or production efficiency.
(f) Flexible Budget: In a Flexible Budget, the budgeted amounts vary with the levels of activity & fixed
cost remains constant. It is the variable cost that varies. Breakup of overhead cost into fixed and
variable is therefore necessary for establishment of budget and for the purpose of variance analysis.
Methods of classification of semi variable cost in fixed and variable
(a) Graphical Method – The costs at number of levels are plotted on a graph, x-axis represents the
volume and y-axis represents the amount of expenditure. A straight line known as regression line or
line of best fit is drawn between the points, plotted in such a manner that there are equal number
of points on both the sides of a line and as far as practicable, pairs of points on either side are in
equal distance from the line. Points falling far beyond the line are erratic and are not considered.
If the regression line is drawn carefully so that most of the plotted points are on the line or not far
from it, the scatter chart provides a fairly accurate method for the separation of fixed and variable.
(b) Simultaneous Equations – This uses the straight line equation of y = m x + c where y represents total
cost, m is variable cost per unit, x is the level of output and c is fixed costs. The total costs at two
different volumes are put into these equations which are solved for the values of m and c.
(d) High and Low Method – The highest and lowest levels of output and costs are taken and the
differential is found. This difference arises only due to variable costs. The remaining portion will be
fixed costs. Under this method the variable cost per unit will be computed first and then the fixed
cost will be derived. Variable cost per unit is computed by dividing the difference in cost at highest
level and lowest level with the difference in volume between highest and lowest level.
(d) Least Square Method – This statistical tool uses straight line equation and finds the line of best fit to
solve the equations. Also known as Simple Regression Method. Under this method first the mean
of volume and mean of costs are computed. The deviations in volume (x) from the mean and
deviation in cost (y) from mean are computed.
Codification of Overheads
It is always advisable to codify the overhead expenses. Codification helps in easy identification of
different items of overheads. There are numerous items of overheads and a code number to each one
will facilitate identification of these items easily. Codification can be done by allotting numerical codes or
alphabetical codes or a combination of both. Whatever system is followed, it should be remembered that
the system is simple for understanding and easy to implement without any unnecessary complications.
products on logical or equitable basis is called allocation. Where a cost can be clearly identified with
a cost centre or cost unit, then it can be allocated to that particular cost centre or unit. In other words,
allocation is the process by which cost items are charged directly to a cost unit or cost centre. For
example, electricity charges can be allocated to various departments if separate meters are installed,
depreciation of machinery can be allocated to various departments as the machines can be identified,
salary of stores clerk can be allocated to stores department, cost of coal used in boiler can be directly
allocated to boiler house division. Thus allocation is a direct process of identifying overheads to cost
units or cost centres. So the term allocation means allotment of whole item of cost to a particular cost
centre or cost object without any division.
Apportionment
Cost Apportionment is the allotment of proportions of items to cost centers. Wherever possible, the
overheads are to be allocated. However, if it is not possible to charge the overheads to a particular
cost centre or cost unit, they are to be apportioned to various departments on some suitable basis. This
process is called as ‘Apportionment’ of overheads. The basis for apportionment is normally predetermined
and is decided after a careful study of relationships between the base and the other variables within
the organisation. The Cost Accountant must ensure that the selected basis is the most logical. A lot of
quantitative information has to be collected and constantly updated for the purpose of apportionment.
The basis selected should be applied consistently to avoid vitiations. However, there should be a periodical
review of the same to revise the basis if needed.
In simple words, distribution of various items of overheads in proportions to the departments or products
on logical or equitable basis is called apportionment.
A general example of various bases that may be used for the purpose of apportionment is shown below:
Particulars P1 P2 P3 S1 S2
Area sq ft 400 300 270 150 80
No. of workers 54 48 36 24 18
Wages 18,000 15,000 12,000 9,000 6,000
Value of plant 72,000 54,000 48,000 6,000
Stock Value 45,000 27,000 18,000
Horse power of plant 600 400 300 150 50
Allocate or apportion the overheads among the various departments on suitable basis.
Solution:
The primary distribution of overheads is as follows:- Amount (`)
Solution:
We will have to determine the sequence in which the service departments should be selected for
distribution and the bases on which each of them will be distributed. The following logical bases are
decided based on the additional information given:
Time office - No of employees
Stores - No of stores requisitions
Maintenance - Machine hours
Also, it can be easily noticed that the time office serves maximum departments (i.e. both production
departments, stores & maintenance departments). Stores serve the next larger number of departments
(i.e. both production departments and maintenance department).
Maintenance department serves only production departments. Hence the sequence for distribution
will be time office, stores and maintenance. This is shown in the following table:
Amount (`)
Particulars Total Basis Fabrication Assembly Time Stores Maintenance
office
As per primary 52,000 as given 24,000 16,000 4,000 5,000 3,000
distribution
Time office 4,000 no of 1,600 1,200 (4,000) 800 400
employees
Stores 5,800 no of req. 2,784 2,320 (5,800) 696
slips
Maintenance 4,096 Machine 2,458 1,638 (4,096)
hours
Total 30,842 21,158
Please notice when we distribute the time office costs first, the charge to stores department is `800.
This makes the total cost of stores to be distributed as `5800 (5000+800).Same is the logic for `4096 of
Maintenance department.
(c) Reciprocal Service Method: This method takes cognizance of the fact that service departments may
actually give as well as receive services from and to the other service departments on reciprocal basis.
Such inter-departmental exchange of service is given due weight in the distribution of the overheads.
There are two methods used for distribution under this logic. One is called Repeated Distribution Method
and the other Simultaneous Equation Method.
(d) Repeated Distribution Method: This is a continuous distribution of overhead costs over all departments.
The decided ratios are used to distribute the costs of service departments to the production and other
service departments. This is continued till the figures of service departments become ‘nil’ or ‘negligible’.
Illustration 3
The summary as per primary distribution is as follows:
Production departments A- `2400; B- `2100 & C- `1500
Service departments X – `700; Y- `900
Expenses of service departments are distributed in the ratios of:
X dept. : A- 20%, B- 40%, C- 30% and Y- 10%
Y dept. : A- 40%, B- 20%, C- 20% and X- 20%
Show the distribution of service costs among A, B and C under repeated distribution method.
Solution:
Amount (`)
Production departments Service departments
Particulars
A B C X Y
As per primary distribution 2400 2100 1500 700 900
Service dept X 140 280 210 (700) 70
Service dept Y 388 194 194 194 (970)
Service dept X 38.8 77.6 58.2 (194) 19.4
Service dept Y 7.76 3.88 3.88 3.88 (19.4)
Service dept X 0.776 1.552 1.164 (3.88) 0.388
Total 2975.336 2657.032 1967.244 0 0.388
It can be noticed that the undistributed balance in service department is very negligible and thus can
be ignored for further distribution
(e) Simultaneous Equations Method: Under this method, simultaneous equations are formed using the
service departments’ share with each other. Solving the two equations will give the total cost of service
departments after loading the inter- departmental exchange of services. These costs are then distributed
among production departments in the given ratios.
In the above Illustration No. 3, service dept X gives 10% of its service to Y and receives 20% of Y’s service.
Let ‘x’ be the total expenses of dept X (its own + share of Y) and
‘y’ be the total expenses of dept Y (its own + share of X)
This can be expressed as:
‘x’ = 700 + 20% of ‘y’ and
‘y’ = 900 + 10% of ‘x’
i.e. x = 700 + 0.2y and
y = 900 + 0.1x
Multiplying both equations by 10, we get
10x = 7000 + 2y i.e. 10x –2y = 7000 and
10y = 9000 + x i.e. -x+10y = 9000
Now multiplying 2nd equation by 10, and then adding the two equations we get,
98y = 97000
Thus y = 990 and x = 898
Based on this we distribute the service department costs over production departments.
Redistribution Statement
Department
A B C X Y
Primary Distribution 2400 2100 1500 700 900
X 180 359 269 (898) 90
Y 396 198 198 198 (990)
Total 2976 2657 1967 — —
Production Causes
These causes primarily result from poor organization of operational plan. Following production causes
often lead to Idle Capacity:-
(a) Repetitive machine adjustment - i) Setup and change-over. ii) Repairs and adjustment
(b) Lack of materials or tools – i) Internal ii) External
(c) Lack of supervision, inspection and instruction
(d) Lack of power – i) Internally produced. ii) Externally produced
Administrative Causes
Sometimes various administrative decisions taken at various level of management result in Idle Capacity.
Major administrative causes that lead to Idle Capacity are: a) Excess plant for anticipated expansion,
b) Special machines prepared for particular jobs, and c) Strikes / Lockouts.
Economic Causes
Sometimes demand for the goods is seasonal as in case of wool, ice cream and furs and production
cannot be evenly distributed. This is especially true, when there exists danger of deterioration of the
product or where carrying charges for stock are too large. Thus, seasonal, cyclical and industrial causes
also lead to Idle Capacity.
Various practices are followed in different companies for disposing of Idle Capacity cost. It is often
agreed in principle that normal production losses should be absorbed in product costs. Abnormal losses
should be treated as non-operating expenses in product costs. Abnormal losses should be treated
as non-operating expenses by direct debit to Profit and Loss Account. Certain companies follow the
practice of computing idle time costs on their leading products by use of statistical techniques. Cost
Accountants should particularly analyse the reasons for idle plant and equipment not used during the
period for non-con-controllable causes. The review of practices of different companies reveals that
Idle Capacity is a somewhat flexible concept. It is an individual problem which should be considered
after taking into account the special situations. For the growth and survival of the organisation, the
management is keenly interested to know the idleness, its causes, its cost and its available remedies.
Normally different companies follow a bit varying restricted accounting concept of Idle Capacity. In
many cases unabsorbed fixed overhead represents losses due to managerial decisions and it becomes
a subjective matter to refer it as idle capacity cost. Overhead rates of different capacity levels will be
different due to influence of fixed overhead.
Absorption of Overheads
Once the steps of primary and secondary distribution are carried out, what we get is total indirect costs
of production departments. The next step is to assign these totals to the individual product units. A job
or a product passes through all or many production departments before it is formed into a finished
saleable product. It is necessary to know the cost of each department it passes through per unit. The
absorption of overhead enables a Cost Accountant to recover the overhead cost spent on each product
department through each unit produced. Overhead absorption is also known as levy or recovery of
overheads. How is this done? Suppose in turning department a total of 1200 tubes are turned and the
cost of turning department overheads (after secondary distribution) are `72000, then can we say the
cost of turning per tube is `6/-? Most probably yes. This `6 per unit is called as Overhead Absorption Rate.
Absorption means ‘recording of overheads in Cost Accounts on an estimated basis with the help of a
predetermined overhead rate, which is computed at normal or average or maximum capacity’
In general, the formula for overhead absorption rate is give as:-
Overhead Rate = Amount of Overhead / No of units of the base
Overhead Absorption Rates: For the purpose of absorption of overhead in costs of jobs, processes,
or products overhead rates related to suitable factors or bases to be determined. There are several
methods in use for determining the overhead rates i.e Actual or Predetermined Overhead Rate, Blanket
or Multiple Rates.
in a highly mechanised factory are mostly related to the number of hours a machine runs. Hence this is
supposed to be the best method for absorbing overhead costs into the cost unit. If a machine normally
runs for 2000 hours in a month and monthly overheads to be absorbed are `15000, then the machine
hour rate will be calculated as (15000/2000) i.e. `7.50 per machine hour. If a job take 75 hours on that
machine, then `562.50 (75 × 7.5) will have to be loaded as cost of using the machine for that job.
A machine hour rate may be calculated using only those overheads which are directly related to the
machine e.g. power, fuel, repairs, maintenance, depreciation etc. These expenses are totalled and
then divided by the hours to compute the rate. This is called as Ordinary Machine Hour Rate. Whereas,
if costs not related to machine are also included (e.g. supervision, rent, lighting, heating etc.) for the
rate calculation, such rate is called as Composite Machine Hour Rate. While calculating machine hour
rate, the wages paid to machine operators may be added to the total costs. This is because these
operators directly wok on the machines & thus related to machine operation. At times a factory may
have more than one similar machines simultaneously working. In such case, a group machine hour rate
may be calculated.
Factors influencing the selection of Overhead Recovery Rate
The particular method or methods selected for application in a company would depend upon the factors
mentioned below. Selection of the most equitable method is of paramount importance since a method
that is not suitable will distort costs and thus make them useless for control and decision making purpose.
Selection of Overhead Recovery Rates depends on the following factors:-
(a) Nature of the product and process of manufacture
(b) Nature of overhead expenses
(c) Organisational set-up of the undertaking into departments and or cost centers
(d) Individual requirements with regard to the circumstances prevailing
(e) Policy of the management
(f) Accuracy vis-a-vis cost of operating the method. Some of the methods are comparatively more
accurate and provide equitable bases for overhead absorption
The main features of a satisfactory overhead rate are as follows:-
(a) Simple, easy to operate, practical and accurate;
(b) Economic in application;
(c) Fairly stable so that cost from period to period does not vary;
(d) Related to time factor as far as practical;
(e) Departmental rates are preferable to blanket rates;
(f) Area of activity selected for computation of the rate should be homogeneous cost unit;
(g) Base for the rate should lay stress on the main production element of the concern.
Under-absorption and Over-absorption of Overhead
The amount of overhead absorbed in costs is the sum total of the overhead costs allotted to individual
cost units by application of the overhead rate. When a predetermined rate worked out on the basis
of anticipated or budgeted overhead and base is applied to the actual base, the amount absorbed
may not be identical with the amount of overhead expenses incurred if either the actual base or the
actual expenses or both deviate from the estimates or the budget.
If the amount absorbed is less than the amount incurred, which may due to actual expenses exceeding
the estimate and / or the output or the hours worked being less than the estimate, the difference denotes
under-absorption.
On the other hand if the amount absorbed is more than the expenditure incurred, which may be due to
the expense being less than estimate and / or the output or hours worked being more than the estimate,
this would indicate over-absorption, which goes to inflate the costs.
Under or over absorption of overhead may arise due to one or the other of the causes given below:-
(a) Error in estimating overhead expenses
(b) Error in estimating the level of production, i.e the base
(c) Major unanticipated changes in the methods of production
(d) Unforeseen changes in the production capacity
(e) Seasonal fluctuations in the overhead expenses from period to period
(f) Overhead rate may be applied to the Normal Capacity which may be less than the full operating
capacity of the undertaking
How does one deal with the situation of over or under absorption? There are three ways to handle it:
(a) Write-off (in case of under absorption) or write back (in case of over-absorption) to the P & L
Account. This treatment is valid if most of the overhead items are related to time.
(b) Carry forward to the next period through a reserve account. This method is not recommended on
the logic that it is inconsistent with Accounting Standards.
(c) Use of supplementary rates to adjust the effect to the cost of sales, finished stocks and Work in
Process stocks. This sounds logical as it does not carry forward the unabsorbed or over absorbed
overheads to the next accounting period entirely. It aims at splitting the total effect between the
cost of sale (which is charged to current year’s profits) and stocks (which get carried forward to
the next year).
Illustration 4
Solution:
l Element wise and behavior wise details of the overheads shall be presented, if material.
l Any under-absorption or over-absorption of overheads shall be presented in the reconciliation
statement.
Disclosure
l The basis of assignment of overheads to the cost objects.
l Overheads incurred in foreign exchange.
l Overheads relating to resources received from or supplied to related parties
l Any Subsidy / Grant / Incentive or any amount of similar nature received / receivable reduced from
overheads.
l Credits / recoveries relating to the overheads.
l Any abnormal cost not forming part of the overheads.
l Any unabsorbed overheads.
Illustration 5
In an Engineering Factory, the following particulars have been extracted for the quarter ended 31st
December, 2015. Compute the departmental overhead rate for each of the production departments,
assuming that overheads are recovered as a percentage of direct wages.
Solution:
Statement showing apportionment of overheads and computation of OH rates: Amount (`)
Particulars Basis Total A B C X Y
Material Actual 45,000 — — — 22,500 22,500
Wages Actual 45,000 — — — 15,000 30,000
Power KWH 1,100 400 300 200 100 100
(4:3:2:1:1)
Lighting Light Points
(5:8:2:3:2) 200 50 80 20 30 20
Stores overhead Materials
(2:4:4:3:3) 800 100 200 200 150 150
Welfare of staff No. of workers
(2:3:3:1:1) 3,000 600 900 900 300 300
Depreciation Assets Value
(6:4:3:1:1) 30,000 12,000 8,000 6,000 2,000 2,000
Repair Assets Value
(6:4:3:1:1) 6,000 2,400 1,600 1,200 400 400
General Over- Direct Wages
heads (2:3:4:1:2) 12,000 2,000 3,000 4,000 1,000 2,000
Rent & Taxes Area
(3:5:1:1:1) 550 150 250 50 50 50
1,43,650 17,700 14,330 12,570 41,530 57,520
Costs of ‘X’ 5:3:2 20,765 12,459 8,306 (41,530) —
Costs of ‘Y’ 2:3:4 12,782 19,173 25,565 — (57,520)
51,247 45,962 46,441 — —
Overhead Rate as % on direct wages
A = [51,247/30,000] x 100 = 170.82%
B = [45,962/45,000] x 100 = 102.14%
C = [46,441/60,000] x 100 = 77.40%
Illustration 6
The New Enterprises Ltd. has three producing departments A,B and C two service Departments D and
E. The following figures are extracted from the records of the Co.
`
Rent and Rates 5,000
General Lighting 600
Indirect Wages 1,500
Power 1,500
Depreciation on Machinery 10,000
Sundries 10,000
The following further details are available:
A B C D E
Floor Space (Sq.Mts.) 2,000 2,500 3,000 2,000 500
Light Points 10 15 20 10 5
Direct Wages 3,000 2,000 3,000 1,500 500
H.P. of machines 60 30 50 10 --
Working hours 6,226 4,028 4,066 -- --
Value of Material 60,000 80,000 1,00,000 -- --
Value of Assets 1,20,000 1,60,000 2,00,000 10,000 10,000
The expenses of D and E are allocated as follows:
A B C D E
D 20% 30% 40% -- 10%
E 40% 20% 30% 10% --
What is the factory cost of an article if its raw material cost is `50, labour cost `30 and it passes through
Departments A, B and C. For 4, 5 & 3 hours respectively.
Solution:
Statement showing apportionment of overheads to departments Amount (`)
d = 4625 + 10/100 e
e = 1575 + 10/100 d
⇒ 100 d = 462500 + 10 e
⇒ 100 e = 157500 + 10 d
990e = 2037500
e = 2037500 / 990
= 2,058
Particulars A B C D E
Totals 7,550 7,200 9,650 4,625 1,575
Costs of D (2:3:4:1) (4831) 966 1,450 1,932 (4,831) 483
Costs of E (4:2:3:1) (2,058) 823 412 617 206 (2058)
9,339 9,062 12,199 -- --
Illustration 7
The following information relates to the activities of a production department of factory for a certain
period.
Amount (`)
Material used 36,000
Direct Wages 30,000
Labour hours 12,000
Hours of Machinery-operation 20,000
Overhead Chargeable to the Dept 25,000
On one order carried out in the department during the period the relevant data were:-
Material used (`) 6,000
Direct Wages (`) 4,950
Labour hours worked 1,650 Hrs.
Machine Hours 1,200
Calculate the overheads chargeable to the job by four commonly used methods.
Solution:
The four commonly used methods of absorbing or recovering overheads are as follows:
1. % of overheads on material = (25,000 / 36,000) x 100 = 69.44%
2. % of overheads on direct wages = (25,000 / 30,000) x 100 = 83.33%
3. Overhead rate per labour hour = 25,000 / 12,000 = 2.083
4. Machine hour rate method = 25,000 / 20,000 = 1.25
The overheads chargeable to job under the above methods is as follows:
1. Material = 6,000 x 69.44% = 4,166.40
2. Wages = 4,950 x 83.33% = 4,125
3. Labour hour rate = 1650 x 2.083 = ` 3,437
4. Machine hour rate = 1,200 x 1.25 = ` 1,500
Illustration 8
In a machine department of a factory there are five identical machines. From the particulars given
below; prepare the machine hour rate for one of the machines.
Space of the department 10,000 sq.mts.
Space occupied by the machine 2,000 sq.mts.
Cost of the machine (`) 20,000
Scrap value of the machine (`) 300
Estimated life of the machine 13 years
Depreciation charged at 7½ % p.a
Normal running of the machine 2,000 hours
Power consumed by the machine as shown by the meter 3,000 p.a
Estimated repairs and maintenance throughout the working life of the machine (`) 5,200 Sundry
supplies including oil, waste etc. charged direct to the machine amount to ` 600 p.a.
Other expenses of the department are : Amount (`)
Rent and Rates 9,000
Lighting (to be apportioned according to workers employed) 400
Supervision 1,250
Other charges 5,000
It is ascertained that the degree of supervision required by the machine is 2/5th and 3/5th being devoted
to other machines.
There are 16 workers in the department of whom 4 attended to the machine and the remaining to the
other machines.
Solution:
Computation of Machine Hour Rate Amount (`)
Illustration 9
From the following particulars given below compute Machine hour rate for a machine.
a. Cost ` 24,000
b. Scrap value ` 4,000
c. Estimated Working life 40,000 hours
d. Estimated cost of repairs and maintenance during the whole life `2,000
e. Standard charges of the shop for 4 weekly period ` 3,000
f. Working hours in 4 weekly period 100 hours
g. No.of machines in the shop each of which is liable for equal charge are 30 machines.
h. Power used per hour 4 units @ 10p. per unit.
Solution:
Computation of Machine Hour Rate Amount (`)
Machine Expenses
Depreciation [(10,000 – 1,000)/10]÷ 1900 = 0.47
Maintenance (1,200 / 1,900) = 0.63
Power (16 x 0.1) = 1.60 2.70
Machine Hour Rate = 4.52
Illustration 11
Your company uses a historical cost system and applies overheads on the basis of “Predetermined”
rates. The following are the figures from the Trial Balance as at 30-9-2015:
Dr. (`) Cr. (`)
Manufacturing overheads 4,26,544 ---
Manufacturing overheads-applied --- 3,65,904
Work-in-progress 1,41,480 ---
Finished Goods Stock 2,30,732 ---
Cost of Goods Sold 8,40,588 ---
Give two methods for the disposal of the under absorbed overheads and show the profit implications
of the method.
Solution:
`
Overheads incurred = 4,26,544
Overheads absorbed = 3,65,904
Under absorption = 60,640
The following are the 3 methods for disposing off this under absorbed overheads:
1. Transferring to the costing P & L A/c under this method, the profit will decrease by ` 60,640.
2. The amount may be disposed off by carrying forward to the next year. In this case, there will be no
effect on profit.
3. Applying Supplementary Overhead Rate and further absorbing, which may be shown as follows.
Under this method also, the profit will decrease by ` 60,640.
=
5%
Amount (`)
Suppl. OH (5%) Total
Work in Progress 1,41,480 7,074 1,48,554
Finished Goods 2,30,732 11,537 2,42,269
Cost of goods sold 8,40,588 42,029 8,82,617
12,12,800 60,640 12,73,440
Illustration 12
In a factory the expenses of factory are charged on a fixed percentage basis on wages and office
overhead expenses are calculated on the basis of percentage of works cost.
I Order (`) II Order (`)
Material 12,500 18,000
Wages 10,000 14,000
Selling price 44,850 61,880
Percentage of profit on cost 15% 12%
Find the rate of Factory OH and Office OH.
Solution:
Let ‘X’ and ‘Y’ be the % of Works Overhead on wages and Office Overhead on works cost respectively.
Particulars Order I Order II
Material 12,500 18,000
Wages 10,000 14,000
Prime Cost 22,500 32,000
(+) Factory OH’s (10,000 x X/100) = 100X (14,000 x X/100) = 140X
Works Cost 22,500 + 100X 32,000 + 140X
(+) Office Overheads
[(100 X + 22,500) x Y/100] XY + 225Y 1.4XY + 320Y
[(140 X + 32,000) x Y/100]
Total Cost 100X + XY + 225Y + 22,500 140X + 1.4XY + 320Y + 32,000
Cost 44,850 x (100/115) = 39,000 61,880 x (100/112) = 55,250
100X + XY + 225Y + 22,500 = 39,000
⇒ 100X + XY + 225Y = 16,500 → Equ. (1)
140X + 1.4XY + 320Y + 32,000 = 55,250
⇒ 140X + 1.4XY + 320Y = 23,250 → Equ. (2)
Equ. (1) x 1.4 ⇒ 140X + 1.4XY + 315Y = 23,100
Equ. (2) ⇒ 140X + 1.4XY + 320Y = 23,250
(–) (–) (–) (–)
5Y = 150
Therefore, Y = 150/50 = 30
Substituting the value of Y in Equ. (1), we get X
100X + 30X + 225 x 30= 16,500 → Equ. (1)
130X + 6750 = 16,500
130X = 9,750
X = 9,750/130 = 75
% of Factory OH on wages = 75%
% of Office OH on works cost = 30%
Illustration 13
Self-help Ltd. has gensets and produced its own power Data for power costs are as follows :-
Solution:
Statement Showing apportionment of power cost and computation of cost per hour Amount (`)
Illustration 14
At Ltd engineering Co. having 25 different types of automatic machines, furnishes you the following
data for 2016-17 in respect of machine B:
1. Cost of the machine ` 50,000
Life - 10 years Scrap value is nil
2. Overhead expenses are:
Factory Rent ` 50,000 p.a.
Heating and Lighting ` 40,000
Supervision ` 1,50,000 p.a
Reserve equipment of machine B ` 5,000 p.a.
Area of the factory 80,000 sq.ft.
Area occupied by machine B 3,000 sq.ft.
3. Wages of operator is `24 per day of 8 hours including all fringe benefits. He attends to one machine
when it is under set up and two machines while under operation.
Solution:
Computation of machine hour rate when machine is in operation
Illustration 15
Ganges Printing Co. has three operating departments:
1. Printing and Binding
2. Lithographing and
3. Engraving.
The company has a job order cost system using a single predetermined expense rate. The management
has been made aware of the deficiencies of using such a rate and is now interested in departmentalising
factory overhead. A study reveals that:
Department 1 has 3 similar machines representing a large investment and calling for high repairs and
depreciation charges.
Department 2 has the workers perform similar tasks and are therefore paid the same hourly wage.
Department 3 however has several classes of workers, each group being paid the same hourly wage.
The estimated factory overhead and production data costs are as follows
Printing & Litho- Engraving
Binding Graphing
Factory overhead (`) 40,000 68,750 1,20,000
Direct labour hours 10,000 20,000 40,000
Direct labour cost (`) 25,000 55,000 80,000
Machine hours 20,000 NIL NIL
Required:
1) An analysis to advice the management regarding the types of rates to be used in these departments.
2) A computation of the rates recommenced.
Solution:
1. It is appropriate to use machine hour rate method of absorbing overheads in Dept 1 because there
is large investment in machine and therefore they are predominant.
OH rate per machine hour = 40,000 / 20,000 = ` 2 per hour.
2. In Dept 2, it is better and appropriate to use labour hour rate of overheads because all the workers
are paid at uniform wage rate.
OH rate per labour hour = 68,750 / 20,000 = ` 3.4375 per hour.
3. In Dept 3, it is better and appropriate to use overhead rate based on certain % of wages because
workers are paid at different rates.
OH % on wages = (1,20,000 / 80,000) x 100 = 150%
Illustration 16
For a department the standard overhead rate is `2.50 per hour and the overhead allowances are as
follows:
Activity Level (Hours) Budget overhead Allowance (`)
3,000 10,000
7,000 18,000
11,000 26,000
Calculate:
a) Fixed cost
b) The standard activity level on the basis of which the standard overhead rate has been worked out.
Solution:
(a) Fixed Cost
Variable OH per hour = High level cost – Low level cost.
High level hours – Low level hours
= [(26,000-10,000) / (11,000-3,000)]
= ` 2 per hour
(b) Standard activity level at which the rate has been determined
Illustration 17
In a certain factory three products are made from different materials by similar process. For a typical
period production costs are as under: Amount (`)
Product A Product B Product C
Material used 1,600 2,000 800
Direct labour cost 1,200 1,000 400
Overhead (actual) 800 650 350
Overhead is charged to cost of each product at the rate of 25% on prime cost.
Do you see anything wrong in principle in this method of charging overheads? If so, suggest a preferable
method.
Solution:
Since, different materials are used for producing products, it is advisable, preferable and appropriate
to use the method of absorbing overheads based on % of materials instead of % on prime cost which
is shown as follows:
Amount (`)
A B C
Materials 1,600 2,000 800
Labour 1,200 1,000 400
Prime Cost 2,800 3,000 1,200
OH @ 25% on prime cost 700 750 300
% of OH on Material Cost:
Illustration 18
A company produced a simple product in three sizes A, B and C. Prepare a statement showing the
selling and distribution expenses apportioned over these three sizes applying the appropriate basis for
such apportionment in each case from the particulars indicated:
Express the total of the costs so apportioned to each size as:
a) Cost per unit sold (nearest paise)
b) A percentage of sales turnover (nearest to two places for decimal).
Particulars A B C
a) Cost per unit sold (16,634/3,400) x 100 (22,456/4,000) x 100 (15,302/3,000) x 100
= 4.89 = 5.614 = 5.10
b) % on sales (16,634/58,000) x 100 (22,456/80,000) x 100 (15,302/62,000) x 100
= 28.67% = 28.07 = 24.68
Working :
A B C
Volume of cu. ft. per unit of finished products 5 8 17
Units sold 3,400 4,000 3,000
Total volume of cu. ft. 17,000 32,000 51,000
Illustration 19
For a production department of a manufacturing company you are required to :
(a) Prepare a fixed budget of overhead;
(b) Prepare a flexible budget of overhead, at 70% and 110% of budget volume;
(c) Calculate a departmental hourly rate of overhead absorption as per (a) and (b) above.
The budgeted level of activity of the department is 5,000 hours per period and the study of the various
items of expenditure reveals the following :
Amount (`) ` per hour
Indirect wages 0.40
Repairs upto 2,000 hours 100
for each additional 500 hours
upto a total of 4,000 hours 35
Additional from 4,001 to 5,000 hours 60
Additional above 5,000 hours 70
Rent and Rates 350
Power Upto 3,600 hours 0.25
for hours above 3,600 0.20
Consumable supplies 0.24
Supervision Upto 2,500 hours 400
Additional for each extra 600 hours
above 2,500 and upto 4,900 hours 100
Additional above 4,900 hours 150
Depreciation upto 5,000 hours 650
above 5,000 hours and upto 6,500 hours 820
Cleaning upto 4,000 hours 60
above 4,000 hours 80
Heat and from 2,100 hours to 3,500 hours 120
lighting from 3,500 hours to 5,000 hours 150
above 5,000 hours 175
Solution:
Fixed and Flexible Budget showing overhead cost per hour: Amount (`)
Illustration 20
In a manufacturing unit, overhead was recovered at a predetermined rate of `25 per man-day. The total
factory overhead incurred and the man-days actually worked were ` 41,50,000 and 1,50,000 respectively.
Out of the 40,000 units produced during a period 30,000 units were sold. There were also 30,000
uncompleted units which may be reckoned at 66.67% complete.
On analysing the reasons, it was found that 40% of the unabsorbed overheads were due to defective
planning and the rest were attributable to increase overhead costs.
How would unabsorbed overhead be treated in Cost Accounts?
Solution:
Amount (`)
Overheads incurred = 41,50,000
Overheads absorbed (1,50,000 x 25) = 37,50,000
Under absorption = 4,00,000
The under absorption of ` 4,00,000 being considerable whether due to defective planning or due to
increase in prices, would be disposed off by applying supplementary OH rate in the following manner:
4,00,000
Supplementary OH rate =
30,000 + 10,000 + (30,000 × 23 )
GLOSSARY
Administrative Overheads: Administrative overheads are the cost of management, secretarial,
accounting and administrative services, which cannot be directly related to the production, marketing,
research and development functions of the enterprise. CAS- 3 defines administrative overheads as the
cost of all activities relating to general management and administration of an organisation.
Blanket Overhead Rates: Blanket overhead rate refers to the computation of one single overhead rate
for the whole factory.
Overhead Costs for the whole factory
Blanket overhead rate = ×100
Total units of the selected base
Classification of Overheads: Classification of Overheads is defined by CIMA as the arrangement of items
in logical groups having regard to their nature (subjective classification) or the purpose to be fulfilled
(objective classification).
Cost Allocation: CIMA defines cost allocation as the charging of discrete, identifiable items of cost to
cost centres or cost units. It is the complete distribution of an item of overhead to the departments or
products on logical or equitable basis. In other words, cost allocation is that part of cost attribution which
charges specific cost to a cost centre or cost unit.
Cost Apportionment: Cost apportionment is that part of cost attribution which shares costs among
two or more cost centres or cost units in proportion to the estimated benefit received. In other words,
distribution of various items of overheads in proportion to the departments or products on logical or
equitable basis is called cost apportionment.
Direct Distribution Method: Under direct distribution method service department costs are apportioned
over the production departments only, ignoring the services rendered by one service department to
the other.
Direct Labour Hour Rate: Direct labour hour rate is the rate calculated by dividing the budgeted or
estimated overhead cost attributable to a cost centre by the appropriate number of direct labour hours
expected to be incurred at normal capacity.
Distribution Overheads: CAS-3 defines distribution overheads as the cost incurred in handling a product
from the time it is ready for despatch until it reaches the ultimate consumer.
Excess Capacity: Excess capacity refers to that portion of practical capacity which is available, but no
attempt is made for its utilisation for strategic or other reasons.
Fixed Overheads/ Period Costs: Fixed overheads are the costs that remain fixed or constant irrespective
of the volume of output or activity. Fixed costs are considered as period costs e.g. rent, salaries, etc.
Idle Capacity: Idle capacity is that part of practical capacity which is not utilised due to factors like
temporary lack of orders, bottlenecks and machine breakdown, etc.
Idle Time: Idle time is the period of time for which the shop floor is available for production but is not
utilised due to shortage of materials, tools, operators, etc. In other words, idle time represents lost time
of men and machines arising from lack of business or of material, a breakdown of equipment, faulty
supervision or other similar causes whether avoidable or not.
Indirect Expenses: Indirect expenses are the expenses which are not charged directly to a product e.
g. insurance, rates and taxes etc. CAS-3 defines indirect expenses as the expenses which cannot be
directly attributed to a particular cost object.
Indirect Labour: Indirect labour costs are the costs which are not charged directly to a product e.g.
supervision. CAS-3 defines indirect labour cost as the employee costs which cannot be directly attributed
to a particular cost object.
Indirect Materials: Indirect materials cost are the material cost which are not charged directly to a
product e. g. cotton waste, cleaning materials etc. CAS-3 defines indirect material cost as the cost
which cannot be directly attributed to a particular cost object.
Machine Hour Rate: Machine hour rate is the rate calculated by dividing the budgeted or estimated
overhead or labour and overhead cost attributable to a machine or group of similar machines by the
appropriate number of machine hours.
Manufacturing Overheads: CAS- 3 defines manufacturing overheads as the indirect expenses incurred
for manufacturing product units.
Maximum Capacity: Maximum capacity or the ideal capacity is the capacity for which plant is designed
to operate. It does not give allowance for waiting, delays and shut-down.
Overhead Cost: Overhead Cost is the total cost of indirect material, indirect labour, and indirect expenses.
CAS- 3 defines overheads as the cost of indirect materials, indirect employees and indirect expense
which are not directly identifiable or allocable to a cost object in an economically feasible manner.
Reciprocal Service Method: Reciprocal service method is used when different service departments
render services to each other, in addition to rendering services to production departments. In such
cases various services departments have to share overheads of each other.
Research and Development overheads: Research cost is the cost of searching for new or improved
products, new applications of material, or new or improved methods, process, systems or services.
Development cost is the cost of the process which begins with the implementation of the decision to
use scientific or technical knowledge to produce a new or improved product or to employ a new or
improved method, process, system, etc, and ends which the commencement of formal production of
that product by that method.
Selling Overheads: CAS-3 defines selling overheads as the expenses related to sale of products and
include all indirect expenses in sales management for the organisation.
Semi-Variable Overheads: Semi-variable overheads are the mixed or hybrid costs partly fixed and partly
variable costs, e.g. Telephone charges.
Variable Overheads: Variable overheads are the costs which vary totally in direct proportion to the
volume of output. These costs fluctuate in total amount but tend to remain constant per unit as production
activity changes.
17. “While manufacturing overheads are part of costs, selling overheads are result of policy”.
Comment.
18. “Management’s interest in overheads is not in the method of their absorption but in their behaviour
under various conditions of production” As a CMA please throw light on the above statement.
19. Distinguish between cost allocation and cost absorption.
20. Discuss the methods of re-apportionment of service department expenses over the production
departments.
PRACTICE PROBLEMS
21. The ‘Prabhat Ltd.’ is divided into two production cost centers A and B, and two service cost centers
X and Y. The following is the summary of overhead costs for a particular period. Works Manager’s
Salary `4,000; Power `21,000; Contribution to PF `9,000; Rent `6,000; Plant Maintenance `4,000.
Canteen expenditure `12,,000; Depreciation of Plant and Machinery ` 20,000.
The following information is made available from the various departments.
DEPT.A DEPT. B DEPT. X DEPT. Y
No. of Employees 16 8 4 4
Area Sq. Ft. 2,000 3,000 500 500
Value of Plant (`) 75,000 1,00,000 25,000 —
Wages (`) 40,000 20,000 10,000 5,000
Horse Power 3 3 1 —
Apportion the costs to the various departments on the most equitable basis.
[Ans: A : ` 32,800; B : ` 30,400; X : ` 9,700; Y : ` 3,100]
22. In a factory there 5 machines, you are required to calculate Machine hour rate from the following
data.
Space of the Departments 8,000 Sq.ft.
Cost of machine (`) 20,000
Space occupied by each machine 1,600 Sq.ft.
Power consumed as indicated by meter is `3,000 p.a. for this machine.
Depreciation 7 ½ % p.a
Estimated life 10 years (working hours 2,000 p.a)
Estimated Repairs p.a. for this machine ` 520
Rent & Rates 9,000+
Lighting 750+ for all machines
Supervision 1,500
Other charges 4,000+
2/5 of the supervision is for this machine. There are three mechanics drawing ` 50, `60, `70 p.m
respectively.
[Ans: Machine hour rate ` 4.401]
23. You are required to calculate the machine hour rate from the following particulars.
a. Cost of the machine `10,000/- its estimated working life is 10 years and the estimated scrap
value at the end of its life is ` 1,000. The estimated working time per year (50 weeks of 40 hours
each) is 2,000 hours.
b. Electricity used by the machine is 16 units per hour at the cost of `0.10 per unit.
c. The machine requires a chemical solution which is replaced at the end of each week at cost
of `20/- each time.
d. The estimated cost of maintenance per year is `1,200.
e. Two attendants control the operation of the machine together with five other identical machines
their combined week wages amount to `120.
f. Departmental and General works overheads allocated to the machine for the year were
`2,000. [Ans: Machine hour rate : ` 4.65]
24. XYZ manufactures household pumps which pass through three departments viz. Foundry, Machine
Shop and Assembling.
The manufacturing expenses are as follows:
Foundry Machine Assembling Total
` ` ` `
Direct wages 10,000 50,000 10,000 70,000
Works Overhead 5,000 90,000 10,000 1,05,000
The factory cost of manufacturing a type of ‘C’ pump was prepared by the company as follows:
`
Material 16
Wages: Foundry 2
Machine Shop 4
Assembling 2
8
Works Overhead:
150% of Direct Wages 12
36
It seems that there is some fallacy. Try to correct it. [Ans: Correct Factory cost ` 34.20]
25. The following are the maintenance costs incurred in a machine shop for six months with corresponding
machine hours.
MONTH MACHINE HOURS MAINTENANCE COSTS (`)
January 2,000 300
February 2,200 320
March 1,700 270
April 2,400 340
May 1,800 280
June 1,900 290
12,000 1,800
Analyse the Machine cost which is semi variable into fixed and variable element.
[Ans: Variable cost per machine hour = ` 0.10; Fixed cost ` 100]
26. From the following data segregate fixed cost and variable costs.
Level of Activity
Capacity (%) 80 100
Labour Hours 400 500
Maintenance expenses of a plant (`) 2,600 2,750
[Ans: Variable Cost per hour ` 1.5; Fixed Cost ` 2,000]
27. In a factory, there are two service departments P and Q and three production departments A,
B and C. In April 2015, the departmental expenses were:
Departments A B C P Q
` 6,50,000 6,00,000 5,00,000 1,20,000 1,00,000
The service department expenses are allotted on a percentage basis as follows:
Amount (`)
Direct material 45,000
Direct wages 60,000
Overheads 90,000
Direct labour hours 15,000
Machine hours 30,000
Find out the overhead recovery rate based on at least five different possible methods of absorption
of overheads.
[Ans: Direct Material Cost method 200%; Direct Labour Cost Method 150%; Prime Cost Method
85.71%; Direct Labour Hour Rate Method ` 6; Machine Hour Rate Method ` 3]
29. The following particulars were extracted from the records of Epsilon Ltd. on 31st December:
How would you deal with the balances under or over-absorbed? What preliminaries enquiries would
you make?
[Ans: Dept. A Over-absorbed ` 200
Dept. B under-absorbed ` 100
Dept. C Under-absorbed ` 250]
30. The overhead expenses of a factory are allowed on the machine hour method. You are required
to calculate the hourly rate for a certain machine from the following information:
Cost ` 58,000
Estimated scrap value ` 3,000
Estimated working life 20,000 hours
Estimated cost of maintenance during working life of machine ` 12,000
Power used for machine ` 1 per hour
Rent, rates etc. per month (10% to be charged for this machine) ` 1,500
Normal machine running hours during a month 180 hours
Standing charges other than rent, rates etc. per month ` 200
[Ans: ` 6.30]
2. Packing cost is a
A. Production of cost
B. Selling cost
C. Distribution cost
D. It may be any or the above
4. Charging to a cost center those overheads that result solely for the existence of that cost Center
is known as
A. Allocation
B. Apportionment
C. Absorption
D. Allotment
5. Absorption means
A. Charging or overheads to cost centers
B. Charging or overheads to cost units
C. Charging or overheads to cost centers or cost units
6. Which method of absorption of factory overheads do you suggest in a concern which Produces
only one uniform time of product
A. Percentage of direct wages basis
B. Direct labour rate
C. Machine hour rate
D. A rate per units of output
8. When the amount of overhead absorbed is less than the amount of overhead incurred, It is called
A. Under- absorption of overhead
B. Over-absorption of overhead
C. Proper absorption of overhead
14. Find out from the following a scientific and accurate method of factory overhead absorption:
A. Percentage of prime cost method
B. Machine hour rate method
C. Percentage of direct material cost method
D. Percentage of direct labour cost method
E. None of the above
[Ans: A, D, B, A , B, D, B, A, C, D, D, A, C, B]
1. Departments that assist producing Department indirectly are called service departments.
4. When actual overhead are more than absorbed overheads, it is known as over-absorption.
7. A blanket overhead rate is a single overhead rate computed for the entire factory.
8. Under-absorption of overhead means that actual overhead are more than absorbed overhead.
9. The principal based used for applying factory overhead are: units of production, material cost,
direct wages, direct labour hours and machine hours.
10. Allocation, for overhead implies the identification of overhead cost centres to which they relate.
4. The difference between actual and absorbed factory overhead is called ___________________.
5. The term used for charging of overheads to cost units is known as _______________.
6. The difference between practical capacity and the capacity based on sales expectancy is
known as ________________.
7. The __________ rate is computed by dividing the overheads by the aggregate of the productive
hours of direct workers.
8. Under or over absorption of overheads arises only when overheads are absorbed by
____________________.
9. Overhead incurred ` 16,000 and overhead absorbed ` 15,300. There is under absorption of
`___________.
[Ans: Indirect material Indirect Labour and Indirect Expenses, Repair and Maintenance and
replacement of Components, Works Cost, under or over absorbed overheads, absorptions, idle
capacity, direct labour hour, predetermined overheads rates, ` 700, Fixed cost]
[Ans: E, D, B, F, C,A]
The council of the Institute of Cost Accountants of India, has constituted ‘Cost Accounting Standards
Board’ (CASB) with the objective of formulating Cost Accounting Standards, after recognizing the
need for structured approach to the measurement of cost so as to provide guidance to the user
organizations, government bodies, regulators, research agencies, academic institutions and others to
achieve uniformity and consistency in classification, measurement and assignment of costs.
The composition of the CASB will be broad based and ensure participation of all interest groups in the
standard setting process. The chairman of the CASB will be nominated by the council of the Institute.
Apart from six members of the council nominated on the CASB the following will be represented on
the CASB :-
(b) Adviser (Cost), Cost Audit Branch, Ministry of Corporate Affairs, Government of India
(c) A nominee of the Central Government representing the Central Board of Indirect Taxes and
Customs, Government of India
(d) A nominee of the Central Government representing the Central Board of Direct Taxes
(f) Four nominees from regulators i.e. CAG, RBI, SEBI, IRDA,TRAI...etc.
(g) Two nominees from professional institutions i.e. ICAI and ICSI
(i) Two nominees from academic institutions like IIM, MDI, Universities...etc.
(k) President is authorized to include a maximum of two eminent persons having knowledge and
expertise in the Cost and Management Accounting / Accounting Standards not falling under the
categories as defined in the constitution.
The objectives of the CASB are to develop high quality Cost Accounting Standards to enable the
management to take informed decisions and to enable regulators to function more effectively by
integrating, harmonizing and standardizing Cost Accounting Principles and Practices.
The following will be the functions of the CASB :-
(a) To issue the framework for the Cost Accounting Standards
(b) To equip the Cost & Management Accounting professionals with better guide lines on cost
Accounting Principles
(c) To assists the members in preparation of uniform cost statements under various statutes
(d) To provide from time to time interpretations on Cost Accounting Standards
(e) To issue application guidance relating to particular standard
(f) To propagate the Cost Accounting Standards and to persuade the users to adopt them in the
preparation and presentation of general purpose Cost Statement
(g) To persuade the government and appropriate authorities to enforce Cost Accounting Standards,
to facilitate the adoption thereof, by industry and corporate entities in order to achieve the desired
objectives of standardization of Cost Accounting Practices
(h) To educate the users about the utility and the need for compliance of Cost Accounting
Standards
Overview of Cost Accounting Standards issued till date are as follows:
CAS 10 Direct Expenses To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
methods of determining the Direct Expenses with reasonable
accuracy
CAS 11 Administrative Overheads To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
methods of determining the Administrative Overheads with
reasonable accuracy
CAS 12 Repairs and Maintenance To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Cost methods of determining the Repairs and Maintenance Cost
with reasonable accuracy
CAS 13 Cost of Service Cost To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Centre methods of determining the Cost of Service Cost Centre with
reasonable accuracy
CAS 14 Pollution Control Cost To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
methods of determining the Pollution Control Costs with
reasonable accuracy
CAS 15 Selling and Distribution To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
overheads methods of determining the selling and Distribution over- heads
with reasonable accuracy
CAS 16 Depreciation and To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Amortisation methods of determining the Depreciation and Amortisation
with reasonable accuracy
CAS 17 Interest and Financing To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles, methods of
Charges. determining and assigning the Interest and Financing Charges
with reasonable accuracy
CAS 18 Research and To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Development Costs methods of determining the Research, and Development Costs
with reasonable accuracy and presentation of the same.
CAS 19 Joint Costs To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
methods of determining the Joint Costs.
CAS 20 Cost Accounting To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Standard on Royalty and methods of determining the amount of Royalty and Technical
Technical Know- How Fee Know-how Fee with reasonable accuracy
CAS 21 Cost Accounting To bring uniformity, consistency in the principles, methods of
Standard on Quality determining and assigning Quality Control cost with reasonable
Control accuracy
CAS 22 Cost Accounting To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Standard on methods of determining the Manufacturing Cost of excisable
Manufacturing Cost goods
CAS 23 Cost Accounting To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Standard on Overburden methods of determining and assigning Overburden Removal
Removal Cost Cost including those requiring attestation
CAS 24 Cost Accounting To bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and
Standard on Treatment methods for treatment of revenue in cost statements with
of Revenue in Cost reasonable accuracy
Statements
*Limited Revision 2017 [CAS 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16, 17, 20, 21, 22, 23 & 24]
Each of the Cost Accounting standards has been explained in brief as follows
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles of Classification of
Cost for disclosure and presentation in the cost statements of a product or service.
Scope
This standard shall be applied to cost statements, which require classification, presentation and
disclosure of cost including those requiring attestation.
Classification of Costs
(c) By function
Installed capacity:
Installed capacity is usually determined based on:
(i) Technical specifications of facility
(ii) Technical evaluation
(iii) Capacities of individual or interrelated production or operation Centres
(iv) Operational constraints or capacity of critical machines or equipment
(v) Number of shifts or machine hours or man hours
Normal Capacity:
Normal capacity is determined after suitable adjustments to the Installed Capacity.
The adjustments may be of the following nature:
(i) Time lost due to scheduled preventive or planned maintenance
(ii) Number of shifts or machine hours or man hours
(iii) Holidays, normal shut down days, normal idle time
(iv) Normal time lost in batch change over
Cost Accounting Standard 4 (CAS-4) was issued to specify the principles for determination of cost of
production for valuation of goods meant for captive consumption, as required under the Central Excise
Valuation (Determination of Price of Excisable Goods) Rules 2000. CBEC, vide circular No. 692/8/2003-
CX dated 13-2-2003 had clarified that in case of captive consumption, cost calculation should be as
per CAS-4 only.
With the introduction of Goods and Services Tax [GST] with effect from July 1, 2017, the concept of
‘captive consumption’ is no more relevant for computing the tax incidence. However, the concept of
cost of production or manufacture is relevant under the GST laws where the value of supply of goods
or services or both are determined based on cost.
Objective
The objective of this Standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the cost of production or acquisition or supply of goods or provision of services as required
under the provisions of GST Acts/Rules.
Scope
This standard should be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation, and disclosure of related costs for determination of the following under the
relevant provisions of GST Acts/Rules.
The Cost Accounting Principles for tracing/identifying an element of cost, its allocation/apportionment
to a product or service are well established. Transportation Cost is an important element of cost
for procurement of materials for production and for distribution of product for sale. Therefore, Cost
Accounting Records should present transportation cost separately from the other cost of inward
materials or cost of sales of finished goods. The Finance Act 2003 also specifies the certification
requirement of Transportation Cost for claiming deduction while arriving at the assessable value of
excisable goods cleared for home consumption/ export. There is a need to standardize the record
keeping of expenses relating to transportation and computation of Transportation Cost.
Objective
(a) To bring uniformity in the application of principles and methods used in the determination of
averaged/equalized Transportation Cost
(b) To prescribe the system to be followed for maintenance of records for collection of cost of
transportation, its allocation/apportionment to cost centres, locations or products
(c) To provide transparency in the determination of cost of transportation
Scope
This standard should be applied for calculation of cost of transportation required under any statute or
regulations or for any other purpose. For example, this standard can be used for :
(a) Determination of average transportation cost for claiming the deduction for arriving at the
assessable value of excisable goods
(b) Insurance claim valuation
(c) Working out claim for freight subsidy under Fertilizer Industry Coordination Committee
(d) Administered price mechanism of freight cost element
(e) Determination of inward freight costs included or to be included in the cost of purchases
attributable to the acquisition
(f) Computation of freight included in the value of inventory for accounting on inventory or valuation
of stock hypothecated with Banks / Financial Institution ...etc.
deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment of Cost of
Utilities, for determination of the cost of product or service and the presentation and disclosure in Cost
Statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Cost of Utilities with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard shall be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement, assignment,
presentation and disclosure of Cost of Utilities including those requiring attestation.
For determining the cost of production to arrive at an assessable value of excisable utilities used for
captive consumption, Cost Accounting Standard 4 on Cost of Production for Captive Consumption
(CAS 4) shall apply. This standard shall not be applicable to the organizations primarily engaged in
generation and sale of utilities. This standard does not cover issues related to the ascertainment and
treatment of carbon credits, which shall be dealt with in a separate standard.
CAS-9: Cost Accounting Standard on Packing Material Cost [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining the Packing Material Cost. This
standard deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment of
Packing Material Cost, for determination of the cost of product, and the presentation and disclosure
in Cost Statements. Packing Materials for the purpose of this standard are classified into primary and
secondary packing materials.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the packing material cost with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard should be applied to cost statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Packing Material Cost including those requiring attestation.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Administrative Overheads with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
The standard should be applied to Cost Statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Administrative Overheads including those requiring
attestation.
CAS-12: Cost Accounting Standard on Repairs and Maintenance [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining the Repairs and Maintenance Cost.
This standard deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment of
Repairs and Maintenance Cost, for determination of the cost of product or service, and the presentation
and disclosure in Cost Statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Repairs and Maintenance Cost with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
The standard should be applied to Cost Statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Repairs and Maintenance Cost including those requiring
attestation.
CAS-13: Cost Accounting Standard on Cost of Service Cost Centre [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining Cost of Service Cost Centres.
This standard covers the service cost centre and excludes utilities and repair & maintenance costs
dealt with in CAS - 8 & CAS 12 respectively. This standard deals with the principles and methods of
classification, measurement and assignment of Cost of Service Cost Centre, for determination of the
cost of product or service, and the presentation and disclosure in Cost Statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Cost of Service Cost Centre with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
The standard should be applied to the preparation & presentation Cost Statements, which require
classification, measurement and assignment, of Cost of Service Cost Centres including those requiring
attestation.
CAS-14: Cost Accounting Standard on Pollution Control Cost [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining Pollution Control Cost. This standard
deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment of Pollution
Control Costs, for determination of the cost of product or service, and the presentation and disclosure
in Cost Statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Pollution Control Costs with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
The standard should be applied to Cost Statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Pollution Control Costs including those requiring attestation.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Selling and Distribution Overheads with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard should be applied to cost statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Selling and Distribution Overheads including those requiring
attestation.
CAS -16 : Cost Accounting Standard on Depreciation and Amortisation [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining Depreciation and Amortisation
Cost.
This standard deals with the principles and methods of measurement and assignment of Depreciation
and Amortisation for determination of the cost of product or service, and the presentation and
disclosure in cost statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the Depreciation and Amortisation with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard shall be applied to cost statements which require measurement, assignment, presentation
and disclosure of Depreciation and Amortisation, including those requiring attestation.
CAS-17 : Cost Accounting Standard on Interest and Financing Charges [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining Interest and Financing Charges.
This standard deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment of
Interest and Financing Charges.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles ,methods of
determining and assigning the Interest and Financing Charges with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard should be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Interest and Financing Charges including those requiring
attestation. This standard does not deal with costs relating to risk management through derivatives.
CAS-20 : Cost Accounting Standard on Royalty And Technical Know-How Fee [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of determining the amount of Royalty and Technical
Know-how Fee.
This standard deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement and assignment
of the amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee, for determination of the cost of product or
service, and their presentation and disclosure in cost statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods of
determining the amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard should be applied to cost statements, which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of the amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee
including those requiring attestation.
Scope
The standards shall be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of Quality Control cost including those requiring attestation.
CAS 23 Cost Accounting Standard on Overburden Removal Cost [Limited Revision 2017]
The standard deals with the principles and methods of measurement and assignment of Overburden
Removal Cost and the presentation and disclosure in cost statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity, consistency in the principles, methods of determining
and assigning Overburden Removal Cost with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
The standard shall be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement, assignment,
presentation and disclosure of Overburden Removal Cost including those requiring attestation.
CAS 24 Cost Accounting Standard on Treatment of Revenue in Cost Statements [Limited Revision 2017]
This standard deals with the principles and methods of classification, measurement, treatment and
assignment of revenue and its presentation and disclosure in cost statements.
Objective
The objective of this standard is to bring uniformity and consistency in the principles and methods for
treatment of revenue in cost statements with reasonable accuracy.
Scope
This standard shall be applied to cost statements which require classification, measurement, treatment,
assignment, presentation and disclosure of revenue including those requiring attestation.
3. Standard deals with the principles and methods of determining the manufacturing Cost of
excisable goods-
A. CAS 12 B. CAS 15 C. CAS 22 D. CAS 2
5. Standards deals with the principles and methods of determining depreciation and amortization
cost-
A. CAS 9 B. CAS 12 C. CAS 15 D. CAS 16
2. Cost Accounting Standard Board Should have minimum three eminant practicing members of
the Insititute of Cost Accounts of India.
3. Is issue the fromwork for The Cost Accounting Standard is the function of CASB.
5. The objective of CAS 10 is to bring uniformity and consistency in the period and methods of
determining the direct expenses with reasonable accuracy.
2. The ______________________ of the CASB will be nominated by the council of The Institute of Cost
Accountants of India.
3. __________________ nominee from the regulate like CAG, RBI to the CASB Board.
5. The function of CASB is to assists the members in preparations of uniform ______________ under
various statue.
COST STATEMENT
In the preceding sections, we have dealt with the basic concepts of costs and the various elements of
costs. We have also seen the different steps followed in determination of cost of a product or rendering
a service. Treatment of various costs has been discussed at length. You are by now very well aware
that the term cost has wide connotations and would not mean anything in isolation. Costs must be
understood if they are to be controlled. Measurement of costs is the first step in the process of control
simply because you cannot control unless you measure. Measurement of cost would mean different
when applied to different industries.
The cost has to be measured with respect to the cost centers first and then at a broader level with
respect to the cost unit. The journey towards the aim of determining cost of a product or service may
take various routes. But the logic is same i.e. collect all relevant costs in the process of converting raw
material into finished product and accumulate the total costs.
To put in simple words, to generate any product or service, resources are needed called as inputs.
Theses inputs are used in a process of conversion. The end result is the output which could either be a
product or a service. The resources consume costs. While determining total cost of resources, the costs
of all resources used (directly or indirectly) in the process are accumulated. This requires establishing
the relationship between the resource and the product or service.
The process of accumulating costs will differ according to the nature of business and the activities carried
out. The common way to accumulate costs is to prepare cost sheets.
Cost Accumulation
The logic of Cost Accumulation is to track costs in the same sequence as the resources get used. See
the following flow of activities:
(a) Raw material & other material are purchased and stored
(b) The material is used up in process of conversion
(c) People or machines work upon the material while in the process
(d) The process results into some products that are finished
The cost data needs to be collected along this whole chain that ends when a final product is produced.
The cost accumulation is done based on the source documents which are used in booking the costs.
Depending upon the type of business, a cost unit is determined for which costs must be accumulated.
The departmentalisation of the business organisation is done to suit the production process. For example,
in a fruit processing industry, the costs would be accumulated as per different process involved i.e.
cutting, pulp formation, blending, purifying and final packing. As the physical flow of material happens
from one process to the other, costs are also passed on from one process to the next in line.
As we know all the direct element of cost together make Prime Cost. Sequentially, production overheads
are added to get Factory Cost or Works Cost. Then Administration overheads are added to the Factory
Cost to get Cost of Production. Once the product is ready for sale, the selling and distribution overheads
are added to get Cost of Sales or Cost of Goods Sold. When this is deducted from Sales revenue we
get profit or loss.
Process of accumulation of cost comprises of:
l Identification of costs to the cost centers or departments
l Apportionment of service costs to production costs
l Absorption of costs into cost units
Cost Collection
Cost Collection is the process of booking costs against a particular Cost Account code under a particular
cost center or directly under a cost unit, as the case may be. Source documents are used to generate
the record of the costs incurred or to be incurred. These source documents are properly authorised and
numbered. They act as the primary source of entry. In additions to these documents there could be
other documents and reports such as allocation sheets, labour utilisation reports, idle time & overtime
analysis, scrap reports etc which help in identifying costs. Let us see how the costs are collected.
Material costs
These costs are identified with cost unit with the help of ‘stores issue summary’. In case of job costing,
there will be job-wise summary prepared on the basis of ‘material issue notes’. In case of contracts,
the summary will be made contract-wise. At times instead of procuring & storing material, it may be
procured and directly used on contract site. ‘Purchase Invoice’ may be the basis to capture such direct
material costs. In case of process industry, the material is issued to different processes. Here, the costs
input to a process may be collected based on the cost of materials processed in the previous process. A
process-wise summary of material issues is maintained. Some material may get added to a process but
may not become part of final product. The cost of such material is apportioned on the output of that
process. The indirect material costs may be gathered on the basis of consumable issues, scrap reports,
standard parts list etc. Care should be taken to account for material losses. Normal material losses are
to be apportioned to the good units produced, whereas, abnormal losses should be excluded from
computation of cost of good units and should be directly taken to P & L Account.
Labour Cost
Salaries and wages summary prepared after the monthly payroll run is the main basis for labour cost
collection. The summary shows department-wise break up, so that the Direct Labour Cost of production
department is separately known and that for the other indirect departments is also available to be
charged as overheads. In case of contracting business, labour force is usually dedicated to various
sites. The cost of labour used on different contracts can be found based on wages sheet maintained
for each contract site. In addition, the idle time reports, overtime reports are used for booking of the
costs of idle time & overtime. In case labourers are common to various jobs or contracts or processes, an
estimate of the time that they spend on each of them is made and the costs are allocated accordingly.
Expenses
Accounting entries in cash book or journal proper help to collect the expenses. Direct expenses which
are job or contract or process specific may be collected on the basis of vouchers. The indirect expenses
are collected and then apportioned in a summarised form using apportionment sheets.
You can observe the logical way in which the cost flow has been shown in the above chart. The focus
in this specimen is on elements and functions split further into direct and indirect costs with respect to
the cost units. Although the formats could be different, the contents of a cost sheet must be understood
and interpreted correctly so that one can analyse it for control and decision making. For example if it
has to be prepared for a process industry, the format would reflect the portion up to factory cost for
each process separately. Then the administration costs will be added together. The cost per unit will be
computed for every process separately. The stock for processes subsequent to process one will mean
stocks transferred from earlier processes and stocks transferred to the next processes. The objective here
is to compute the cost per process. The cost sheet format here could be:
As we know that the stocks are always valued at cost or market price whichever is less. This norm has
to be applied to the rates of all the items of material in stock, and then the total valuation of stock is
done. The stock ledger records all receipts and issues of the quantity and rate of material items. The
valuation of material issues has to be properly done based on correctly chosen method of issue pricing.
This summary figure as per the issue column should exactly match with the raw material consumed figure
as included in the cost sheet.
The normal losses on account of material shortages must be included in the cost of raw material
consumed. Care should be taken to remove the abnormal losses there from.
(e) Treatment of work in process is another important step. If the format is carefully seen, it will be noticed
that the cost of WIP stocks is adjusted specifically after adding Factory Overheads! Why adjusted?
And why at that stage only? Please note that Cost Sheet is prepared for a period of time for a cost
unit. At the beginning of that period, if the job has been carried forward from the previous period,
there may be some partly finished work that is carried forward. At the same time there may be
partly finished production at the end of current period. These stocks must be adjusted to reflect
the cost consumed during the current period. Further, the work in process is normally valued at
Factory Cost. It does not include Administration Overheads as the production of goods is not yet
fully complete. Administration costs are absorbed at the stage of finished production. Hence the
adjustment of WIP stocks is to be done before adding the Administration Overheads.
(f) Similarly, the adjustment for the opening and closing stocks of finished goods should be done. This
has to be done after the stage of cost of production.
(g) One could have separate columns for total costs and per unit costs side by side. This will help have
a quick glance at the per unit figures. Management at operating level will find this very helpful.
Illustration 1
Following data is available from the cost records of a company for the month of March 2017:
(1) Opening stock of job as on 1st March 2017
Job no. A 99: Direct Material `80, Direct Wages `150 and Factory Overheads `200
Job no. A 77: Direct Material `420, Direct Wages `450 and Factory Overheads `400
(2) Direct material issued during the month of February 2017 was:
Job no A 99 `120
Job no A 77 `280
Job no A 66 `225
Job no A 55 `300
(3) Direct labour details for March 2017 were:
Job no Hours Amount (`)
A 99 400 600
A 77 200 450
A 66 300 675
A 55 100 225
(4) Factory Overheads are applied to jobs on production according to direct labour hour rate which
is `2 per hour.
(5) Factory Overhead incurred in March 2017 were `2100.
(6) Job numbers A 99 & A 77 were completed during the month. They were billed to the customers at
a price which included 15% of the price of the job for Selling & Distribution expenses and another
10% of the price for Profit.
Prepare:
(a) Job cost sheet for job number A 77 and A 99.
(b) Determine the selling price for the jobs.
(c) Calculate the value of work in process.
Solution:
Remarks :
(1) The Factory Overheads actually incurred are ` 2100. This amount to be apportioned on the basis
of labour hours. So the rate to be considered as ` 2.1per unit = (2100/1000) and not `2 per unit. If
we consider the above mentioned point the calculations for Job Sheets & for the work in progress
will change accordingly.
(2) Work in progress is to be calculated for the incomplete jobs hence job no. A 66 and A 55 should
only be included in the calculations of work in progress.
Job Cost Sheets for the month of March 2017 Amount (`)
Note 1
S&D and profit are given in indirect way. 480 300
Assume Selling price as 100 320 200
Less: S & D @ 15% (15)
Less: Profit @ 10% (10)
Balance has to be the Factory Cost 75
S & D price will be 15/75 of Factory Costs
Profit will be 10/75 of Factory Cost
Items
Opening balance as on 1 March
st
Job A 99 430
Job A 77 1,270 1,700
Material issued during the month of March Job A 99 120
Job A 77 280
Job A 66 225
Job A 55 300 925
Direct Labour Job A 99 600
Job A 77 450
Job A 66 675
Job A 55 225 1,950
Factory Overheads on 1000 hours @ ` 2.1 2,100
Factory Cost 6,675
Less: Factory Cost of completed jobs Job A 77 2,420
Job A 99 1,990 4,410
Closing work in process as on 28 March 2017
th
2,265
Illustration 2
Prepare Cost Sheet for an engineering company which produces standard components in batches of
1000 pieces each. A batch passes through three processes viz. Foundry, Machining & Assembly.
The materials used for a batch number 001 were: Foundry 1300 tonnes @ `50 per tonne of which 50
tonnes were sent back to stores.
Other details
Solution:
Cost sheets for the Batch number 001
Standard batch size 1000 pieces
Illustration 3
An advertising agency has received an enquiry for which you are supposed to submit the quotation.
Bill of material prepared by the production department for the job states the following requirement of
material:
Some photography is required for the job. The agency does not have a photographer as an employee.
It decides to hire one by paying `10000 to him. Estimated job card prepared by production department
specifies that service of following employees will be required for this job:
The primary packing material will be required to the tune of `4000. Production Overheads 40% of direct
cost, while the S & D Overheads are likely to be 25% on Production Cost. The agency expects a profit
of 20% on the quoted price. The agency works 25 days in a month and 6 hours a day.
Solution:
Quotation for a Printing Job
Illustration 4
The following figures were extracted from the Trial Balance of a company as on 31st December 2016.
Solution:
Factory Overheads:
Indirect labour 18,000
Accrued indirect labour 1,200
Factory supervision 10,000
Repairs & upkeep 14,000
Heat, Light & power 52,000
Rates & taxes 4,200
Misc. Factory expenses 18,700
Depreciation on plant & machinery 46,050
Depreciation on buildings 6,400
1,70,550
Add: Opening WIP 2,00,000
Less: Closing WIP (1,92,000) 1,78,550
Factory Cost 6,37,750
Administration Overheads
Heat Light & power 6,500
Rates & taxes 2,100
Depreciation on buildings 800
Depreciation on office appliances 870
Office salaries 8,600
18,870
Add: Opening FG stock 80,000
Less: Closing FG Stock (1,15,000) (16,130)
Cost of Production of saleable units 6,21,620
Selling & Distribution overheads
Heat & light 6,500
Depreciation on buildings 800
Sales commission 33,600
Sales travelling 11,000
Sales promotion 22,500
Distribution department expenses 18,000 92,400
Cost of Sales 7,14,020
Illustration 5
PR Ltd. manufactures and sells a typical brand of Tiffin Boxes under its on brand name. The installed
capacity of the plant is 1,20,000 units per year distributable evenly over each month of calendar year.
The Cost Accountant of the company has informed the following cost structure of the product, which
is as follows:
Raw Material ` 20 per unit.
Direct Labour ` 12 per unit
Direct Expenses ` 2 per unit
Variable Overheads ` 16 per unit.
Fixed Overhead ` 3,00,000.
Solution:
Cost Sheet for the period Amount (`)
Illustration 6
X Ltd. Provides you the following figures for the year 2015-16:
Solution:
(a) Statement showing the Cost of Sales Amount (`)
(b)
(i) New Selling Price = (` 24,30,000 + ` 5,00,000)/24,000 units = ` 122.08
(ii) New Selling Price = (` 24,30,000 + 25% or ` 24,30,000)/24,000 units = ` 126.5625
(iii) New Selling Price = (` 24,30,000 + 1/3rd or ` 24,30,000)/24,000 units = ` 135
(iv) New Selling Price = (` 24,30,000 + (24,000 x ` 10) / 24,000 units = ` 111.25
Illustration 7
The following are the costing records for the year 2017 of a manufacturer:
Production 10,000 units; Cost of Raw Materials ` 2,00,000; Labour Cost ` 1,20,000; Factory Overheads
` 80,000; Office Overheads ` 40,000; Selling Expenses ` 10,000, Rate of Profit 25% on the Selling Price.
The manufacturer decided to produce 15,000 units in 2017. It is estimated that the cost of raw materials
will increase by 20%, the labour cost will increase by 10%, 50% of the overhead charges are fixed and
the other 50% are variable. The selling expenses per unit will be reduced by 20%. The rate of profit will
remain the same.
Prepare a Cost Statement for the year 2017 showing the total profit and selling price per unit.
Solution:
Statement of Cost & Profit (Cost Sheet)
(Output 10,000 units) Amount (`)
Particulars Cost per unit Total Cost
Raw Materials 20 2,00,000
Labour 12 1,20,000
PRIME COST 32 3,20,000
Add: Factory Overhead 8 80,000
WORKS COST 40 4,00,000
Add: Office Overhead 4 40,000
COST OF PRODUCTION 44 4,40,000
Add: Selling Expenses 1 10,000
COST OF SALES 45 4,50,000
Add: Profit (25% on Selling Price or 33.33% on Cost of Sales) 15 1,50,000
SELLING PRICE 60 6,00,000
4.2 ITEMS EXCLUDED FROM COST AND NORMAL AND ABNORMAL ITEMS/COST
Appropriation of profits:
(i) Appropriation to sinking funds
(ii) Dividends paid
(iii) Taxes on income and profits
(iv) Transfers to general reserves
(v) Excess provision for depreciation of buildings, plant etc. and for bad debts
(vi) Amount written off – goodwill, preliminary expenses, underwriting commission, discount on
debentures issued; expenses of capital issue etc.
(vii) Capital expenditures specifically charged to revenue
(viii) Charitable donation
Non - Integrated Accounting is a system of accounting under which separate ledgers are maintained
for cost and financial accounts by accountants. This system is also referred to as cost ledger accounting
system. Under such a system the cost accounts restrict itself to recording only those transactions which
relate to the product or service being provided. This leads to the exclusion of certain expenses e.g.
interest, bad debts and revenue/income from other than the sale of product or service.
Non-Integrated Accounting System contains fewer accounts when compared with financial
accounting because of the exclusion of purchases, expenses and also balance sheet items viz. fixed
assets, debtors and creditors. Items of accounts which are excluded are represented by an account
called Cost Ledger Control Account. The important ledgers to be maintained under non-integrated
accounting system in the cost accounting department are discussed below.
(a) Cost Ledger: Cost ledger is the principal ledger of the cost department in which impersonal
accounts are recorded. This ledger is made self-balancing by maintaining therein a control
account for each subsidiary ledger.
(b) Stores Ledger: Stores ledger contains an account for each of stores. The entries in each account
maintained in this ledger are made from the invoice, goods received note, material requisitions,
material received note etc. Accounts in respect of each item of stores show receipt, issue and
balance in physical as well as in monetary terms.
(c) Work-in-Process Ledger: Work-in-process ledger contains accounts of unfinished jobs and
processes. All material costs, wages and overheads for each job in process are posted to the
respective job account in this ledger. The balance in a job account represents total balance of
job/work-in-process, as shown by the job account.
(d) Finished Goods Ledger- Finished goods ledger contains an account for each item of finished
product manufactured or the completed job. If the finished product is transferred to stores, a
credit entry is passed in the work-in-process ledger and a corresponding debit entry is passed in
this ledger.
(xi) Overhead Adjustment Account: Overhead adjustment account will be debited for under-
recovery of overhead and credited with over-recovery of overhead amount. The net balance in
this account is transferred to costing profit & loss account.
Note: Sometimes, overhead adjustment account is not maintained and under/over absorbed overheads
is directly transferred to costing profit & loss account from the respective overhead accounts.
Illustration 8
On 31st March, 2018 the following balances were extracted from the books of the ABC Ltd.
Particulars (Rs.)
Raw Materials:
- Purchased 95,000
- Returned to suppliers 3,000
- Issued to production 98,000
- Returned to stores 3,000
Productive wages 40,000
Indirect wages 25,000
Factory overhead expenses incurred 50,000
Selling and Administrative expenses 40,000
Cost of finished goods transferred to warehouse 2,13,000
Cost of Goods sold 2,10,000
Sales 3,00,000
Factory overheads are applied to production at 150% of direct wages, any under/over absorbed
overhead being carried forward for adjustment in the subsequent months. All administrative and selling
expenses are treated as period costs and charged off to the Profit and Loss account of the month in
which they are incurred.
Solution:
(a) Cost Ledger Control A/c
Working Note:
Integrated accounting system is the name given to a system of accounting, where by cost and financial
accounts are kept in the same set of books. Obviously, then there will be no separate set of books for
costing and financial records. Integral accounts provide or meet the information required by costing
and financial accounts.
Illustration 9
Journalise the following transactions assuming that cost and financial accounts are integrated:
Solution:
Journals
Dr. Cr.
Illustration 10
Pass the journal entries for the following transactions in a double entry cost accounting system:
Solution:
Journals Dr. Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Amount (`)
Work In Progress Control A/c Dr. 5,50,000
Factory Overheads Control A/c Dr. 1,50,000
To Material Control A/c 7,00,000
Work In Progress Control A/c Dr. 2,00,000
Factory Overheads Control A/c Dr . 40,000
To Wages Control A/c 2,40,000
Work In Progress Control A/c Dr. 1,50,000
Finished goods Control A/c Dr. 50,000
Cost of Sales A/c Dr. 30,000
To Factory Overhead Control A/c 1,50,000
To Administrative Overhead Control A/c 50,000
To Selling Overhead Control A/c 30,000
Costing Profit & Loss A/c Dr. 10,000
To Administrative Overhead Control A/c 10,000
Factory Overhead Control A/c Dr. 20,000
To Costing Profit & Loss A/c 20,000
Illustration 11
Messsrs Essbee Ltd. maintains Integrated Accounts of Cost and Financial Accounts. From the following
details write up Control Accounts of a factory and prepare a Trial Balance.
Solution:
Dr. Creditors Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Cash A/c 11,00,000 By, Balance b/d 5,00,000
To, Balance c/d 4,00,000 By, Material Control A/c 10,00,000
15,00,000 15,00,000
By, Balance b/d 4,00,000
Dr. Debtors Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Balance b/d 2,00,000 By, Cash A/c 21,00,000
To, P & L A/c 22,00,000 By, Balance c/d 3,00,000
24,00,000 24,00,000
To, Balance b/d 3,00,000
Dr. Material Control A/c (or) Stores Ledger Control Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Balance b/d 1,50,000 By, Work-in-Progress Control A/c 10,50,000
To, Creditors A/c 10,00,000 By, Manufacturing Overhead 5,000
Control A/c
By, Balance c/d 95,000
11,50,000 11,50,000
To, Balance b/d 95,000
Dr. Cash & Bank Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Balance b/d 75,000 By, Wages Control A/c 6,50,000
To, Debtors A/c 21,00,000 By, Manufacturing Overhead Control 3,00,000
A/c
By, Selling and Distribution O.H. 1,00,000
Control A/c
By, Creditors A/c 11,00,000
By, Balance c/d 25,000
21,75,000 21,75,000
To, Balance b/d 25,000
Dr. Work-in-Progress Control Account Cr.
Illustration 12
The following balances are shown in the Cost Ledger of Vinak Ltd. as on 1st October, 2016:
Particulars Dr. (`) Cr.(`)
Work in progress Account 7,056
Factory overheads suspense Account 360
Finished stock Account 5,274
Stores Ledger Control Account 9,450
Administration Overheads Suspense A/C 180
General Ledger Adjustment Account 22,320
Transactions for the year ended 30th september, 2017
Particulars Amount (`)
Stores issued to production 45,370
Stores purchased 52,400
Material purchased for direct issued to production 1,135
Wages paid (including indirect labour ` 2,520) 57,600
Finished goods sold 1,18,800
Administration expenses 5,400
Selling expenses 6,000
Factory overheads 15,600
Store issued for Capital work-in-Progress 1,500
Finished goods transferred to warehouse 1,08,000
Store issued for factory repairs 2,000
Factory overheads recovered to production 16,830
Administration overheads charged to production 4,580
Factory overheads applicable unfinished work 3,080
selling overheads allocated to sales 5,500
Stores lost due to fire in store (not insured) 150
Administration expenses on unfinished work 850
Finished goods stock on 30.9.2016 14,274
You are required to record the entries in the cost ledger for the year ended 30th September, 2017 and
prepare a Trial Balance as on that date.
Solution:
Dr. Work-in-Progress Control Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Balance b/d 7,056 By, Finished Goods Control A/c 1,08,000
To, Material Control A/c 45,370 By, Balance c/d
To, General Ledger Adjustment A/c 1,135 Factory Overhead 3,080
To, Wages control A/c 55,080 Admn. O.H. 850
To, Factory overhead control A/c 16,830 Material & Wages 22,051 25,981
To, Administrative Overhead Control A/c 4,580
To, Factory Overhead Control A/c 3080
To, Administrative Overhead Control A/c 850
1,33,981 1,33,981
To Balance b/d 25,981
Where no separate accounts are maintained for costing and finance, the question of reconciliation
does not arise. But where the cost and financial accounts are maintained independently of each other,
it is indispensable to reconcile them. Though both the sets of accounts are same as far as the basic
transactions are concerned but there are differences in the profits of two sets of books.
B. Appropriation of Profits
(a) Donations and Charities
(b) Income Tax
(c) Dividend Paid
(d) Transfer to Reserves
(iv) Differences due to different basis of stock valuation and depreciation methods.
Objects of Reconciliation
(a) To assure the mathematical accuracy and reliability of cost accounts
(b) To have proper cost control and ascertainment
(c) To find out the reasons for the profit or loss shown by the financial accounts
(d) To ensure correct profit or loss in financial accounts
(e) To ensure true and fair view of balance sheet of the business concern
Add :
(a) Items of income included in Cost Accounts but not in Financial Accounts.
(c) Amounts by which items of income have been shown in excess in Cost Accounts over the
corresponding entries in Financial Accounts.
(d) Amounts by which items of expenditure have been shown in excess in Financial Accounts over the
corresponding entries in Cost Accounts.
(f) The amount by which closing stock of inventory is overvalued in Cost Accounts.
(g) The amount by which opening stock of inventory is undervalued in Cost Accounts.
Less :
(a) Items of income included in Financial Accounts but not in Cost Accounts.
(b) Items of expenditure (as interest on Capital, Rent on owned premises etc.) included in Cost Accounts
but not in Financial Accounts.
(c) Amounts by which items of expenditure have been shown in excess in Cost Accounts as compared
to the corresponding entries in Financial Accounts.
(d) Amounts by which items of incomes have been shown in excess in Financial Accounts as compared
to the corresponding entries in Cost Accounts.
(f) The amount by which closing stock of inventory is undervalued in Cost Accounts.
(g) The amount by which opening stock of inventory is overvalued in Cost Accounts.
Illustration 13
The net profits of a manufacturing company appeared at ` 64,500 as per financial records for the year
ended 31st December, 2016. The cost books however, showed a net profit of ` 86,460 for the same
period. A careful scrutiny of the figures from both the sets of accounts revealed the following facts.
`
(i) Income-tax provided in financial books 20,000
Solution:
Statement showing reconciliation of profit shown by cost and financial accounts as on 31-12-2016:
Illustration 14
The net profits shown by financial accounts of a company amounted to ` 18,550 whilst the profits
disclosed by company’s cost account for that period were ` 28,660. On reconciling the figures, the
following difference were noted.
Amount (`)
(i) Director’s fee not charged in cost accounts 650
(ii) A provision for bad and doubtful debts 570
(iii) Bank interest (cr.) 30
(iv) Income-tax 8,300
(v) Overheads in the cost accounts were estimated at ` 8,500. The charges shown by the financial
books was ` 8,320.
(vi) Work was started during the year on a new factory and expenditure `16,000 was incurred.
Depreciation of 5% was provided in financial accounts.
Prepare a Statement Reconciling the figures shown by the cost and financial accounts.
Solution:
Statement showing reconciliation of profit shown by cost and financial accounts
Illustration 15
M/s Mysore Petro Ltd. showed a net loss of ` 2,08,000 as per their financial accounts for the year ended
31st March, 2017. The cost accounts, however, disclosed a net loss of `1,64,000 for the same period.
The following information was revealed as a result of the scrutiny of the figures of both the sets of books.
Amount (`)
Solution:
Statement Showing Reconciliation of Profit Shown by Cost and Financial Accounts
Illustration 16
During a particular year, the auditors certified the financial accounts, showing profit of `1,68,000 whereas
the same, as per costing books was coming out to be ` 2,40,000. Given the following information you
are asked to prepare a Reconciliation Statement showing the reasons for the gap.
Solution:
Statement Showing Reconciliation of Profit Shown by Cost and Financial Accounts
* 5% of 34,65,000 = 1,73,250
** 3% of 34,65,000 = 1,03,950
Illustration 17
A transistor manufacturer, who commenced his business on 1st June, 2017 supplies you with the following
information and asks you to prepare a statement showing the profit per transistor sold. Wages and
materials are to be charged at actual cost, works overhead at 75% of wages and office overhead at
30% of works cost. Number of transistors manufactured and sold during the year was 540.
Other particulars:
Materials per set ` 240
Wages per set ` 80
Selling price per set ` 600
If the actual works expenses were `32,160 and office expenses were `61,800, prepare a Reconciliation
Statement.
Solution:
Cost Sheet (or) Statement of Cost and Profit Amount (`)
Statement of Reconciliation
Illustration 18
Given below is the Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Vikas Electronics for the accounting year
ended 31st March, 2017.
Normal output of the factory is 2,00,000 units. Factory overheads are fixed upto `60,000 and office
expenses are fixed for all practical purposes, selling and distribution expenses are fixed to the extent of
`50,000 the rest are variable. Prepare a Statement of Reconciliation of Profit as per Cost Accounts and
Financial Accounts.
Solution:
Cost Sheet (or) Statement of Cost and Profit
Statement of Reconciliation
Illustration 19
The following is the Trading and Profit and Loss account of M/s. Time and Trading limited for the year
ended 31.12.2016.
Dr. Trading and profit & Loss Account Cr.
Solution:
Costing Profit & Loss Account
Statement of Reconciliation
Illustration 20
The financial profit and loss account of a manufacturing company for the year ended 31st March, 2017
is given below:
Solution:
Illustration 21
The following figures have been extracted from financial accounts of a manufacturing firm for the first
year of its operation.
Amount (`)
Direct material consumption 50,00,000
Direct wages 30,00,000
Factory OH 16,00,000
Administration OH 7,00,000
Selling and distribution OH 9,60,000
Bad debts 80,000
Preliminary expenses written off 40,000
Legal charges 10,000
Dividends received 1,00,000
Interest on deposit received 20,000
Sales (1,20,000 units) 1,20,00,000
Closing stock
Finished stock - 4,000 units 3,20,000
Work-in-progress 2,40,000
The cost accounts for the same period reveal that the direct material consumption was `56,00,000.
Factory OH recovered at 20% on prime cost; Administration OH is recovered @ `6 per unit of production;
Selling and Distribution OH are recovered at `8 per unit sold.
You are required to prepare Costing and Financial Profit and Loss Accounts and reconcile the difference
in the profit in the two sets of accounts.
Solution:
Dr. Costing P & L Accoount Cr.
Statement of Reconciliation
Particulars Amount (`) Amount (`)
Profit as per Financial Accounts 12,90,000
Add: Over valuation of cl. Stock of Finished goods in Cost Accounts 29,161
Pure financial expenses not considered in Cost Accounts 1,30,000 1,59,161
(80,000 + 40,000 + 10,000)
Less: Over recovery of material 6,00,000
Over recovery of FOH 1,20,000
Over recovery of AOH 44,000
Financial incomes not considered in Cost Accounts. 1,20,000 8,84,000
Profit as per Cost Accounts 5,65,161
Illustration 22
The following represent the Trading and Profit and Loss Account of a manufacturer of a standard fire
extinguisher:
1,550 Extinguishers were manufactured during the year, and 1,500 were sold during the same p eriod.
The cost records showed that Factory overheads work out at ` 8.25 and Administrative overheads at
` 9.0625 per article produced: the Cost Accounts showing an estimated total profit of ` 7,031.25 for the
year.
From the forgoing information you are required to prepare
(a) Factory Overhead Control of Account
(b) Administration overheads Control Account in costing books and
(c) An account showing reconciliation between the total net profit as per the Cost Accounts and
the net profit shown in Financial Books.
Solution:
INFRASTRUCTURE SECTOR
The Infrastructure activity which, inter alia includes building / re-building / restoring structures or
infrastructure facilities, typically using civil, mechanical or other branches of engineering, plays an
important role in the development of the economy as it has multiplier effect across various sectors
creating investment opportunities.
The infrastructure industry contributes a significant share of the country’s GDP and employment.
Features of an infrastructure contract / project are as follows:
• Execution of projects as a contractor / sub-contractor or as a developer
• Projects involving design, detailed engineering, procurement, manufacturing/fabrication,
installation, commissioning
• The contracts / projects are finalised normally through a bidding process and the projects are
executed as per client’s requirements at client’s project site.
• The client normally makes payment based on the progress of work as per the contract.
• Contracts also normally stipulate work / quality certification by a client nominated third party
consultant.
• Contracts also lay down performance guarantee conditions, warranty / defect liability period,
liquidated damages for schedule delay, price variation clause if any, client’s obligations during
construction period, method to be followed for any change in scope of work, claim management,
force-majeure clause, arbitration etc.
• The duration of a project may vary from project to project for different industries. Normally the
projects are of long duration (more than 12 months) and revenue is recognised generally based
on Indian Accounting Standard (Ind AS-11) notified by Government of India, Ministry of Corporate
Affairs.
EDUCATION SECTOR
Education imparts knowledge and skills and shapes values and attitudes. Education is vital for progress
of a civil society. Education forms the backbone of a nation and is one of the most important key
indicators of a country’s growth and development. The rise of knowledge economy at a global level
has reinforced education, in all its forms (elementary, secondary, higher, vocational, and adult), as the
key economic and business driver.
Education acts as a driver for technological innovation and facilitates absorption of developed
technology for the benefit of the mankind. It is now widely accepted that knowledge capital, holds
the key to development of economy.
With the emergence of India as a knowledge-based economy human capital has now become its
major strength. This has put the spotlight on severe inadequacies of India’s infrastructure for delivery of
education, particularly higher education.
The social rates of return on investments in all levels of education much exceed the long-term
opportunity cost of capital. At the same time, since it is difficult to measure the social rate of return, the
financial ROI, becomes a key driver for sustaining and enhancing the investments in education sector.
Cost Management in Education Sector
Today, the aim of the top management of colleges and universities is to improve
transparency into their services, operations and finances for their stakeholder and the public. There is
also a growing interest among the institutions of higher education to enhance risk management through
better controls over their entity systems, policies and procedures, and to promote the importance of
accountability among professionals.
Within these organizations, management information system, performance management and cost
review plays a pivotal role in working with administrators, management and boards to establish strong
cost spending controls and derive the many resulting benefits in terms of organizational performance
and cost efficiencies.
The cost/finance controller can help the Higher Educational Institutions in overcoming the threats
and weaknesses of their internal management and system. And can also open and widen the areas
according to their strengths and visible opportunities.
The Management of Higher Educational Institutions shall undertake the following review to evaluate
and improve the effectiveness of risk management, cost control and governance processes:
• Systems evaluation – assessing the control systems in place within a specific area, to support the
achievement of the areas objectives;
• Stock evaluation – undertake stock take of library books, IT equipment, laboratory equipment,
stationary, college furniture etc.
• Compliance evaluation – assessing compliance against an agreed set of standards, e.g. UGC
norms, AICTE norms ;
• Contract evaluation and cost review– auditing procurement projects and capital programmes,
assessing compliance with best practice (policies and procedures), cost reviews for expenditure
on institution infrastructure, staff payroll, administration etc.;
• Thematic work reviews – to be undertaken across a number of departments, identifying areas of
good practice and producing an overall report for all areas of Institution with respect to budgetary
controls, spending analysis, achieving value for money etc.;
• Revenue assurance – undertaking assurance review to confirm that departments have appropriate
controls in place for fee collections, timely deposits, etc.;
• Grant reviews – to ensure that the grants are used for the intended purpose.
HEALTHCARE SECTOR
One of the important objectives of Government is to improve in standard of living and health status
of its population. For this, government endeavors to provide its populations accessible, affordable,
awareness and quality healthcare. Indian Government is also making continuous efforts to improve
the standard of living and health status of its population and it remains one of the primary objectives
in Indian planning. The 12th five year plans (2012-17) focuses on providing universal healthcare
infrastructure, promoting R&D and enacting strong regulation for the Health Sector. India’s health care
system have mixed treatment ownership patterns and with different systems of medicine – primary
Allopathy & Homoeopathy, co existing with indigenous system like Ayurvedic, Unani, and Siddha.
The proper goal of a health care delivery system is to “Touch & Enriching billion Lives with creating
certain set of value” i.e. Patient Centricity, Ownership, & integrity to patients. Objective in health care
is measured in terms of the patient outcomes achieved per rupee expended. It is not the number of
different services provided or the volume of services delivered that matters but the true status of health.
Cost Management can be a useful tool for management in Health Care Sector to:
• Estimate the reasonable cost of Health care resources used in patient care
• Lower health care cost without compromising on quality of services rendered or extended
• Estimate the capacity of each resources and comparison with actual utilization
• Manage materials & its storage and associated costs in terms of consumables, drugs, etc.
• Break down the costs to different cost centers & map costs to activities
• Compare cost of each service group with revenues generated and arrive at profitability
PORT SECTOR
The ports sector in India is divided into “Major Ports” and “Non-Major Ports” which are under the
jurisdiction of Central Government and State Governments respectively. The legal framework governing
the sector comprises the Indian Ports Act of 1908 and the Major Port Trusts Act of 1963. Major Ports
under Central jurisdiction are governed by policy and directives of Ministry of Shipping of Government
of India. Minor Ports under State’s jurisdiction and governed by policy and directives of respective State
Government’s nodal departments/ agencies.
Tariff Authority for Major Ports (TAMP) has been constituted for regulating tariffs in major ports and its
functioning/role is being revised to ensure uniform and transparent norms relating to fixing tariffs as well
as prescribing quality of service for port authorities/terminal operators.
The Management of Port Sector shall undertake the following review to evaluate and improve the
effectiveness of risk management, cost control and governance process;
• To ensure that the internal control are in place as set by the management for the attainment of the
objective of the business,
• Management need to review that the internal control are in place in relation to revenue collection
and its proper accounting,
• To ensure that the grant if issued by the government must be used for the specific purpose for
which it is granted,
• To ensure that the contract enter with the various client is operating in order and its adherence are
in place as this is incidental with the revenue of the entity.
GLOSSARY
Cost Collection: Cost collection is the process of booking costs against a particular cost account
code under a particular cost centre or directly under a cost unit, as the case may be.
Cost Control Accounts: Cost control accounts are accounts maintained for the purpose of exercising
control over the costing ledgers and also to complete the double entry in cost accounts.
Integral Accounting: Integrated accounting system is a system of accounting, whereby cost and
financial accounts are kept in the same set of books. Integral accounts provide the information
required by costing and financial accounts.
PRACTICE PROBLEMS:
4. Prakash Transport Company has been given a route of 20 km long to run a bus. The bus costs
`12,50,000 with an estimated useful life of 5 years. It is insured @ 3% pa of the cost. Annual tax
amounted to `25,000. The garage rent is `5,000 per month. Annual repairs cost is estimated as
`50,000.
The driver is paid a salary of `7,500 per month and the conductor is paid `5,000 per month in addition
to a 10% of takings as commission to be shared equally by them.
Office Stationery would `1,000 pm and Office Salaries `10,000 pm.
Diesel will cost @ `30 per liter and the bus would travel a distance of 5 km per liter. The bus will
make 3 round trips carrying on an average 40 passengers on each trip. Assuming a profit of 15% on
takings, calculate the fare to be charged from each passenger. The bus will operate for 25 days
in a month.
[Ans: Price per Passenger KM = ` 0.85]
5. The City Pride Theatre has revealed the following estimates of their cinema hall:
Salary 1 manager ` 8,000 pm, 10 door keepers `2,000 pm, 2 operators `4,000 pm, 4 booking clerks
`2,500 pm
Annual expenses:
Electricity ` 12,00,000
Carbon ` 3,00,000
Misc. expenses ` 1,50,000
Advertising ` 7,50,000 (it would earn income of `25,000 on
advertisements shown in the hall)
Hire of films ` 15,00,000 per film on 15 films
Administration expenses ` 80,000
The premises cost `60 lacs and are to be depreciated over 15 years. Projector and other equipments
cost `25 lacs and to be depreciated @ 25% pa.
The plan is to have 3 daily shows on all 360 days in a year. The capacity is 625 seats divided into
Lower class 250
Upper class 250 and
Balcony 125
20% of the seats are estimated to be vacant. The weightages to be given to the three classes are
in the ratio of 1:2:3.
If the management wishes to earn a profit of 25% on gross proceeds, find out the rates to be charged
for each class. Round off to nearest rupee.
[Ans: Rates of the ticket per seat Lower class ` 36.29; Upper class ` 72.57; Balcony ` 108.86.]
A. Carriage inward
B. Purchase returns
C. Sales commission
D. Interest paid
2. Which of the following items is not excluded while preparing a cost sheet?
D. Transfer to reserves
E. Interest paid
C. Salesman’s wages
6. For the purpose of Cost sheet preparation, costs are classified based on:
A. Functions
B. Relevance
C. Variability
D. Nature
A. Direct expenses
B. Administration cost
D. Factory overheads
B. Production cost
C. Administration Cost
9. A company has set up a laboratory for testing of products for compliance with standards. Salary
of this laboratory stuffs are part of:
A. Direct Expenses
C. Works overheads
A. Administration Cost
B. Factory overhead
C. Marketing cost
11. Which of the following does not form part of prime cost:
C. Cost of packing
12. A company pays royalty to State Government on the basis of production, it is treated as:
A. Direct Expenses
B. Factory overheads
D. Administration cost
C. Ignored
[Ans: D, C, A, A, A, A, B, C, B, B, C, A, A, B, A, B, A, A, D, B, C, B, A, B, A, C, A]
3. Closing stock of finished goods should be valued on the basis of cost of sales.
6. Notional interest on Owner’s capital appears only in financial profit and loss A/c.
9. Expenses which appears only in financial accounts and not in cost accounts, are Generally
notional items.
11. Cost ledger control account makes the cost ledger self balancing.
12. Stock ledger contains the accounts of all items of finished goods.
14. Cost control accounts are prepared on the basis of double entry system.
15. The balancing in costing profit and loss account represents under or over absorption of overheads.
[Ans: T, F, F, F, F, F, F, F, F, F, T, T, F, T, F]
Fill in the Blanks:
3. ________+Profit = Sales.
11. All the transactions relating to materials are recorded through ____________.
12. The net balance of _______________ represents net profit or net loss.
13. WIP ledger contains the accounts of all the ______________ which are under _____.
14. The two traditional systems of accounting for integration of cost and financial accounts are the
________ and ____________.
15. Under integrated accounting system, the accounting entry for payment of wages is to debit _____
and to credit cash.
[Ans: Total cost, Selling Price, Cost of Sales, Direct wages, Factory Overhead, Added to costing profit,
Added to costing profit, Deducted from costing profit, Added to financial profit, Cost Accounts,
Store ledger control accounts, Costing profit and loss account, Jobs Execution, Double entry
method –the third entry method, Wages control Accounts.]
Column A Column B
1. Primary Packing Materials Consumed A Not shown in cost sheet but debited to profit &
loss account
2. Captive power plant expense B Forms part of office & adm. Expenses
3. Cash discount allowed C Forms part of selling expenses
4. Scrap value of abnormal loss of D Treated as part of factory expenses
finished output
5. Cost of free samples of products E Treated as direct expenses
distributed
6. Depreciation on computer purchased for F Not shown in cost sheet but credited to profit
office & loss account
7. Donations G Expenses debited only in the financial accounts
8. Interest paid on loan H Appropriations only in financial accounts
9. Notional Rent charged to I Expenses debited only in cost accounts
10. Notional interest on Owner’s capital J Income credited only in cost accounts
[Ans: E, D, A, F, C, B, H, G, J, I]
Specific Order Costing: Specific order costing is the category of basic costing methods applicable where
the work consists of separate jobs, batches or contracts each of which is authorised by a specific order
or contract. It includes job costing consisting batch costing and contract costing.
Material Cost
On receipt of a production order, the shop draws the requisite materials from the stores. Surplus, excess
or incorrect materials are returned from the shops to the stores on materials return notes. Scrap and
waste arising in the course of manufacture are returned in a similar manner. The materials requisitions,
materials return notes and materials transfer notes are ‘costed’ in accordance with the methods of
pricing adopted by the concern.
Labour Cost
Labour summaries or wages analysis sheets are prepared for each accounting period and the totals of
these statements are debited to Work-in-Progress Account or Overhead Control Account by credit to
Wages Control Account. Amounts on account of overtime, idle time, shift differential and fringe benefits
may also be included in the wages analysis sheet. Direct labour costs are posted on the respective cost
sheets and indirect labour is treated in the manner indicated for indirect material.
Manufacturing Overhead
Overhead costs are accumulated against standing order numbers and against cost centres. Overhead
rates, predetermined or actual as the case may be, are worked out for each such centre. The overhead
applied to each job is obtained by multiplying the overhead rate by the actual base variable spent
on the job.
Completion of Jobs
Postings of direct material, direct labour, direct expenses and manufacturing overhead costs to the cost
sheet for a job or production order are made periodically throughout the run of the job or order. The
completion report is an indication that the manufacturing operations are over and further expenditure
on the job should cease so that the cost sheet may not be closed.
Work-in-Progress
The cost of an incomplete job i.e., a job on which some manufacturing processes or operations are still
due before it can be made into the finished product is termed Work-in-Progress or Work-in-Process. If
a production order has been only partly completed by the end of an accounting period, it is essential
that the closing stock of the work-in-progress be determined.
Control over job costs may be exercised by comparison of the actual costs with the estimated costs
established as basis for fixing job prices. Here again, adequate cost control is available for direct
material and direct labour only; overhead costs cannot be controlled in terms of individual jobs. Control
of overhead is, therefore, confined to the department as a whole for which predetermined overhead
rate has been determined.
Comparison may also be made with the costs of previous periods or of earlier batches of production,
if any. Standard costs may be used in job type plants, particularly where the product or the particular
operations of the job are of a standardised nature.
(b) With the increase in the clerical processes, chances of errors are enhanced.
(c) The cost as ascertained, even where they are compiled very promptly, are historical as they are
compiled after incidence.
(d) The cost compiled under job costing system represents the cost incurred under actual conditions
of operation. The system does not have any scientific basis.
Total
TOTAL COST
Profit/Loss
SELLING PRICE
Illustration 1
As newly appointed Cost Accountant, you find that the selling price of Job No. 9669 has been calculated
on the following basis:
An analysis of the previous year’s profit and loss account shows the following:
Solution:
(a)
In order to draw up Job Cost Sheet, the factory overhead rates of different departments and percentage
of selling cost will have to be determined first on the basis of previous year’s figures as follow:
Particulars Department
A B C
Direct Wages (i)
Factory Overheads (ii) 2,500 4,000 1,000
Direct Labour Hours (D.W. x 4) (iii) 20,000 24,000 16,000
Factory Overhead Rates per hour (ii ÷ iii) 0.125 0.167 0.063
Working Notes:
` 30,000
Percentage of Selling Cost on Works Cost = × 100 = 30%
`1,00,000
Illustration 2
A work order for 100 units of a commodity has to pass through four different machines of which the
machine hour rates are: Machine P – ` 1.25, Machine Q – ` 2.50, Machine R – ` 3 and Machine S – ` 2.25
Following expenses have been incurred on the work order – Materials ` 8,000 and Wages ` 500.
Machine - P has been engaged for 200 hours. Machine - Q for 160 hours, Machine - R for 240 hours and
Machine - S for 132 hours.
After the work order has been completed, materials worth ` 400 are found to be surplus and are returned
to stores.
Office overhead used to be 40% of works costs, but on account of all-round rise in the cost of
administration, distribution and sale, there has been a 50% rise in the office overhead expenditure.
Moreover, it is known that 10% of production will have to be scrapped as not being upto the specification
and the sale proceeds of the scrapped output will be only 5% of the cost of sale.
If the manufacturer wants to make a profit of 20% on the total cost of the work order, find out the selling
price of a unit of commodity ready for sale.
Solution:
Statement showing the selling price of a unit
Note: It was known before that 10% of production will have to be scrapped, therefore, inputs must have
been made taking this factor into consideration. No other adjustment is necessary except deducting
the value of scrap from the cost of production.
Illustration 3
The data pertaining to Heavy Engineering Ltd. using are as follows at the end of 31.3.2018. Direct material
` 9,00,000; Direct wages ` 7,50,000; Selling and distribution overhead ` 5,25,000; Administrative overhead
` 4,20,000, Factory overhead ` 4,50,000 and Profit ` 6,09,000.
Illustration 4
A manufacturing company is divided into three production departments – A, B and C. All production is
to customers’ orders. All orders are dissimilar and they go through all the three departments.
Manufacturing Costs for a given period were as follows:
Particulars Dept A Dept B Dept C Total
Amount (`) Amount (`) Amount (`) Amount (`)
Direct material 1,80,000
Direct labour 40,000 20,000 30,000 90,000
Indirect manufacturing costs 20,000 40,000 30,000 90,000
Particulars Departments
A B C
Indirect Mfg. Cost (`) (a) 20,000 40,000 30,000
Direct Labour (`) (b) 40,000 20,000 30,000
% of Mfg. Cost to Labour Cost [(a/b) x 100] 50% 200% 100%
On the assumption that direct labour cost method is considered to be a reasonable method of absorption
of overheads, it is quite possible that departmental application of overhead may be able to resolve
the difficulty faced by the manager regarding the costing of the job given. On this basis the amended
job cost sheet will be as under:
Revised Cost of Job
Particulars Amount (`) Amount (`)
Direct Materials (Given) 1,000
Direct Labour:
Dept. A 120
Dept. B 280
Dept. C 200 600
1,600
Indirect Manufacturing Cost: (Revised)
Dept. A 50% of Direct Labour 60
Dept. B 200% of Direct Labour 560
Dept. C 100% of Direct Labour 200 820
Total Cost 2,420
Illustration 5
A shop floor supervisor of a small factory presented the following cost for Job no.555 to determine selling
price.
Particulars Amount (`) Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`) Amount (`)
Materials 1,50,000 Sales 2,50,000
Direct Wages:
Dept. X 10,000
Dept. Y 12,000
Dept. Z 8,000 30,000
Special stores items 4,000
Overheads:
Dept. X 5,000
Dept. Y 9,000
Dept. Z 2,000 16,000
2,00,000
Gross profit c/d 50,000
2,50,000 Gross profit b/d 2,50,000
Selling expenses 20,000 50,000
Net profit c/d 30,000
50,000 50,000
It is also noted that average hourly rates for the 3 departments, X, Y and Z are similar.
You are required:
(a) Draw up a job cost sheet;
(b) Calculate the entire revised cost using 2016 actual figures as basis;
(c) Add 20% to total cost to determine selling price.
Solution:
(a) Calculation of Departmental Overhead Rates
Amount (`)
Particulars Departments
X Y Z
(i) Direct Wages 10,000 12,000 8,000
(ii) Rate of wages per hour 2.5 2.5 2.5
(iii) Hours (i ÷ ii) 4000 4800 3200
(iv) Actual Overheads 5000 9000 2000
(v) Department Overhead Rates per hour (iv ÷ iii) 1.250 1.875 0.625
Illustration 6
In a factory following the Job Costing Method, an abstract from the work in process as at 30th September,
was prepared as under.
Amount (`)
NUMBER OF HOURS
JOB NO.
SHOP A SHOP B
115 25 25
118 90 30
120 75 10
121 65 -
124 20 10
275 75
Indirect Labour:
Waiting for material 20 10
Machine breakdown 10 5
Idle time 5 6
Overtime premium 6 5
316 101
A shop credit slip was issued in October, that material issued under requisition No.54 was returned back
to stores as being not suitable. A material transfer note issued in October indicated that material issued
under requisition No.55 for Job 118 was directed to Job 124.
The hourly rate in shop A per labour hour is `3 while at shop B it is ` 2 per hour. The factory overhead is
applied at the same rate as in September; Jobs 115, 118 and 120 were completed in October.
You are asked to compute the factory cost of the completed jobs. It is practice of the management to
put a 10% on the factory cost to cover administration and selling overheads and invoice the job to the
customer on a total cost plus 20% basis what would be the invoice price of these three jobs?
Solution:
Calculation of selling price of the Job
Meaning
Batch Costing is that form of specific order costing under which each batch is treated as a cost unit and
costs are accumulated and ascertained separately for each batch. Each batch consists of a number
of like units.
Basic Features
(a) Each batch is treated as a cost unit.
(b) All costs are accumulated and ascertained for each batch.
(c) A separate Batch Cost Sheet is used for each batch and is assigned a certain number by which
the batch is identified.
(d) The cost per unit is ascertained by dividing the total cost of a batch by the number of items produced
in that batch.
Applications
Batch Costing is applied in those industries where the similar articles are produced in definite batches
for internal consumption in the production of finished products or for sale to customers generally. It is
generally applied in –
(a) Read made Garments Manufacturing Industries
FORMULA
2AS
E.B.Q =
C
Illustration 7
From the following information, calculate Economic Batch Quantity for a company using batch costing:
Solution :
Illustration 8
A customer has been ordering 90,000 special design metal columns at the columns at the rate of 18,000
per order during the past years. The production cost comprises `120 for material, ` 60 for labour and ` 20
for fixed overheads. It costs ` 1,500 to set up for one run of 18,000 column and inventory carrying cost
is 15% since this customer may buy at least 5000 columns this year, the company would like to avoid
making five different production runs. Find the most economic production run.
Solution :
Economic Production Run
2 × 90,000 × 1,500
= = 3,000 units
15% of 200 (120 + 60 + 20)
Illustration 9
AB Ltd.is committed to supply 24,000 bearings per annum to CD Ltd. On a steady basis. It is estimated
that it costs 10 paise as inventory holding cost per bearing per month and that the set-up cost per run
of bearing manufacture is ` 324.
(a) What would be the optimum run size for bearing manufacture?
(b) What is the minimum inventory holding cost at optimum run size?
(c) Assuming that the company has a police of manufacturing 6000 bearing per run, how much extra
costs would the company be incurring as compared to the optimum run suggested in (a)?
Solution :
2AS
(a) Optimum production Run Size (Q) =
C
Where, A = No. of units to be produced within one year = 24,000 (units) bearing
O = Set-up cost per production run = ` 324
C = Carrying cost per unit per annum = 0.10 × 12 = ` 1.2
2 × 24,000 × 324
= = 3,600 units (bearing)
1.2
(c) Statement showing Total Cost at Production Run sizes of 3600 and 6000 bearings
Illustration 10
Component ‘Gold’ is made entirely in cost centre 100. Material cost is 6 paise per component and
each component takes 10 minutes to produce. The machine operator is paid 72 paise per hour, and
machine hour rate is ` 1.50. The setting up of the machine to produce the component ‘Gold’ takes
2 hours 20 minutes.
On the basis of this information, prepare a cost sheet showing the production and setting up cost, both
in total and per component, assuming that a batch of :
(a) 10 components,
(b) 100 components, and
(c) 1000 components is produced.
Solution :
Cost Sheet Component ‘Gold’ Amount (`)
Working Notes:
Contract Costing or Terminal Costing as it is often termed, is a variant of the job costing system, which is
applied in businesses engaged in building or other construction work. The jobs are usually the contracts
entered into with the customers. As the number of such contracts handled at a time by a business may
not be usually large, Contract Costing is comparatively simpler in operation than job costing system.
The basic principles applied in Contract Costing are the same as those used in job costing except that
these are modified to suit the particular requirements of the contracts.
of which would be kept on reserve against contingencies. The profit to be transferred to Profit & Loss
Account out of notional profit is ascertained by taking into consideration the degree of completion of
the work, cash received etc.
Some special items under contract accounting are explained below:
(i) Sub-Contract
Sub-contracting, usually of a part of the work, is another essential feature which we frequently come
across in contract work. Sub-contracting may be necessary under the following circumstances:
(a) Work of a specialized nature for which facilities are not internally available within the concern
is offered to a sub-contractor.
(b) It may be advantageous to get a part or component from outside, if it is costlier to manufacture
it.
(c) Consideration of opportunity cost; the management may not like to invest capital which may
be utilized for other more profitable lines.
(d) The capacity of the firm may be limited and in order to keep time schedule, work may be
speeded by offering it to sub-contractors.
The payments made to sub-contractors are charged in totals to the concerned Contract Account
as direct expense and no detailed records or break-up of the sub-contract amount is necessary
for cost purposes.
(ii) Surveyor’s Certificate and Retention Money
In the case of contracts running for long periods of time, it is customary for the contractor’s firm to get
‘on account’ payments against the portion of contract completed. The amount received depends
upon the extent of work certified by the technical assessor i.e. on the surveyor’s certificates, as these
are called. Normally such payments are not received to the full extent of the work completed but
a small percentage is held back as retention money, payable on completion of the contract. The
retention money is a sort of safeguard available to the contractee in case the contractor is not
able to fulfill one or more of the conditions laid down in the contract.
(iii) Defective Work
Defective work will not evidently be paid for by the contractee but the cost of such defective
work should be charged to the Contract Account. Sometimes, rectification of the defective work is
required to be made at the contractor’s cost; the cost of such rectification should also be charged
to the Contract Account but shown separately.
(iv) Escalation Clause
Escalation clauses are often provided in contracts as safeguards against any likely changes in price
or utilisation of material and labour. Such a clause in a contract would provide that in the event of
a specified contingency happening, the contract price would be suitably enhanced. This clause is
particularly necessary where the price of certain raw materials are likely to rise, where labour rates
are anticipated to increase, or where the quantity of material or labour time cannot be properly
assessed or estimated unless the work has sufficiently advanced. There may also be ‘De-escalation
or Reserve Clause’ to provide for any future decrease in price etc. so that the benefit may be
passed on to the contractee.
(v) Work-in-progress
In Contract Accounts, the value of the work-in-progress consists of:-
(a) the cost of work completed, both certified and uncertified,
(b) the cost of work not yet complete, and
(c) the amount of profit taken as credit.
In the Balance Sheet, the work-in-progress is usually shown under two heads, viz. certified and
uncertified. The cost of work completed and certified and the profit credited will appear under
the head ‘certified’ work-in-progress, while the completed work not yet certified and the cost of
labour, material and expenses of work which has not reached the stage of completion are shown
under the head ‘uncertified’ work-in-progress.
(vi) Profit on incomplete contracts
For the purpose of finding out the portion of the profit out of notional profit to be transferred to Profit
and Loss Account, the contracts are divided in the following manner:-
(A) Contracts which have just commenced
In this case no portion of the notional profit shall be transferred to Profit and Loss Account and the
entire amount is kept as reserve. There are no hard and fast rules to determine that a particular
contract is just commenced or reasonably advanced or almost complete. However, as per general
norms, the contracts in which less than 1/4th work is done are regarded as the contracts which have
just commenced.
(B) Contracts which have reasonably advanced
In this case the profit to be transferred to Profit and Loss Account out of notional profit is based on
the degree of completion of the contract. The degree of completion of the contract can be found
out by comparing work certified and the contract price.
(a) If the degree of the completion of the contract is less than or equal to 1/4th no portion of the
notional profit shall be transferred to Profit and Loss Account and the entire amount would be
kept as reserve.
(b) If the degree of completion of work is (> 1/4 and < 1/2), 1/3 of the notional profit shall be
transferred to Profit and Loss Account and the remaining amount would be kept as reserve.
(c) If the degree of completion of work is more than or equal to 1/2, 2/3rd of the notional profit
shall be transferred to Profit and Loss Account and the remaining amount would be kept as
reserve.
The profit so arrived in the above manner shall further be reduced in the ratio of cash received to
work certified. Thus, the formula is as follows:
2 1 (Cash received)
(Notional Profit x or (as the case may be) x
3 3 (Work certified)
(C) Contracts which are almost complete
In this case the portion of the profit to be transferred to Profit and Loss Account is calculated by
using the estimated total profit which is ascertained by subtracting the total cost to date and the
additional cost to complete the contract from the contract price. The different formulas for such
computations of profit are as follows:-
(Work certified)
(i) Estimated Profit x
(Contract price)
Contract A/c..................................................Dr.
To Works Expenses
Direct Expenses
Direct expenses (if any) are directly charged to the concerned contract account.
Contract A/c..................................................Dr.
To Direct Expenses
Indirect Expenses
Indirect expenses (such as expenses of engineers, surveyors, supervisors, corporate office etc.) may be
distributed over several contracts on certain reasonable basis as overheads.
Contract A/c..................................................Dr.
To Overheads A/c
Sub-Contract
Sub-contract costs are also debited to the Contract Account
Contract A/c..................................................Dr.
To Cost of Sub-Contract A/c
Extra work
The extra work amount payable by the contractee should be added to the contract price. if extra
work is substantial, it is better to treat it is a separate contract. If it is not substantial expenses incurred
should be debited to the contract account as “cost of Extra work”.
Illustration 11
A firm of Builders, carrying out large contracts kept in contract ledger, separate accounts for each
contract on 30th June, 2017, the following were shown as being the expenditure in connection with
Contract No. 555.
Amount (`)
Materials purchased 1,16,126
Materials issued from stores 19,570
Plant, which has been used on other contracts 25,046
Additional plant 7,220
Wages 1,47,268
Direct expenses 4,052
Proportionate establishment expenses 17,440
The contract which had commenced on 1st February, 2017 was for ` 6,00,000 and the amount certified
by the Architect, after deduction of 20% retention money, was ` 2,41,600 the work being certified on
30th June, 2017. The materials on site were ` 19,716. A contract plant ledger was also kept in which
depreciation was dealt with monthly the amount debited in respect of that account is ` 2260. Prepare
Contract Account showing profit on the contract.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Materials purchased A/c 1,16,126 By, Work in progress A/c
To, Material issued A/c 19,570 - Work certified 3,02,000
To, Depreciation A/c 2,260
To, Wages A/c 1,47,268 By, Material stock A/c 19,716
To, Direct expenses A/c 4,052
To, Proportionate estab. expenses A/c 17,440
To, P & L A/c [15,000 x 2/3 x 4/5] 8,000
To, Reserve c/d 15,000
3,21,716 3,21,716
Illustration 12
A contractor has undertaken a construction work at a price of ` 5,00,000 and begun the execution of
work on 1st January, 2016. The following are the particulars of the contract up to 31st December, 2016.
It was decided that the profit made on the contract in the year should be arrived at by deducting the
cost of work certified from the total value of the architects certificate, that 1/3 of the profit so arrived at
should be regarded as a provision against contingencies and that such provision should be increased
by taking to the credit of Profit and Loss Account only such portion of the 2/3rd profit, as the cash
received to the work certified.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Illustration 13
A contractor commenced the work on a particular contract on 1st April, 2016 he usually closes his books
of accounts for the year on 31st December of each year. The following information is revealed from his
costing records on 31st December, 2016.
Amount (`)
Materials sent to site 43,000
Jr. Engineer 12,620
Labour 1,00,220
A machine costing ` 30,000 remained in use on site for 1/5th of year. Its working life was estimated at 5
years and scrap value at ` 2,000
A supervisor is paid ` 2,000 per month and had devoted one half of his time on the contract.
All other expenses were `14,000 the materials on site were ` 2,500.
The contract price was ` 4,00,000. On 31st December, 2016 2/3rd of the contract was completed
however, the architect gave certificate only for ` 2,00,000. On which 80% was paid. Prepare Contract
Account.
Solution:
Contract Account
Dr. Cr.
Illustration 14
The following figures are supplied to you by contractor for the year ending 31st December, 2016.
Prepare Contract Ledger Accounts, and the total contractee’s and show the work-in-progress as it
would appear in the Balance sheet.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Work-in-Progress A/c 85,000 By, W.I.P A/c
To, Wages A/c 8,500 Work certified 15,000
To, Materials A/c 6,000 Work uncertified 88,000 1,03,000
To, Materials A/c 10,500 By, Material returned (supplier) 450
To, Working Expenses A/c 1,500 By, Material returned (stores) 550
To, Administration Expenses A/c 1,000 By, Contractee A/c 22,500
To, Plant 2,500
To, P & L A/c 11,500
1,26,500 1,26,500
Illustration 15
The information given under has been extracted from the books of a contractor relating to contract
for `3,75,000.
The value of plant at the end of I year was `4,000 at the end of II year `2,500 and at the end of III year
it was `1,000. It is customary to pay 90% in cash of the amount of work certified. Prepare the contract
Account and show how the figures would appear in the balance sheet.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Illustration 16
A firm of engineers undertook three contracts beginning on 1st Jan, 1st May and 1st August 2015. Their
accounts on 30th November, 2015 showed the following position:
On the respective dates of the contracts, the plant was installed depreciation thereon being taken at
15% p.a. You are required to prepare accounts in the Contract Ledger.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Amount (`)
I II III I II III
To, Materials A/c 14,400 11,600 4,000 By, W.I.P A/c
To, Wages (incl. o/s) A/c 22,700 23,250 3,150 Work certified 40,000 32,000 7,200
To, Gen Expenses A/c 950 650 250 Work uncertified 1,200 1,600 400
To, Dep. On plant A/c 550 280 120 By, Material on hand A/c 800 800 400
(4,000 x 15% x 11/12) By, P & L A/c -- 1,380 --
(3,200 x 15% x 7/12)
(2,400 x 15% x 4/12)
To, Notional profit 3,400 -- 480
42,000 35,780 8,000 42,000 35,780 8,000
To, P & L A/c By, Notional profit 3,400 -- 480
(3,400 x 2/3 x 3/4) 1,700 -- --
To, Reserve c/d 1,700 -- 480
3,400 -- 480 3,400 -- 480
Illustration 17
The following is the Trial Balance of Premier Construction Company, engaged on the execution of
contract No.747, for the year ended 31st December, 2015.
Solution:
Illustration 18
A company of builders took to a multi-storied structure for ` 40,00,000 estimating the cost to be ` 36,80,000.
At the end of the year, the company had received ` 14,40,000 being 90% of the work certified; work
done but not certified was `40,000. Following expenditure were incurred.
`
Materials 4,00,000
Labour 10,00,000
Plant 80,000
Materials costing ` 20,000 were damaged. Plant is considered as having depreciated at 25%.
Prepare Contract Account and show all the possible figures that can reasonably be credited to Profit
and Loss Account.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Material 4,00,000 By, Costing P & L A/c 20,000
To, Labour 10,00,000 By, W.I.P A/c
To, Depreciation 20,000 Work certified 16,00,000
To, Notional Profit 2,40,000 Work uncertified 40,000 16,40,000
16,60,000 16,60,000
(i) 3,20,000 x (1,420/3,680) = 1,23,478
(ii) 3,20,000 x (1,420/3,680) x 90/100 = 1,11,130
(iii) 3,20,000 x 16/40 = 1,28,000
(iv) 3,20,000 x (16/40) x (90/100) = 1,15,200
Illustration 19
The following Trial Balance was extracted on 31st December, 2015 from the books of Swastik Co. Ltd
contractors: Amount (`)
Dr. Cr.
Share Capital:
Shares of `10 each 3,51,800
P&L A/c on 1.1. 2015 25,000
Provision for Dep. on Machinery 63,000
Cash received on account Contract - 7 12,80,000
Creditors 81,200
Land and Buildings (Cost) 74,000
Machinery (Cost) 52,000
Bank 45,000
Contract 7:
Materials 6,00,000
Direct Labour 8,30,000
Expenses 40,000
Machinery on site (Cost) 1,60,000
18,01,000 18,01,000
Contract 7 was begun on 1st Jan 2015. The contract price is ` 24,00,000 and the customer has so far
paid ` 12,80,000 being 80% of the work certified.
The cost of the work done since certification is estimated at ` 16,000. On 31st December, 2015, after the
above Trial Balance was extracted machinery costing ` 32,000 was returned to stores, and materials
then on site were value at `27,000.
Provision is to be made for direct labour due `6,000 and for depreciation of all machinery at 12 1/2 %
on cost.
You are required to prepare:
(a) The Contract Account;
(b) A Statement of Profit, if any, to be properly credited to profit and loss account for 2015 and
(c) The Balance Sheet of Swastik Co. Ltd as on 31st December.
Solution:
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To, Material A/c 6,00,000 By, W.I.P A/c
To, Direct labour A/c 8,36,000 Work certified 16,00,000 16,16,000
To, Expenses A/c 40,000 Work uncertified 16,000
To, Dep. on machinery A/c 20,000 By, Material at site A/c 27,000
To, P & L A/c 78,400
To, Reserve c/d 68,600
16,43,000 16,43,000
Illustration 20
Kapur Engineering Company undertakes long term contract which involves the fabrication of pre stressed
concrete block and the reaction of the same on consumer’s life.
The following information is supplied regarding the contract which is incomplete on 31st March, 2017
Cost Incurred: Amount (`)
Fabrication cost to date:
Direct materials 2,80,000
Direct Labour 90,000
Overheads 75,000
4,45,000
Erection cost to date 15,000
Total 4,60,000
Contract price 8,19,000
Cash received on account 6,00,000
Technical estimate of work completed to date:
Fabrication: Direct materials 80%
Direct labour and overheads 75%
Erection 25%
You are required to prepare a statement for submission to the management indicating
(a) The estimated profit on the completion of the contract;
(b) The estimated profit to date on the contract.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of profit on completion of contract and profit to date: Amount (`)
Illustration 21
The following particulars are obtained from the books of Vinay Construction Ltd. as on March, 2017.
`
Plant and equipment at cost 4,90,000
Vehicles at cost 2,00,000
Details of contract with remain uncompleted as on 31-3-2017.
Contract nos.
Particulars V.29 V.24 V.25
(`lacs) (`lacs) (`lacs)
Estimated final sales value 8.00 5.60 16.00
Estimated cost 6.40 7.00 12.00
Wages 2.40 2.00 1.20
Materials 1.00 1.10 0.44
Overheads (excluding dep.) 1.44 1.46 0.58
4.84 4.56 2.22
Value certified by architects 7.20 4.20 2.40
Progress payments received 5.00 3.20 2.00
Depreciation of plant and Equipment and Vehicle should be charged at 20% to the three contracts in
proportion to work certified. You are required to prepare statements showing contract-wise and total.
(a) Profit/loss to be taken to the P & L A/c for the year ended 31st March, 2017.
(b) Work-in-progress as would appear in the Balance Sheet as at 31-03-2017.
Solution:
(` in Lacs)
Dr. Contract Account Cr.
Illustration 22
A company is manufacturing building bricks and fire bricks. Both the products require two processes.
Brick forming and Heat treatment. The requirements for the two bricks are:
BUILDING BRICKS FIRE BRICKS
Forming per 100 bricks 3 hrs. 2 hrs.
Heat treatment per 100 bricks 2hrs. 5 hrs.
Total costs of the two departments in one month were:
Forming ` 21,200
Heat Treatment `48,800
Production during the month was:
Building Bricks 1,30,000 Nos.
Fire Bricks 70,000 Nos.
Prepare statement of manufacturing costs for the two varieties of bricks.
Solution:
Statement Showing Number of Hours
Statement showing computation of manufacturing cost per two varieties of bricks: Amount (`)
Illustration 23
Deluxe limited undertook a contract for `5,00,000 on 1st July, 2016. On 30th June 2017 when the accounts
were closed, the following details about the contract were gathered:
Solution:
Cost of material & wages incurred = ` (1,00,000 + 45,000 + 5,000 – 25,000 )
= `1,25,000
Cost of material & wages before increase in prices = ` (1,25,000 x 100/125 )
= `1,00,000
Increase in contract price = `25/100 [1,25,000 – ` (1,00,000 x 105/100)]
= `5,000 *
Process Costing
Process costing is that aspect of operation costing which is used to ascertain the cost of the product at
each process or stage of manufacture. This method of accounting used in industries where the process
of manufacture is divided into two or more processes. The objective is to find out the total cost of the
process and the unit cost of the process for each and every process. Usually the industries where process
costing used are textile, oil industries, cement, pharmaceutical etc.
Features of Process Costing
(a) Production is done having a continuous flow of products having a continuous flow of identical
products except where plant and machinery is shut down for repairs etc.
(b) Clearly defined process cost centres and the accumulation of all costs by the cost centres.
(c) The maintenance of accurate records of units and part units produced and cost incurred by each
process.
(d) The finished product of one process becomes the raw material of the next process or operation
and so on until the final product is obtained.
(e) Avoidable and unavoidable losses usually arise at different stages of manufacture for various
reasons.
(f) In order to obtain accurate average costs, it is necessary to measure the production at various
stages of manufacture as all the input units may not be converted into finished goods.
(g) Different products with or without by-products are simultaneously produced at one or more stages
or processes of manufacture. The valuation of by-products and apportionment of joint cost before
joint of separation is an important aspect of this method of costing.
(h) Output is uniform and all units are exactly identical during one or more processes. So the cost
per unit of production can be ascertained only by averaging the expenditure incurred during a
particular period.
Applications of Process Costing
The industries in which process costs may be used are many. In fact a process costing system can
usually be devised in all industries except where job, batch or unit or operation costing is necessary. In
particular, the following are examples of industries where process costing is applied:
Equivalent Production
This represents the production of a process in terms of completed units. In other words it means converting
the incomplete production units into its equivalent of complete units. In each process an estimate
is made of the percentage completion of any work-in-progress. A production schedule and a cost
schedule will then be prepared. The work-in-progress is inspected and an estimate is made of the degree
of completion, usually on a percentage basis. It is most important that this estimate is as accurate as
possible because a mistake at this stage would affects the stock valuation used in the preparation of
final accounts. The formula for equivalent production is:
Equivalent units of work-in-progress
= Actual no.of units in process of manufacture x Percentage of work completed
For example, if 20% work has been done on the average of 1,000 units still in process, then 1,000 such units
will be equal to 200 completed units. The cost of work-in-progress will be equal to 200 completed units.
complete the units added in the process and units in the work in progress. The objective of the first in first
out method is to value the inventory at the current costs and as such the main problem is to calculate
the equivalent production under this method.
Average Method
Process costs are sometimes computed on the basis of average costs. Where degree of completion of
opening work in progress is not given, average method is used. The average process cost is obtained
by adding the cost of opening work in progress and the cost of units introduced in the process during
the current period and dividing this total cost by total equivalent units obtained by adding the number
of units completed and equivalent units of the closing work in progress of each element, material, labor
and overheads. The main object of average method is to even out the fluctuations in prices and hence
is used when the prices fluctuate widely during a particular period.
Weighted Average Method
If a manufacturing unit is manufacturing two or more products, which are quite dissimilar to each other,
weighted average method is used. Under this method, weighted average is computed and used in
valuation of the incomplete units.
Illustration 24
The following particulars for process II are given:
Solution:
Illustration 25
Product-X is obtained after it passes through three distinct processes. You are required to prepare process
account from the following information:
PROCESSES
TOTAL I II III
Material 15,084 5,200 3,960 5,924
Direct wages 18,000 4,000 6,000 8,000
Production overheads 18,000 - - -
1,000 units @ ` 6 per unit was introduced in Process I production overhead to be distributed at 100% on
direct wages.
ACTUAL OUTPUT UNITS NORMAL LOSS VALUE OF SCRAP
(` per unit)
Process-I 950 5% 4
Process-II 840 10% 8
Process-III 750 15% 10
Prepare Process Accounts for I, II & III
Solution:
Dr. PROCESS-I- Account Cr.
Particulars Units Amount Particulars Units Amount
(`) (`)
To, Material introduced 1000 1000 6,000 By, Normal Loss (5% of 950)×4 50 200
@ ` 6/-
To, Additional Material A/c 5,200 By, Transfer to Process-II A/c @ `20/- 950 19,000
per unit
To, Direct Labour A/c 4,000
To, Production Overheads A/c 4,000
1000 19,200 1000 19,200
Illustration 26
A product passes through three processes— A, B and C. 10,000 units at a cost of `1.10 were issued to
Process A. The other direct expenses were as follows:
Solution:
Dr. PROCESS-A- Account Cr.
Dr.
PROCESS-C- Account Cr.
Working Notes:
Scrap value = X × 1 = ` X
68,088 = 72,960 – 7x
7x = 4,872
X= 696 units
696
Percentage of Normal wastage = × 100
9120
= 7.63%
Illustration 27
Degree of completion
Opening stock 1,600 Units Material 70%
Labour 60%
Overhead 60%
Transfer from Process I 10,200 Units
Transfer to next process 9,200 Units
Units scrapped 800 Units
Normal loss 10% of Input
Closing stock 1,800 Units Material 60%
Labour 40%
Overhead 40%
Prepare a Statement of Equivalent Production.
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Illustration 28
From the following information compute (i) Equivalent production (ii) statement of apportionment of
cost, (iii) prepare Process Account.
Work-in-progress (opening) Stage of completion
200 units @ `4 per unit 100% Material
40% Labour & Overheads
Units introduced 1050
Transfer to next process 1100 units
Closing stock 150 units 100% Material
70% Labour and Overhead
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Illustration 29
From the following information prepare process account.
OPENING STOCK DEGREE OF COMPLETION
800 Units @ `6 per unit ` 4,800 Material I - 100%
Material II - 60%
Labour & Overheads 40%
Transfer from Process NO - I
12,000 units costing `16,350
Transfer to next process 9,700 units
Normal process loss 10%
Closing stock 1,800 units
Degree of Completion: For units scrapped:- Material 100% Labour and Overheads 50%.
For closing stock: Material 60%; Labour and overheads 50%
Scrap realized Re.1.00 per unit
Other information: Material `10,500; Labour ` 20,760; Overheads `16,670
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Input Output Units Material-I Material - II Labour Overheads
% Units % Units % Units % Units
800 Opening Stock 800 - - 40 320 60 480 60 480
12000 Normal Loss
(800+12000-1800) x 10% 1100 - - - - - - - -
Finished Units (9700-800) 8900 100 8900 100 8900 100 8900 100 8900
Closing Stock 1800 100 1800 60 1080 50 900 50 900
12600 10700 10300 10280 10280
Add: Abnormal Loss 200 200 100 200 50 100 50 100
12800 12800 10900 10500 10380 10380
Statement of Cost per unit Amount (`)
Illustration 30
SM Ltd., furnished you the following information relating to process B for the month of October, 2017.
(i) Opening work-in-progress- NIL
(ii) Units introduced - 10,000 units @ `3 per unit
(iii) Expenses debited to the process; Direct materials `14,650; Labour `21,148; Overheads ` 42,000
(iv) Finished output - 9,500 units
(v) Closing work-in-progress 350 units; Degree of completion : Material 100%; Labour and overheads
50%
(vi) Normal loss in process- one percent of input
(vii) Degree of completion of abnormal loss: Material 100% ; Labour and Overheads 80%
(viii) Units scrapped as normal loss were sold at `1 per unit
(ix) All the units of abnormal loss were sold at `2.50 per unit.
Prepare:
(a) Statement of Equivalent Production
(b) Statement of Cost
(c) Process - B Account
(d) Abnormal Loss Account
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Illustration 31
AB Ltd. is engaged in process Engineering Industry. During the month of April, 2015, 2,000 units were
introduced in Process ‘X’. The normal loss was estimated at 5% of input. At the end of the month 1,400
units had been produced and transferred to process Y. 460 units incomplete and 140 units after passing
through fully the entire process had to be scrapped. The incomplete units had reached the following
stage of completion.
Units scrapped relaised ` 10 each. Prepare Statement of Equivalent Production, Statement of Cost,
Statement of Evaluation and the Process X Account.
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Illustration 32
The product of a manufacturing unit passes through two distinct processes. From the past experience
the incidence of wastage is ascertained as under:
PROCESS ‘A’ 2%
PROCESS ‘B’ 10%
In each case the percentage of wastage is computed on the number of units entering the process
concerned. The sales realisation of wastage in Process A and B are ` 25 per 100 units and `50 per 100
units respectively.
The following information is obtained for the month of April, 2015; 40,000 units of crude material were
introduced in Process A at a cost of ` 16,000.
Particulars PROCESS A PROCESS B
Amount (`) Amount (`)
Other Materials 16,000 5,000
Direct Labour 9,000 8,000
Direct Expenses 8,200 1,500
Units Units
Output 39,000 36,500
Finished Product Stock:
April 1 6,000 5,000
April 30 5,000 8,000
Value of stock per unit on April 1st 1.20 1.60
Stocks are valued and transferred to subsequent process at weighted average costs. Prepare respective
Process Accounts and Stock Accounts.
Solution:
Dr. Process A- Account Cr.
Illustration: 33
The following information is obtained in respect of process 3 of the month of August:
Opening Stock 1,000 units
Value Direct Material (I) ` 390; Direct material (II) ` 75;
Direct Labour - ` 112; Production overhead - ` 118.
Process 2 transfer 6,000 units at ` 2,360
Process 4 transfer 4,700 units.
Direct material added in process ` 520
Direct labour employed ` 1,036
Production Over Heads ` 1,541
Units scrapped 300
Degree of completion Direct material 100%
Direct labour 80%
Production overhead 60%
Closing stock 2,000 units
Degree of completion: Direct material 60%
Direct labour 50%
Production overhead 40%
Solution:
Statement of Equivalent Production
Statement of Cost
Material-I Material-II Labour Overheads
Opening stock 390 75 112 118
Add: during the period 2360 520 1036 1541
2750
Less: Scrap value of
Normal Loss (250 x 0.2) 50 2700 595 1148 1659
Cost per unit (`) 0.40 0.10 0.20 0.30
Amount (`)
Material I 2000 x 0.40 = 800
Material II 1200 x 0.10 = 120
Labour 1000 x 0.20 = 200
Overheads 800 x 0.30 = 240
= 1360
Amount (`)
Material I 50 x 0.40 = 20
Material II 50 x 0.10 = 5
Labour 40 x 0.20 = 8
Overheads 30 x 0.30 = 9
= 42
joint cost and the apportionment of the same to different products is the main objective of the
joint product accounting.
(f) The management has little or no control over the relative quantities of the various products that
will result.
(g) Joint products are commonly produced in industries like, chemicals, oil refining, mining, meatpacking,
automobile etc. In oil refining, fuel, oil, petrol, diesel, kerosene, lubricating oil are few examples of
the joint products.
Accounting Treatment
In case of joint products, the main objective of accounting of the cost is to apportion the joint costs
incurred up to the split off point. As discussed earlier, the manufacturing process is same up to a certain
stage and after crossing that stage; each product has distinct manufacturing process. Therefore the
main problem is apportionment of the joint cost or the cost incurred up to the split off point. The total
cost of production of the joint product will be cost incurred up to the split off point duly apportioned
plus the cost incurred after the split off point. There is no problem of charging the cost incurred after the
split off point as the cost can be identified easily. The main problem therefore is that of apportionment
of the joint cost and the following methods are used for apportioning the same.
(i) Physical Quantity Method: Under this method, cost apportionment is made in proportion to the
volume of production. These physical measures may be units, pounds, liters, kilos, tones, gallons
etc.
(ii) Average Unit Cost Method: Under this method, the joint cost is apportioned to the joint products
by computing the average unit cost of the product units. The average unit cost is computed by
dividing the total manufacturing cost by the total number of units produced of all products. This
method is useful where all the products produced are uniform with each other in all the respects.
This method will not be useful if the production units are not similar with each other.
(iii) Weighted Average Method: Under this method, weights are assigned to each unit based upon
size of the units, difference in type of labor employed, material consumption, market share, efforts
of labour required and so on. The joint cost is apportioned on the basis of the weights assigned to
each product. This method is highly useful if the weights assigned are on objective basis. If subjective
element creeps in, the method may not give accurate results.
(iv) Selling Price Method: Under this method, the joint cost is apportioned on the basis of sales value at
the split off point. The logic is that a product should bear the share of the joint cost according to
its sale price. If sales price is higher than that of the other products, more share of joint cost should
be charged to that product and if it is comparatively less than that of other products, less share
of joint cost should be charged to the same. Though logically this method seems to be sound, in
practice, charging higher share of joint cost to the product with higher sales value may not be
justified due to the fact that lesser efforts are required for manufacturing of the same.
Meaning of By-Products
The term ‘by-products’ is sometimes used synonymously with the term ‘minor products’. The by-product is
a secondary product, which incidentally results from the manufacture of a main product. By–products are
also produced from the same raw material and same process operations but they are secondary results
of operation. The main difference between the joint product and byproduct is that there is no intention
to produce the by-product while the joint products are produced intentionally. The relationship between
the by-product and the main product changes with changes in economic or industrial conditions or
with advancement of science. The by-product of an industry may become a main product and main
product may become a by-product subsequently.
For example, (a) in sugar industry, sugar is a main product and molasses is a by-product (b) in coke
ovens, gas and tar are incidentally produced in addition to the main product coke. Gas and tar are,
therefore, treated as by-products. These minor secondary products have saleable or usable value and
are incidentally produced in addition to the main product.
In CIMA Terminology, By-product is “a product which is recovered incidentally from the material used in
the manufacture of recognized main products such as having either a net realizable value or a usable
value which is relatively low in comparison with the saleable value of the main products. By products
may further be processed to increase their realizable value”.
Thus the term ‘by-product’ is generally used by businessmen and accountants to denote one or more
products of relatively small value that are produced simultaneously with a product of greater value.
Classification of By-Products
By-products can be classified into two groups according to marketable conditions at the split off point:
(a) Those sold in the same form as originally produced, and
(b) Those which may undergo further processing before sale.
Accounting treatment
By-products are jointly produced products of minor importance and do not have separate costs until the
split off point. They are not produced intentionally but are emerging out of the manufacturing process
of the main products. The following methods are used for accounting of by-products. The methods are
broadly divided into Non-Cost Methods and Cost Methods.
(A) Non-Cost Methods: The following methods are included in this category.
(i) Other income or miscellaneous income method: Under this method, sales value of by-products
is credited to the Profit and Loss Account and no credit is given in the Cost Accounts. The credit
to the Profit and Loss Account is treated as other income or miscellaneous income. No effort
is made for ascertaining the cost of the product. No valuation of inventory is made and all
costs and expenses are charged to the main product. This is the least scientific method and
is used where the sales value of the by-product is negligible.
(ii) Total sales less total cost: Under this method, sales value of by-product is added to the sales
value of the main product. Further the total cost of the main product including the cost of the
by-product is deducted from the sales revenue of the main product and by-product. All costs
and expenses are charged to the main product.
(iii) Total cost less sales value of by-product: In this method, the total cost of production is reduced
by the sales value of the by-product. This method seems to be more acceptable because like
waste and scrap, by-product revenue reduces the cost of major products.
(iv) Total cost less sales value of by-products after setting off selling and distribution overheads
of by-products: Sales value of the by-product minus the selling and distribution overheads of
byproduct is deducted from the total cost. Selling and distribution overheads are charged
against by-products actually sold.
Reverse cost method: This method is based on the view that the sales value of the by-product
(v)
contains an element of profit. It is agreed that this element of profit should not be credited
to the Profit and Loss Account. The cost of by-product is arrived at by working backwards.
Selling price of the by-product is deflated by an assumed gross profit margin. Thus under this
method, sales value of the by-product is first reduced by, an estimated profit margin, selling and
distribution expenses and then the post split off costs and then the cost of the main product
is thus reduced by this net figure.
(B) Cost Methods: The following methods are included in this category.
(i) Replacement or opportunity cost method: If the by-products are consumed captively, they
are valued at the opportunity cost method or replacement cost method. This means the
cost which would have been incurred had the by-product been purchased from outside. For
example, bagasse, which is one of the main by-product of sugar industry and which is used
for the factory as a fuel in the boiler is valued at the market value, i.e. the price that would
have been paid if it would have been purchased from outside.
(ii) Standard cost method: Under this method, the by-product is valued at the standard cost
determined for each product. The standard cost may be based on technical assessment.
Standard cost of the by-product is credited to the process account of the main product.
Accordingly, the cost control of main product can be exercised effectively.
(iii) Joint cost proration: Where the by-product is of some significance, it is appropriate that the
joint costs should be apportioned between the main products and by-products on a most
suitable and acceptable method. Thus in this method, no distinction is made between the
joint product and byproduct. Industries, where the by-products are quite important, use this
method. For example, in a petroleum refinery, gas was earlier considered as a by-product.
Now it has assumed the importance like petrol, diesel etc. and is being treated as joint product.
Accordingly, the joint cost is prorated between the joint product and the by-product.
There are instances when a by-product attains so much importance in terms of sales value and/or the
company objective, then it is regarded as a main product. There are also instances when a by-product
is more important than the main product, so that they by-product becomes the main product and the
main product becomes the by-product.
Illustration 34
X, Y Ltd. manufactures product A which yields two by-products B and C. The actual joint expenses of
manufacturing for a period were ` 8,200.
The profits on each product as a percentage of sales are 33-1/3%, 25% and 15% respectively. Subsequent
expenses are as follows:
Products Amount (`)
Solution:
Statement Showing Apportionment of Joint Expenses
Particulars A B C Total
Sales 6,000 4,000 2,500 12,500
(-) Profit 2,000 1,000 375 3,375
Total Cost (Joint & Separate cost) 4,000 3,000 2,125 9,125
Separate Expenses 450 325 150 925
Share of Joint Expenses 3,550 2,675 1,975 8,200
Illustration 35
A chemical process yields 60% of the material introduced as main Product - A and by Product B 15%
by - Product - C 20% and 5% being the wastage.
The ratio of absorption of Raw material and Labour in the process products is as follows :
(i) One unit of product C requires half the raw material required for one unit of product - B, one unit
of product - A requires 1 ½ time the raw material required for product - B.
(ii) Product A requires double the time needed for the production of one unit of B and one unit of C
(iii) Product C requires half the time required for the production of one unit of product B
(iv) Overheads are to be absorbed in the ratio of 6:1:1
(v) Cost Data: Input 1,000 units of cost `4,600
Direct labour `4,100
Overheads `6,000
Calculate cost of distribution between the above products.
Solution:
A = 1,000 x 60% = 600 units
B = 1,000 x 15% = 150 units
C = 1,000 x 20% = 200 units
Wasteage = 1,000 x 5% = 50 units
Material:
A : B : C = 3 x 600 : 2 x 150 : 1 x 200
= 1800 : 300 : 200
= 18 : 3 : 2
Labour:
A : B : C = 6 x 600 : 2 x 150 : 1 x 200
= 3600 : 300 : 200
= 36 : 3 : 2
Illustration 36
The following data have been extracted from the books of M/s. Southern Coke Co. Ltd.
Benzol 22
Sulphate of Ammonia 26
Gas 412
2,000
The price of coal is `80 per tonne. The direct labour and overhead costs to the point of split-off are `40
and `60 respectively per tonne of coal. Calculate the material, labour and total cost of each product
on the basis of weight.
Solution:
Statement Showing Calculation of Material, Labour and Total Cost of Each Product Amount (`)
Illustration 37
A factory engaged in the production of Chemical X and in the course of manufacture in a by-product-Y
is produced which after a separate process has a commercial value. Following are the information for
the month of March.
Solution:
Joint Expenses Account
Dr. Cr.
X’s Account
Dr. Cr.
Y’s Account
Dr. Cr.
Illustration 38
In manufacturing the main product ‘A’ a company processes the resulting waste material into two by
products B and C. Using reversal cost method of by products, prepare a comparative profit and loss
statement of the three products from the following data:
(i) Total cost upto separation point was ` 68,000 Amount (`)
A B C
(ii) Sales (all production) 1,64,000 16,000 24,000
(iii) Estimated net profit
% to sale value — 20% 30%
(iv) Estimated Selling expenses as
% of sales value 20% 20% 20%
(v) Costs after separation — 4,800 7,200
Solution:
Apportionment of Joint expenses for the products Amount (`)
Particulars B C
Sales 16,000 24,000
(-) Profit 3,200 7,200
Total Cost 12,800 16,800
(-) Selling expenses 3,200 4,800
Manufacturing cost 9,600 12,000
(-) Separate expenses 4,800 7,200
Joint Expenses 4,800 4,800
Joint expenses of A = 68,000 – (4,800 + 4,800) = 58,400.
Profit and Loss Statement Amount (`)
Particulars A B C Total
(i) Joint cost 58,400 4,800 4,800 68,000
(ii) Separate cost -- 4,800 7,200 12,000
(iii) Manufacturing cost (I + II) 58,400 9,600 12,000 80,000
(iv) Selling expenses 32,800 3,200 4,800 40,800
(v) Total cost (III + IV) 91,200 12,800 16,800 1,20,800
(vi) Profit * 72,800 3,200 7,200 83,200
(vii) Sales 1,64,000 16,000 24,000 2,04,000
Illustration 39
The progressive manufacturing company manufactures one main product and two by-products. Data
for month are shown below:
Solution:
Calculation of Selling Expenses
Illustration 40
In a factory producing joint products of two varieties, the following data are extracted from the books:
TOTAL (`)
Sales of products X and Y 7,50,000
Direct Material 2,25,000
Direct Labour 1,10,000
Variable Overhead (150% on Labour) 1,65,000
Fixed Overhead 2,00,000
The analysis of sales reveals that the percentage of sale of product X is 66 2 % .
3
Management contemplates to process further joint products so that they could be sold at higher
rates. Facilities for this are available. The additional expenditure for the further process and total sales
anticipated at higher selling prices are given below. Make recommendations presenting the affect of
the proposal.
Solution:
Amount (`)
Particulars X Y Total
(i) Sales after further processing 6,00,000 3,00,000 9,00,000
(ii) Sales at split off 5,00,000 2,50,000 7,50,000
(iii) Incremental sales 1,00,000 50,000 1,50,000
(iv) Incremental/Additional/further processing / Separate
cost:
Material 50,000 20,000 70,000
Labour 20,000 8,000 28,000
Variable Overheads 30,000 12,000 42,000
(v) Incremental Profit/Loss -- 10,000 10,000
It is recommended to further process Product Y because there is an incremental / additional profit
` 10,000 where as product X need not be further processed because there is no additional profit.
Illustration 41
A vegetable oil refining company obtains four products whose cost details are:
Joint costs of the four products: ` 8,29,600
Outputs : A - 5,00,000 litres; B -10,000 litres,C- 5,000 litres and D- 9,000 kgs.
Further processing costs: A ` 2,40,000; B ` 48,000, C-Nil and D-` 8,030.
The products can be sold as intermediates i.e., at split-off point without further processing. The sale
prices are:
As finished Product As Intermediate
A ` Per litre 1.84 1.20
B ` Per litre 8.00 4.00
C ` per litre 6.40 6.40
D ` Per Kg. 26.67 24.00
(a) Calculate the product-wise profit allocating joint costs on Net Realisable Values (NRV).
(b) Compare the profitability in selling the products with and without further processing.
Solution:
(a) Statement showing computation of profit after further processing Amount (`)
Particulars A B C D Total
(i) Sales after further processing 9,20,000 80,000 32,000 2,40,030 12,72,030
(ii) Separate / further costs 2,40,000 48,000 -- 8,030 2,96,030
(iii) Sales at split off
(being NRV) (I-II) 6,80,000 32,000 32,000 2,32,000 9,76,000
(iv) Joint costs (NRV basis) 5,78,000 27,200 27,200 1,97,200 8,29,600
(v) Profit 1,02,000 4,800 4,800 34,800 1,46,400
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales at split off 6,00,000 40,000 32,000 2,16,000 8,88,000
(II) Joint costs as apportioned above 5,78,000 27,200 27,200 1,97,200 8,29,600
(III) Profit (I – II) 22,000 12,800 4,800 18,800 58,400
(b) Statement Showing Computation of Incremental or Additional Profit by Further Process Amount (`)
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales after further processing 9,20,000 80,000 32,000 2,40,030 12,72,030
(II) Sales before further processing 6,00,000 40,000 32,000 2,16,000 8,88,000
(III) Incremental or additional sales (I-II) 3,20,000 40,000 - 24,030 3,84,030
(IV) Incremental cost 2,40,000 48,000 - 8,030 2,96,030
(III) Additional Profit or Loss (III-IV) 80,000 (8,000) - 16,000 88,000
Products A&D should be further process, because there is incremental profit and where as products B
and C need not be further process.
Alternative Method:
Statement Showing Computation of Profit Before Further Processing (on the basis of sales)
Amount (`)
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales before further processing/split off 6,00,000 40,000 32,000 2,16,000 8,88,000
(II) Joint costs 8,29,000 x (6,00,000/8,88,000) 5,60,540 37,369 29,895 2,01,796 8,29,600
(III) Profit 39,460 2,631 2,105 14,204 58,400
Statement Showing Computation of Profit After Further Processing (on basis of sales)
Amount (`)
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales at split off 6,80,000 32,000 32,000 2,32,000 9,76,000
(II) Joint costs as apportioned above. 5,60,540 37,369 29,895 2,01,796 8,29,600
(III) Profit or Loss 1,19,460 (5,369) 2,105 30,204 1,46,400
Illustration 42
T Ltd., in the course of refining crude oil obtains four joint products A, B, C and D. The total cost till the
split off point was ` 97,600. The output and sales in the year 2015 were as follows:
C 5,000 4,000 —
Solution:
Statement Showing Computation of Profit After Further Processing: Amount (`)
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales at further processing 1,15,000 10,000 4,000 30,000 1,59,000
(II) Separate cost 30,000 6,000 -- 1,000 37,000
(III) Sales at Split off (I) - (II) 85,000 4,000 4,000 29,000 1,22,000
(IV) Joint Costs (On basis of NRV) 68,000 3,200 3,200 23,200 97,600
(V) Profit (III) - (IV) 17,000 800 800 5,800 24,400
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales at split off 75,000 5,000 4,000 27,000 1,11,000
(II) Joint Cost (as apportioned above) 68,000 3,200 3,200 23,200 97,600
(III) Profit (I) - (II) 7,000 1,800 800 3,800 13,400
Particulars A B C D Total
(I) Sales after further process 1,15,000 10,000 4,000 30,000 1,59,000
(II) Sales at split off (I) - (II) 75,000 5,000 4,000 27,000 1,11,000
(III) Incremental sales 40,000 5,000 -- 3,000 48,000
(IV) Incremental/Separate costs 30,000 6,000 -- 1,000 37,000
(V) Incremental Profit (loss) (III) - (IV) 10,000 (1,000) -- 2,000 11,000
Product ‘A’ and ‘D’ should be further processed because there is additional profit where as product
‘B’ and ‘C’ need not be further processed because there is no additional profit.
Computation of Profit by implementing decision:
Amount (`)
Profit from A = 17,000
Profit from B = 1,800
Profit from C = 800
Profit from D = 5,800
= 25,400
Illustration 43
Beauty soap, company manufactures four different brands of soaps namely Komal, Lovely, Makeup
and Nice. The data on production and sale of these brands during 2015 is reproduced below.
All the above soaps are manufactured jointly up to a particular process. At split off point they are formed
into cake-sand packed. The annual cost data were as under.
Out of the above brands, Make up is sold in unpacked condition without further processing while other
3 brands further processed at an additional cost:
Komal `1,20,000
Lovely `1,30,000 and
Nice ` 50,000
You are required to:-
(a) Work out the profit and cost of each brand of soap after allocating joint cost on the basis of Net
Realisable value at split up point. (per unit cost not required).
(b) Find out revised cost and profit on each brand if the company decides to sell all soaps at split up
point at following prices; Komal ` 4.50; Lovely `6.00; Make up ` 4.00 and Nice ` 1.50 per unit.
Assume that for allocation of joint cost net Realisable value method is used.
(c) With the working results in (a) and (b) above advise Beauty Soap Company about the processing
decision as to which soap to ;be sold at split of point and which to be processed further so as to
maximise profit. Substantiate your decision with suitable costing technique.
Solution:
Particulars K L M N Total
(I) Sales after further processing 15,00,000 31,00,000 2,80,000 1,20,000 50,00,000
(II) Separate cost 1,20,000 1,30,000 - 50,000 3,00,000
(III) Sales before further processing NRV= 13,80,000 29,70,000 2,80,000 70,000 47,00,000
(I-II)
(IV) Joint Costs (on basis of NRV) 10,86,383 23,38,085 2,20,426 55,106 37,00,000
(V) Profit or Loss (III-IV) 2,93,617 6,31,915 59,574 14,894 10,00,000
Illustration 44
In the course of manufacture of the main product ‘P’ by products ‘A’ and ‘B’ also emerge. The joint
expenses of manufacture amount to ` 1,19,550. All the three products are processed further after
separation and sold as per details given below:
Main product By products
P A B
Sales 90,000 60,000 40,000
Cost incurred after separation 6,000 5,000 4,000
Profit as percentage on sales 25 20 15
Total fixed selling expenses are 10% of total cost of sales which are apportioned to the three products
in the ratio of 20 : 40 : 40.
(a) Prepare a statement showing the apportionment of joint costs to the main product and the two
by products.
(b) If the by-product A is not subjected to further processing and is sold the point of separation for which
there is a market, at `58,500 without incurring any selling expenses. Would you advise its disposal
at this stage. Show the workings.
Solution:
(a) Statement showing computation of share of joint expenses Amount (`)
Particulars Main Product P By Product A By Product B Total
(i) Sales 90,000 60,000 40,000 1,90,000
(ii) Profit 22,500 12,000 6,000 40,500
(iii) Cost of sales (I - II) 67,500 48,000 34,000 1,49,500
(iv) Selling expenses 2,990 5,980 5,980 14,950
(v) Manufacturing cost (III - IV) 64,510 42,020 28,020 1,34,550
(vi) Separate costs 6,000 5,000 4,000 15,000
(vii) Share of joint expenses (V – VI) 58,510 37,020 24,020 1,19,550
Amount (`)
Sales at split off (A) = 58,500
(-) Joint Cost (A) = 37,020
= 21,480
(b) It is better to sell By-Product ‘A’ at split off point because it gives more profit ` 21,480 against profit
after processing ` 12,000.
Illustration 45
“If the products are truly joint products the cost of the process can be applied to these products”.
(i) On the basis of the weight or other physical quantity of each product.
(ii) In respect of the marginal cost of the process on the basis of physical quantities and in respect of
fixed costs of the process on the basis of the contribution made by the various products.
(iii) On the basis of selling values of the different products
Illustrate the above statement by using the following figures in respect of joint production of A and B
for a month.
TOTAL COST: Direct Material 5,000
Direct labour 3,000
Variable Overheads 2,000
Fixed Overheads 2,000
Sales ——— A 100 Qtls. ` 80 per qtl
Sales ——— B 150 Qtls. ` 40 per qtl
Solution:
Computation of Profit by Distributing Joint Costs on the basis of Weight
Amount (`)
Particulars A B Total
(i) Sales 8,000 6,000 14,000
(ii) Costs (100 : 150) 4,800 7,200 12,000
(iii) Profit / (Loss) 3,200 (1,200) 2,000
Computation of Profit by Distributing Variable Cost on the Basis of Weight & Fixed Cost on basis of
Contribution Amount (`)
Particulars A B Total
(i) Sales 8,000 6,000 14,000
(ii) Variable costs (100 : 150) 4,000 6,000 10,000
(iii) Contribution 4,000 -- 4,000
(iv) Fixed cost 2,000 -- 2,000
(v) Profit 2,000 -- 2,000
Particulars A B Total
(i) Sales 8,000 6,000 14,000
(ii) Total cost 6,857 5,143 12,000
(iii) Profit 1,143 857 2,000
TRANSPORT ORGANISATION
Costing in a transport industry consists of determining the operating cost of each vehicle and applying
this cost to find out the cost per unit of service rendered by a vehicle. The cost unit is selected with proper
care keeping in view the needs of each concern, the weight, bulk, volume and type of goods carried
and distance covered in each trip. Transport undertakings include goods transport organizations as well
as passenger transport organizations. The cost unit is either ton kilometer or passenger kilometer. The
meaning is cost of carrying one ton over a distance of one kilometer or cost of carrying one passenger
for a distance of one kilometer.
Collection of Costs: A log book is maintained for each vehicle to record details of trips made by the
vehicle during a specified period of time. Log book is maintained usually on a daily basis. The details
shown in the log book enables the management to make suitable allocation of vehicles, to avoid the
duplicate trips, or to avoid idle running capacity. The log book also provides the information relating
to the fuel consumed, distance travelled, no of hours travelled, chargeable kilo meters. The log book
provide the data for proper allocation of cost and in this respect these may be compared with the
production details available in a manufacturing concern
Classification of Costs
The costs of a transport organisation can be classified and accumulated under the following heads:-
(a) Fixed or stand-by costs: These costs which include garage charges, insurance, taxes, license,
depreciation, wages of drivers, cleaner’s salary, establishment cost of workshop and office. Out
of the above some of the costs are directly identifiable for each vehicle such as license fee and
some are apportioned such as office expenses
(b) Maintenance Charges: These costs are in the nature of semi-variable nature includes expenditure
on maintenance, repairs, tyres, tubes and other charges.
(c) Operating and Running costs: These costs are variable in nature, includes fuel, lubricating oil, wages
of drivers / cleaners (if paid on per trip / kilometer). These costs can be easily identifiable with each
of the vehicle.
Illustration 46
There are two warehouses for storing finished goods produced in a factory. Warehouse ‘A’ is at a distance
of 10 kms. and Warehouse ‘B’ is at a distance of 15 kms from the factory. A fleet of 5 tonne lorries is
engaged in transporting the finished goods from the factory. The records show that the lorries average
a speed of 30 kms. per hour when running and regularly take 40 minutes to load at the factory. At
warehouse ‘A’ unloading takes 30 minutes per load while at warehouse ‘B’ it takes 20 minutes per load.
Drivers’ Wages, depreciation, insurance and taxes amount to `18 per hour operated. Fuel oil, tyres,
repairs and maintenance cost ` 2.40 per kilometer. You are required to draw up a statement showing
the cost per tonne kilometer of carrying the finished goods to the two warehouses.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of total cost and cost per tonne kilometer of carrying finished goods
to warehouses:
Particulars A B
Time for travelling 40 Min 60 Min
Time for loading 40 Min 40 Min
Time for unloading 30 Min 20 Min
110 Min 120 Min
Cost of Insurance, wages, tax, etc. [(110/60) x 18] 33.00
[(120/60) x 18] ` 36.00
Fuel & oil etc. (20 x 2.4) (30 x 2.4) ` 48.00 72.00
Total Cost ` 81.00 108.00
Tonne Kilometers (5 x 10) (5 x 15) ` 50.00 75.00
Cost per tonne KM ` 1.62 1.44
Illustration 47
A transport service company is running 4 buses between two towns which are 50 miles apart. Seating
capacity of each bus is 40 passengers. The following particulars were obtained from their books for
April, 2015.
Amount (`)
Wages of Drivers, Conductors and Cleaners 2,400
Salaries of Office and Supervisory Staff 1,000
Diesel and oil and other oil 4,000
Repairs and Maintenance 800
Taxation, Insurance, etc. 1,600
Depreciation 2,600
Interest and Other Charges 2,000
14,400
Actual passengers carried were 75% of the seating capacity. All the four buses ran on all days of the
month. Each bus made one round trip per day. Find out the cost per passenger mile.
Solution:
Computation of Cost per Passenger Mile
Passenger miles = No. of buses x Distance x Round trip x No. of Passengers x No. of days in
month x Capacity.
= 4 x 50 x 2 x 40 x 30 x 75%
= 3,60,000 miles
Cost per passenger mile = 14,400 / 3,60,000
= ` 0.04
Illustration 48
Mr. Sohan Singh has started transport business with a fleet of 10 taxies. The various expenses incurred
by him are given below:
(i) Cost of each taxi ` 75,000
(ii) Salary of office Staff ` 1,500 p.m.
(iii) Salary of Garage’s Supervisor ` 2,000 p.m.
(iv) Rent of Garage ` 1,000 p.m
(v) Drivers Salary (per taxi) ` 400 pm.
(vi) Road Tax and Repairs per taxi ` 2,160 p.a.
(vii) Insurance premium @ 4% of cost p.a.
The life of a taxi is 3,00,000 km. and at the end of which it is estimated to be sold at ` 15,000. A taxi runs
on an average 4,000 Km. per month of which 20% it runs empty, petrol consumption 9 Km. per litre of
petrol costing ` 6.30 per litre. Oil and other sundry expenses amount to ` 10 per 100 Km.
Calculate the effective cost of running a taxi per kilometre. If the hire charge is ` 1.80 per Kilometre, find
out the profit that Mr.Shoan may expect to make in the first year of operation.
Solution:
Statement Showing Computation of Effective Cost and Profit for the Year
Illustration 49
Janata Transport Co. has been given a route 20 km. long for running buses. The company has a fleet of
10 buses each costing ` 50,000 and having a life of 5 years without any scrap value.
From the following estimated expenditure and other details calculate the bus fare to be charged from
each passenger.
(i) Insurance charges 3 % p.a.
(ii) Annual tax for each bus ` 1,000
(iii) Total garage charges `1,000
(iv) Drivers’ salary for each bus `150 p.m
(v) conductor’s salary for each bus `100 p.m
(Vi) Annual repairs to each bus `1,000
(vii) Commission to be shared by the driver and conductor
equally: 10% of the takings
(viii) Cost of stationary `500 p.m.
(ix) Manager’s salary `2,000 p.m.
(x) Accountant’s salary `1,500 p.m.
(xii) Petrol and oil `25 per 100 km
Each bus will make 3 round trips carrying on an average 40 passengers on each trip. The bus will run
on an average for 25 days in a month. Assuming 15% profit on takings, calculate, the bus fare to be
charged from each passenger.
Solution:
⇒ X = 35,000
Fare per passenger Km = 35,000 / (30,000 x 40)
= 0.0292 = ` 0.03
Illustration 50
Union Transport Company supplies the following details in respect of a truck of 5 tonne capacity
Cost of truck ` 90,000
Estimated life 10 years
Diesel, oil, grease ` 15 per trip each way
Repairs and maintenance `500 p.m.
Driver’s wages ` 500 p.m.
Cleaner’s wages ` 250 p.m.
Insurance ` 4,800 per year
Tax `2,400 per year
General supervision charges `4,800 per year
The truck carries goods to and from the city covering a distance of 50 kms. each way.
On outward trip freight is available to the extent of full capacity and on return 20% of capacity.
Assuming that the truck runs on an average 25 days a month, work out:
(a) Operating cost tonne-km.
(b) Rate for tonne per trip that the company should charge if a profit of 50% on freight is to be earned.
Solution:
HOTELS
Service costing is an effective tool in respect of hotel industry which run on commercial basis. Hence
it is necessary to compute the cost in order to determine the price of various services provided by the
hotel and to find out the profit or loss at the end of a particular period.
In this case, the costs associated with different services offered may be identified and cost per unit may
be worked out. The cost unit may be Guest-day or room-day. For calculation of cost per guest day or
room day, estimated occupancy rate at different point of time are taken into account, for example,
peak season or lean season.
Illustration 51
XYZ Ltd. runs a holiday home. For this purpose, it has hired a building at a rent of `10,000 per month
along with 5% of total taking. It has three types of suites for its customers, viz., single room, double rooms
and triple rooms.
Following information is available:
Particulars `
Staff salaries 14,25,000
Room attendants’ wages 4,50,000
Lighting, heating and power 2,15,000
Repairs and renovation 1,23,500
Laundry charges 80,500
Interior decoration 74,000
Sundries 1,53,000
Provide profit @ 20% on total taking and assume 360 days in a year.
Calculate the rent to be charged for each type of suite.
Solution:
Working Notes:
Total equivalent single room suites
Nature of suite Occupancy (Room-days) Equivalent single room suite
(Room- days)
Single room suites 36,000 36,000
(100 rooms × 360 days × 100%) (36,000 × 1)
Double rooms suites 14,400 36,000
(50 rooms × 360 days × 80%) (14,400 × 2.5)
Triple rooms suites 6,480 32,400
(30 rooms × 360 days × 60%) (6,480 × 5)
1,04,400
Particulars `
Staff salaries 14,25,000
Room attendants’ wages 4,50,000
Lighting, heating and power 2,15,000
Repairs and renovation 1,23,500
Laundry charges 80,500
Interior decoration 74,000
Sundries 1,53,000
Building rent {(Rs.10,000 × 12 months) + 5% on total taking} 25,21,000
1,20,000 + 5% on total takings
Total cost 26,41,000 + 5% on total takings
Profit is 20% of total takings
\ Total takings = ` 26,41,000 + 25% (5% + 20%) of total takings
Let R be rent for single room suite
Then 1,04,400 R = 26,41,000 + (0.25 × 1,04,400 R)
Or, 1,04,400 R = 26,41,000 + 26,100 R
Or, 78,300 R = 26,41,000
Or, R = ` 33.73
Rent to be charged:
Rent to be charged for single room suite = ` 33.73
Rent for double rooms suites = ` 33.73 × 2.5 = ` 84.33
Rent for triple room suites = ` 33.73 × 5 = `168.65
Illustration 52
Angel Holiday Home runs in a small hill station with 100 single rooms. The home offers concessional
rates during six off season months in a year. During this period, half of the full room rent is charged. The
management’s profit margin is targeted at 20% of the room rent. The following are the cost estimates
and other details for the year ending on 31st March 2018 [Assume a month as 30 days].
(i) Occupancy during the season is 80% while in the off- season it is 40% only.
(ii) Total investment in the home is ` 200 lakhs of which 80% relate to buildings and balance for furniture
and equipment.
(iii) Expenses:
Particulars `
Staff salary [Excluding room attendants] 5,50,000
Repairs to building 2,61,000
Laundry charges 80,000
Interior 1,75,000
Miscellaneous expenses 1,90,800
Annual depreciation is to be provided for buildings @ 5% and on furniture and equipment @ 15%
on straight-line basis.
(v) Room attendants are paid `10 per room day on the basis of occupancy of the rooms in a month.
(vi) Monthly lighting charges are `120 per room, except in four months in winter when it is ` 30 per room
and this cost is on the basis of full occupancy for a month.
You are required to work out the room rent chargeable per day both during the season and the off-
season months on the basis of the foregoing information.
Solution:
Working Notes
Total Room days in a year
Lighting Charges
It is given in the question that lighting charges for 8 months is `120 per month and during winter season
of 4 months it is ` 30 per month. Further it is also given that peak season is 6 months and off season is 6
months.
Being Hill station, winter season is to be considered as part of off-season. Hence, the non-winter season
of 8 months include: peak season of 6 months and off-season of 2 months.
Hence, the lighting charges are calculated as follows:
Particulars `
Staff salary 5,50,000
Repairs to building 2,61,000
Laundry & Linen 80,000
Interior 1,75,000
Sundries Expenses 1,90,800
HOSPITALS
Hospitals provide various types of medical services to the patients. Hospital costing is applied to
determine the cost of these services. A hospital may have different departments catering to very many
services to the patients - such as
Out-Patient
In-Patient
Unit of Cost
Segregation of Cost
The cost of hospital can be divided into fixed costs and variable costs
Fixed costs are based on timelines and irrespective of services rendered. For example, Staff salaries,
Depreciation on Building and Equipment, etc
Variable costs vary with the level of services rendered. For example, Laundry charges, Cost of food
supplied to patients, Power, etc.
Illustration 53
Zenith Hospital runs a Critical Care Unit (CCU) in a hired building. CCU consists of 35 beds and 5 more
beds can be added, if required.
Rent per month: `75,000
Supervisors - 2 persons @ ` 25,000 per month each
Nurses - 4 persons @ `20,000 per month each
Ward Boys - 4 persons @ `5,000 per month each
Doctors were paid `250,000 per month on the basis of number of patients attended and the time spent
by them.
Solution:
Working Notes:
Calculation of number of patient days
Profitability Statement
Profit 55,34,000
Illustration 54
Manar lodging home is being run in a small hill station with 50 single rooms. The home offers concessional
rates during six off- season months in a year. During this period, half of the full room rent is charged. The
management’s profit margin is targeted at 20% of the room rent. The following are the cost estimates
and other details for the year ending on 31st March 2016. [Assume a month to be of 30 days].
(i) Occupancy during the season is 80% while in the off- season it is 40% only.
(ii) Expenses:
• Staff salary [Excluding room attendants] ` 2,75,000
• Repairs to building ` 1,30,500
• Laundry and linen ` 40,000
• Interior and tapestry ` 87,500
• Sundry expenses ` 95,400
(iii) Annual depreciation is to be provided for buildings @ 5% and on furniture and equipments @ 15%
on straight-line basis.
(iv) Room attendants are paid ` 5 per room day on the basis of occupancy of the rooms in a month.
(v) Monthly lighting charges are ` 120 per room, except in four months in winter when it is ` 30 per room
and this cost is on the basis of full occupancy for a month.
(vi) Total investment in the home is ` 100 lakhs of which ` 80 lakhs relate to buildings and balance for
furniture and equipments.
You are required to work out the room rent chargeable per day both during the season and the off-
season months on the basis of the foregoing information.
Solution:
(i) Computation of Estimated Cost for the year ending 31st March, 2016
(iv) Light charges for 8 months @ ` 120 per month i.e. ` 120/30 = ` 4 per room day.
Light charges for 4 months @ ` 30 per month, i.e. ` 30/30 = ` 1 per room day
Therefore, during season, room rent of ` 197 is to be charged while in the off-season room rent of ` 98.50
is to be charged.
GLOSSARY
Abnormal Process Gain: Abnormal process gain is an unexpected gain in production under the normal
conditions due to over-estimation of process loss, improvements in work efficiency of workers, use of
better technology in production etc.
Abnormal Process Loss: Abnormal process loss is the loss in excess of the predetermined loss (normal
process loss) due to carelessness of workers, a bad plant design or operation, sabotage etc. Such a loss
cannot obviously be estimated in advance.
Batch Costing: Batch Costing is that form of specific order costing under which each batch is treated
as a cost unit and costs are accumulated and ascertained separately for each batch. Each batch
consists of a number of like units. This type of costing is applied to a manufacturing organisation where
similar articles are produced in batches either for sale or for use within the organisation. It is similar to
Job Costing.
By-product: By-product is the product which is recovered incidentally from the material used in the
manufacture of main products. The by-product has either a net realisable value which is relatively low
as compared to the saleable value of the main products.
Contract Costing: Contract Costing is a form of specific order costing applicable to a construction
company where work is undertaken according to customers’ requirements and each order is of long
duration. It is similar to Job Costing.
Cost of Work Uncertified: Cost of work uncertified represents the cost of the work which has been
carried out by the contractor but has not been certified by the expert.
Economic Batch Quantity (EBQ): Economic Batch Quantity refers to the optimum quantity batch
which should be produced at a point of time so that the set up & processing costs and carrying costs
are together optimised.
Equivalent Units: Equivalent units are the notional quantities of completed units substituted for the
actual quantities of incomplete physical units in progress, when the aggregate work content of the
incomplete units is deemed to be equivalent to that of the substituted quantity of completed units, e.g.
100 units 50% complete is equivalent to 50 completed units.
Escalation Clause: Escalation clause is a clause in a contract which empowers a contractor to revise
the price of the contract in case of increase in the prices of inputs due to some macro-economic or
other agreed reasons.
Job Costing: Job Costing is a form of specific order costing applicable to an organisation where work is
undertaken according to customers’ requirements and each order is comparatively of short duration.
According to CIMA, Job Costing is the category of basic costing methods which is applicable where
the work consists of separate contracts, jobs or batches each of which is authorised by specific order
or contract.
Joint Costs: Joint costs are the costs of providing two or more products or services whose production
could not be segregated for physical reasons.
Joint Products: Joint products are the two or more products separated in the course of processing,
each having a high saleable value to be considered as main product.
Normal Process Loss: Normal process loss is the loss of material which is inherent in the nature of work.
It is unavoidable because of nature of the material or the process.
Operating Costing: CIMA defines operating costing as that form of operating costing which applies
where standardised services are provided either by an undertaking or by a service cost center within
an undertaking.
Process Costing: Process costing is one of the basic costing methods applicable to an organisation
where goods result from a sequence of repetitive operations or processes to which costs are charged
before being averaged over the units produced during the period.
Retention Money: Retention money is the portion of the value of work certified, which is kept by a
contractee as security money for any loss or damage caused by the contractor.
Value of Work Certified: Value of work certified is the value of a contract which is certified by an expert
in terms of percentage of total work.
Theoretical Questions:
1. Explain Job Costing and Batch Costing giving examples of Industries where these are used.
4. Describe briefly, how joint costs up to the point of separation may be apportioned amongst the
joint products?
3. The most suitable cost system where the products differ in type of material and work performed is
A. Operating Costing
B. Job costing
C. Process costing
D. All of these.
7. In order to determine cost of the products or services, different business firms follow:
A. Different techniques of costing
B. Uniform Costing
C. Different method of costing
D. Note of the above
E. All of the above
8. In case product produced or jobs undertaken are of diverse nature, the system of costing to be
used should be:
A. Operating Costing
B. Process Costing
C. Job costing
D. None of the above
E. All of the above
C. Technique of costing
A. Direct costing
B. Process costing
C. Job costing
D. Differential costing
11. Batch Costing is similar to that under job costing except with the difference that:
12. Economic batch quantity is that size of the batch of production where:
D. Both A. and B.
13. Job costing is similar to that under Batch costing except with the difference that:
14. Which of the following documents are used in job costing to record the issue of direct materials to
a job:
A. Purchase order
B. Purchase requisition
C. Goods received note
D. Material requisition
E. None of the above
18. In a process 8000 units are introduced during a period. 5% of input is normal loss. Closing work
in progress 60% complete is 1000 units. 6600 completed units are transferred to next process.
Equivalent production for the period is:
A. 9000 units
B. 7440 units
C. 5400 units
D. 7200 units
19. The type of process loss that should not be allowed to affect the cost of good units is called:
A. Standard loss
B. Normal loss
C. Abnormal loss
D. Seasonal loss
E. None of the above
20. 400 units were introduced in a process in which 40 units is the normal loss. If the actual output is 300
units, then there is:
A. No abnormal gain
C. No abnormal loss
21. Spoilage that occurs under inefficient operating conditions and is generally controllable is called
A. Normal defectives
B. Abnormal spoilage
C. Normal spoilage
C. Total process cost less realisable value of normal loss less value of transferred out goods.
24. A process account is debited by abnormal gain, the value is determined as:
25. In sugar manufacturing industry molasses is also produced along with sugar. Molasses may be of
smaller value as compared with the value of sugar and is known as:
A. Joint product
B. Common product
C. By-product
D. None of them
26. Method of apportioning joint costs on the basis of output of each joint product at the point of split-
offs is known as:
27. The main purpose of a accounting of joint products and by-products is to:
28. Under net realisable value method of apportioning joint costs to joint products, the selling &
distribution cost is:
A. Ignored
30. Which of following methods can be used when the joint products are of unequal quantity and
used for captive consumption:
A. Physical units method
B. Net realisable value method
C. Technical estimates, using market value of similar goods
D. Market value at split-off method
[Ans: D, B, B, A, C, B, C, C, B, C, C, D, B, D, B, D, C, D, C, B, B, D, C, C, C, A, C, B, C, C, A, D, C, C, B]
4. FIFO methods are followed for evaluation of equivalent production when prices are fluctuating.
6. Costs incurred prior to the split off point are known as “Joint Costs”
[Ans: F, F, F, F, T, T, F, T, F, F]
2. If the actual loss in a process is less than the normal loss, the difference is known as
___________________.
4. The ____ product generally has a greater sale value than by product.
5. Statement of cost per unit of equivalent production shows the per unit cost ________.
9. The method of costing used in undertaking like gas companies, cinema houses, hospitals etc is
known as _________________.
10. In motor transport costing two example of fixed cost are __________ and ________________.
[Ans: Abnormal, Abnormal gain, Subsequent, main, Element wise, FIFO and Average
method, per bed, Kilowatt, Operating costing, Insurance and Depreciation]
Column A Column B
1. The contact which provide for payment of actual A. Average price method
cost plus an agreed percentage of profit.
2. In contact costing, the cost unit is B. Kilowatt
3. Abnormal loss is transferred to C Job costing
4. Job costing is used in D Normal Output
5. Under job order cost system, each job is assigned E Cost Plus
one identifying job.
6. Cost of normal loss is borne by F Per bed
7. Inherent features of process industry G Per contract
8. The method which is followed for evaluation of H Automobile garages
equivalent production when prices are fluctuating.
9. In hospital the cost unit is I Costing Profit and loss account
10. In electricity companies, the cost unit is J Work in progress
[Ans: E, G, I, H, C, D, J, A, F, B]
Marginal Cost is defined as “the amount at any given volume of output by which aggregate costs are
changed if the volume of output is increased or decreased by one unit.” Marginal Cost also means
Prime Cost plus Variable Overheads. Marginal Cost also means Prime Cost plus Variable Overheads.
Marginal Cost is a constant ratio which may be expressed in terms of an amount per unit of output. On
the other hand, fixed cost which is not normally traceable to particular unit denotes a fixed amount of
expenditure incurred during an accounting period. Fixed cost is, therefore, also called time cost, period
cost, standby cost, capacity cost, or constant cost. Variable cost or marginal cost is also termed as
direct cost, activity cost, volume cost or out-of-pocket cost.
From the above definition and analysis of marginal cost, we can understand that is the cost which
varies according to the variations in the volumes of output. However, by definition marginal cost is the
change in the total cost for addition of one unit. It is to be noted that for an economist marginal cost
and variable cost would be different. But for an accountant both marginal cost and variable cost are
same and are interchangeably used. Therefore, for our study, we use marginal cost and variable cost
synonymously.
Marginal costing is “the ascertainment of marginal costs and of the effect on profit of changes in volume
or type of output by differentiating between fixed costs and variable costs.” Several other terms in use
like direct costing, contributory costing, variable costing, comparative costing, differential costing and
incremental costing are used more or less synonymously with marginal costing.
It is a process whereby costs are classified into fixed and variable and with such a division so many
managerial decisions are taken. The essential feature of marginal costing is division of total costs into fixed
and variable, without which this could not have existed. Variable costs vary with volume of production
or output, whereas fixed costs remains unchanged irrespective of changes in the volume of output. It
is to be understood that unit variable cost remains same at different levels of output and total variable
cost changes in direct proportion with the number of units. On the other hand, total fixed cost remains
same disregard of changes in units, while there is inverse relationship between the fixed cost per unit
and the number of units.
3. The fixed costs are written off soon after they are incurred and do not find place in product cost
or inventories.
4. Prices are based on Marginal Cost and Marginal Contribution.
5. It combines the techniques of cost recording and cost reporting.
Absorption Costing
In absorption costing the classification of expenses is based on functional basis but in marginal costing
it is based on the nature of expenses. In absorption costing, the fixed expenses are distributed over
products based on a pre-determined level of output. Since fixed expenses are constant, such a
method of recovery will lead to over or under-recovery of expenses depending on the actual output
being greater or lesser than the estimate used for recovery. This difficulty will not arise in marginal
costing because the contribution is used as a resource for meeting fixed expenses.
The presentation of information to management under the two costing techniques is given below.
Income Statement (Absorption costing)
It is observed from the above that under marginal costing technique the contributions of various
products are pooled together and the fixed overheads are met out of such total contribution. The
total contribution is also known as gross margin. The contribution minus fixed expenses gives net profit.
Illustration 1
MAXWEL Ltd. produces a single product Boost. The following figures relate to Boost for the period: 2017-
2018.
The normal level of activity for the year is 800 units. Fixed costs are incurred evenly throughout the year,
and actual fixed costs are the same as budgeted. There were no stocks of Boost at the beginning of
the year.
In the first quarter, 220 units were produced and 160 units were sold.
Required:
(a) What would be the fixed production costs absorbed by Boost if absorption costing is followed?
(b) What would be the under/over-recovery of overheads during the period?
(c) What would be the profit as per absorption costing?
(d) What would be the profit as per marginal costing?
Solution:
Fixed production costs absorbed
Particulars (`)
Budgeted fixed production costs 1,60,000
Budgeted output (normal level of activity 800 units)
Therefore, the absorption rate: 1,60,000/800 = ` 200 per unit
During the first quarter, the fixed production cost absorbed by Boost 44,000
would be (220 units × ` 200)
Particulars (`)
Actual fixed production overhead (1/4 of ` 1,60,000) 40,000
Absorbed fixed production overhead 44,000
Over-recovery of overheads 4,000
Similarity
a. Both the techniques of cost analysis and cost presentation.
b. Both are made use of by the management in decision making and in formulating policies.
c. The concepts of differential costs and marginal costs mainly arise out of the difference in the
behaviour of fixed and variable costs.
d. Differential costs compare favourably with the economist’s definition of marginal cost, viz. that
marginal cost is the amount which at any given volume of output is changed if output is increased
or decreased by one unit.
Difference
a. Differential cost analysis can be made in the case of both absorption costing as well as marginal
costing.
b. While marginal costing excludes the entire fixed costs, some of the fixed costs may be taken into
account as being relevant for the purpose of differential cost analysis.
c. Marginal costs may be embodied in the accounting system whereas differential costs are worked
out separately as analysis statements.
d. In marginal costing, margin of contribution and contribution ratio are the main yardsticks for
performance evaluation and for decision making. In differential cost analysis, differential costs are
compared with the incremental or decremental revenues, as the case may be.
(ii) Acceptance of offer at a lower price or offering a quotation at lower selling price in order to
increase capacity
(iii) It is used to decide whether it will be more profitable to sell a product as it is or to process it further
into a different product to be sold at an increased price
(iv) Determining the suitable price at which raw material may be purchased
(vi) Discontinuing a product or business segment in order to avoid or reduce the present loss or increase
profit
Where C = Contribution
S = Selling Price
V = Variable Cost
P = Profit
From (1) and (2) above, we may deduce the following equation called Fundamental Equation of
Marginal Costing i.e.
Particulars A B C
Selling price (`) 100 150 200
Variable cost (`) 50 70 100
Contribution (`) 50 80 100
In the above example, one can say that the product ‘C’ is more profitable because, it has more
contribution. This proposition of product having more contribution is more profitable is valid, as long
as, there are no limitations on any factor of production. In this context, factors of production means,
the factors that are responsible for producing the products such as material, labour, machine hours,
demand for sales etc.,
Contribution
Profitability =
Key Factor
A B C
50 / 1 = ` 50 80 / 2 = ` 40 100 / 5 = ` 20
Now, product A is more profitable because it has more contribution per kg of material.
The key factor can also be called as scarce factor or Governing factor or Limiting factor or Constraining
factor etc., whatever may be the name, it indicates the limitation on the particular factor of production.
From the above, it is essentially understandable that contribution is helpful in determination of profitability
of the products, priorities for profitability of the products and in particular, profitabilities when there are
limitation on any factor.
For example:
Gross profit ratio: It may be expressed as follows:
So, P/V ratio or contribution ratio is association of two variables. From this, one may assume that it is the
ratio of profit and sales. But it is not so. It is the ratio of Contribution to Sales.
Contribution
Symbolically P/V ratio = ×100 (1)
Sales
C
⇒ P/V ratio = ×100
S
Contribution
⇒ Sales = (3)
P
Ratio
V
Change in Profit
P/V ratio = ×100
Change in Sales
It is to be noted that the above two formulas are valid as long as there are no changes in prices,
means input prices and selling prices.
Usually, Sales = Cost + Profit
i.e. it can also be written as Sales = Variable Cost + Fixed Cost + Profit and this is called general
sales equation.
Since Sales consists of variable costs and contribution, given the variable cost ratio, P/V ratio can
be found out. Similarly, given the P/V ratio, variable cost ratio can be found out.
For example, P/V ratio is 40%, then variable cost ratio is 60%, given variable cost ratio is 70%, then
P/V ratio is 30%. Such a relationship is called complementary relationship. Thus P/V ratio and variable
cost ratios are said to be complements of each other.
P/V ratio is also useful like contribution for determination of profitabilities of the products as well as
the priorities for profitabilities of the products. In particular, it is useful in determination of profitabilities
of the products in the following two situations:
i. When sales potential in value is limited.
ii. When there is a greater demand for the products.
Y Total Sales
b Total Cost
Cost & Revenue
Angle of Incidence
FC
a
O X
Unit
a = Losses b = Profits
When no. of units are expressed on X-axis and costs and revenues are expressed on Y-axis, three lines
are drawn i.e., fixed cost line, total cost line and total sales line. In the above graph we find there
is an intersection point of the total sales line and total cost line and from that intersection point if a
perpendicular is drawn to X-axis, we find break even units. Similarly, from the same intersection point a
parallel line is drawn to X-axis so that it cuts Y-axis, where we find Break Even point in terms of value. This
is how, the formal pictorial representation of the Break Even chart.
At the intersection point of the total cost line and total sales line, an angle is formed called Angle of
Incidence, which is explained as follows:
Angle of Incidence
Angle of Incidence is an angle formed at the intersection point of total sales line and total cost line in
a formal break even chart. If the angle is larger, the rate of growth of profit is higher and if the angle is
lower, the rate of growth of profit is lower. So, growth of profit or profitability rate is depicted by Angle
of Incidence.
Y Total Sales
Total Cost
Cost & Revenue
Angle of Incidence
FC
O
X
Unitso
‘……’ line indicates increase in total cost and total sales.
In the above chart, if we clearly observe we find that there is no change in BEP even if there is
increase or decrease in No. of units.
Y NTS
Total Sales
Total Cost
Cost & Revenue
Angle of Incidence
FC
O BEP X
Units
‘……’ line indicates changes in break even point and changes in sales.
From the above chart, we observe that profit is increased by increasing the selling price and also,
if there is change in selling price, BEP also changes. If selling price is increased then BEP decreases.
If selling price is decreased then BEP increases. Thus, we say that there is an inverse relationship
between selling price and BEP.
Total Sales
TC
B
C
FC
O X
Total Sales
TC
B
C FC
D E
X
O
‘DE and DB’ line indicate decrease in fixed cost and total cost respectively and consequent
decrease in BEP.
From the above chart also we find that there is increase in profit due to decrease in fixed cost. If
fixed cost is increased then BEP also increases. If fixed cost is decreased then BEP also decreases.
Thus there is a direct relationship between fixed cost and BEP.
Total
Costs
Profit
Fixed Costs
Sales
In some cases on account of non-linear behaviour of cost and sales there may be two or more break
even points. In such a case the optimum profit is earned where the difference between the sales and
the total costs is the largest. It is obvious that the business should produce only upto this level. This is
being illustrated in the above chart.
The contribution can be read as the difference between the sales revenue line and the variable cost
line.
Cash Break-Even Point
When break-even point is calculated only with those fixed costs which are payable in cash, such a
break-even point is known as cash break-even point. This means that depreciation and other non-cash
fixed costs are excluded from the fixed costs in computing cash break-even point. Its formula is-
Cash break even point = Cash fixed costs / Contribution per unit.
F
U = S-V
OR
No. ofUnits = Fixed Cost
Contributionper Unit
Break even sales
F× S
SU (Sales) =
S−V
Uses and applications of Break even Analysis (Or) Profit Charts (Or) Cost Volume Profit Analysis
The important uses to which cost-volume profit analysis or break-even analysis or profit charts may be
put to use are:
a. Forecasting costs and profits as a result of change in Volume determination of costs, revenue and
variable cost per unit at various levels of output
b. Fixation of sales Volume level to earn or cover given revenue, return on capital employed, or rate
of dividend
c. Determination of effect of change in Volume due to plant expansion or acceptance of order, with
or without increase in costs or in other words, determination of the quantum of profit to be obtained
with increased or decreased volume of sales
d. Determination of comparative profitability of each product line, project or profit plan
e. Suggestion for shift in sales mix
f. Determination of optimum sales volume
g. Evaluating the effect of reduction or increase in price, or price differentiation in different markets
h. Highlighting the impact of increase or decrease in fixed and variable costs on profit
i. Studying the effect of costs having a high proportion of fixed costs and low variable costs and
vice-versa
j. Inter-firm comparison of profitability
k. Determination of sale price which would give a desired profit for break-even
l. Determination of the cash requirements as a desired volume of output, with the help of cash break-
even charts
m. Break-even analysis emphasizes the importance of capacity utilization for achieving economy.
n. During severe recession, the comparative effects of a shutdown or continued operation at a loss
are indicated.
o. The effect on total cost of a change in the fixed overhead is more clearly demonstrated through
break-even charts.
Limitations of Break-even Analysis
a. That Costs are either fixed or variable and all costs are clearly segregated into their fixed and
variable elements. This cannot possibly be done accurately and the difficulties and complications
involved in such segregation make the break-even point inaccurate.
b. That the behavior of both costs and revenue is not entirely related to changes in volume.
c. That costs and revenue patterns are linear over levels of output being considered. In practice, this
is not always so and the linear relationship is true only within a short run relevant range.
d. That fixed costs remain constant and variable costs vary in proportion to the volume. Fixed costs
are constant only within a limited range and are liable to change at varying levels of activity and
also over a long period, particularly when additional plants and equipments are introduced.
e. That sales mix is constant or only one product is manufactured. A combined analysis taking all the
products of the mix does not reflect the correct position regarding individual products.
f. That production and sales figures are identical or the change in opening and closing stocks of the
finished product is not significant.
g. That the units of production on the various product range are identical. Otherwise, it is difficult to
find a homogeneous factor to represent volume.
h. That the activities and productivity of the concern remain unchanged during the period of study.
i. As output is continuously varied within a limited range, the contribution margin remains relatively
constant. This is possible mainly where the output is more or less homogeneous as in the case of
process industries.
Margin of Safety
It is the sales point beyond the breakeven point. Margin of safety can be obtained by subtracting break
even sales from Total sales. It is useful to determine financial soundness of business enterprise. If margin
of safety is high, then the financial position of the enterprise is sound.
Margin of Safety = Total Sales – Break Even Sales (1)
Total Sales = Break Even Sales + Margin of Safety Sales (2)
Margin of safety can also be computed as follows:
Margin of Safety = Profit / P/V ratio (3)
A relative measure to the margin of safety is its ratio to total sales.
Margin of safety ratio is the ratio of Margin of safety sales to Total sales.
Margin of safety ratio = [Margin of safety / Total sales] x 100 (4)
Margin of safety ratio and Break even sales ratios are complements of each other.
If the sales amount, P/V ratio and M/S ratio are given, then profit can be computed as
follows:
Profit = Total sales x P/V ratio x M/S ratio (5)
Apart from the above formulae, various formulae that are used in the chapter to find out different results
are as follows:
Profit = (Sales x P/V ratio) – Fixed Cost
Fixed Cost + desired profit
Sales value to earn desired profit = and
P ratio
V
The level at which profits are same or the level at which costs are same for two methods or two alternatives
Difference in fixed costs
i.e., Indifference Point = Difference in variable costs per unit
Profit-volume chart
This is similar to a breakeven chart. In this chart the vertical axis represents profits and losses and the
horizontal axis is drawn at zero profit or loss. In this chart each level of activity is taken into account and
profits marked accordingly. The breakeven point is where this line intersects the horizontal axis. A profit
–volume graph is given below:
Breakeven point
Profit 0
Loss
Number of units
The main advantage of the profit-volume chart is its capability of exhibiting clearly the effect on profit
and breakeven point of any changes in the variables.
Illustration 2
ABC Ltd. incurs fixed costs of ` 3,00,000 per annum. It is a single product company with annual sales
budgeted to be 70,000 units at a sales price of ` 300 per unit. Variable costs are ` 285 per unit.
The company is deliberating upon an increase in the selling price of the product to ` 350 per unit. This
shall be required in order to improve the quality of the product. It is anticipated that despite increase
in the selling price the sales volume shall remain unaffected. However, the fixed costs shall increase to
` 450,000 per annum and the variable costs to ` 330 per unit.
You are required to draw a profit volume graph, and determine the breakeven point. Also draw on the
same graph a second profit volume graph and give your comments.
Situation (ii)
Workings:
The profit for sales of 70,000 units is ` 7,50,000
Particulars (` 000)
Contribution 70,000 × (` 300 – ` 285) 1050
Fixed Costs 300
Profit 750
This point is joined to the loss at zero activity, ` 3,00,000 i.e., the fixed costs.
Particulars (` 000)
Contribution 70,000 × (` 300 – ` 330) 1400
Fixed Costs 450
Profit 950
This point is joined to the loss at zero activity, ` 4,50,000 i.e., the fixed costs.
Comments:
It is clear from the graph that there are larger profits available from option (ii). It also shows an increase
in the break-even point from 20,000 units to 22,500 units. However, the increase of 2,500 units may not
be considered large in view of the projected sales volume. It is worth-mentioning that for sales volumes
above 30,000 units the profit achieved will be higher with option (ii). For sales volumes below 30,000
units option (i) will yield higher profits (or lower losses).
Illustration 3
The sports material manufacturing company budgeted the following data for the coming year.
Amount (`)
Sales (1,00,000 units) 1,00,000
Variable cost 40,000
Fixed cost 50,000
Find out
(a) P/V Ratio, B.E.P and Margin of Safety
(b) Evaluate the effect of
(i) 20% increase in physical sales volume
(ii) 20% decrease in physical sales volume
(iii) 5% increase in variable costs
(iv) 5% decrease in variable costs
(v) 10% increase in fixed costs
(vi) 10% decrease in fixed costs
(vii) 10% decreases in selling price and 10% increase in sales volume
(viii) 10% increase in selling price and 10% decrease in sales volume
(ix) ` 5,000 variable cost decrease accompanied by ` 15,000 increase in fixed costs.
Solution:
= 1,00,000 – 40,000
= ` 60,000
= 60%
= 50,000 / 60%
= ` 83,333
= 1,00,000 – 83,333
= `16,667
Illustration 4
Two businesses AB Ltd and CD Ltd sell the same type of product in the same market. Their budgeted
profits and loss accounts for the year ending 30th June, 2016 are as follows: Amount (`)
AB Ltd CD Ltd
Sales 1,50,000 1,50,000
Less: Variable costs 1,20,000 1,00,000
Fixed Cost 15,000 1,35,000 35,000 1,35,000
Profit 15,000 15,000
You are required to calculate the B.E.P of each business and state which business is likely to earn greater
profits in conditions.
(a) Heavy demand for the product
(b) Low demand for the product.
Solution:
Statement Showing Computation of P/V ratio, BEP and Determination of Profitability in Different conditions:
Illustration 5
A factory is currently working to 40% capacity and produces 10,000 units. At 50% the selling price falls by
3%. At 90% capacity the selling price falls by 5% accompanied by similar fall in prices of raw material.
Estimate the profit of the company at 50% and 90% capacity production.
The cost at present per unit is:
Material ` 10
Labour `3
Overheads ` 5(60% fixed)
The selling price per unit is ` 20/- per unit.
Solution:
Statement Showing Computation of Profit at 50% and 90% Capacity as well as at Current Capacity:
Illustration 6
The sales turnover and profit during two periods were as follows:
Amount (`)
Illustration 8
SV Ltd a multi product company furnishes you the following data relating to the year 2015:
Amount (`)
Solution:
(i) P/V ratio = [(7,000 – 5,000) / (50,000 – 45,000)] x 100 = 40%
(ii) Fixed expenses for first half year : = (Sales x PV ratio) – Profit
= (45,000 x 0.4) – 5,000 = ` 13,000
Fixed expenses for the year = 13,000 + 13,000 = ` 26,000
(iii) Break even sales = 26,000 / 40% = ` 65,000
(iv) Margin of safety = (50,000 + 45,000) – 65,000 = ` 30,000
Margin of safety ratio = [30,000 / (50,000 + 45,000)] x 100 = 31.58%
Illustration 9
S Ltd. furnishes you the following information relating to the half year ended 30th June, 2015.
Fixed expenses ` 45,000
Sales value `1,50,000
Profit ` 30,000
During the second half the year the company has projected a loss of `10,000.
Calculate:
(1) The B.E.P and M/S for six months ending 30th June, 2015.
(2) Expected sales volume for the second half of the year assuming that the P/V Ratio and Fixed
expenses remain constant in the second half year also.
(3) The B.E.P and M/S for the whole year for 2015.
Solution:
(1) P/V ratio = (Fixed cost + Profit) / Sales
⇒ Sales = ` 70,000
Illustration 10
The following is the statement of a Radical Co. for the month of June.
Amount (`)
Products Total
L M
Sales 60,000 60,000 1,20,000
Variable costs 42,000 30,000 72,000
Contribution 18,000 30,000 48,000
Fixed cost 36,000
Net Income 12,000
You are required to compute the P/V ratio for each product and then compute the P/V Ratio, Break-
even Point and net profit for the following assumption.
(i) Sales revenue divided 60% to Product L & 40% to Product M.
(ii) Sales revenue divided 40% to Product L & 60% to Product M.
Also calculate the profit estimated on sales upto ` 1,80,000/- p.m. for each of the sales mix provided
above.
Solution:
Computation of P/V ratio
Particulars L M Total
P/V ratio = (C/S) x 100 30% 50% 40%
Illustration 11
Accelerate Co. Ltd., manufactures and sells four types of products under the brand names of A, B, C and
1 2 2 1
D. The sales Mix in value comprises 33 %, 41 %, 16 and 8 %,of products A, B, C & D respectively.
3 3 3 3
The total budgeted sales (100% are `60,000 p.m). Operating costs are:
Variable Costs:
Product A 60% of selling price
Product B 68% of selling price
Product C 80% of selling price
Product D 40% of selling price
Fixed Costs: ` 14,700 p.m.
(a) Calculate the break - even - point for the products on overall basis and
(b) Also calculate break-even-point, if the sales mix is changed as follows the total sales per month
remaining the same. Mix: A - 25% : B - 40% : C - 30% : D - 5%.
Solution:
Particulars A(`) B(`) C(`) D(`) Total(`)
I. Sales 20,000 25,000 10,000 5,000 60,000
II. Variable cost 12,000 17,000 8,000 2,000 39,000
III. Contribution 8,000 8,000 2,000 3,000 21,000
IV. Fixed cost 14,700
V. Profit 6,300
P/V ratio = (C/S) x 100 40% 32% 20% 60% 35%
Particulars A B C D Total
I. Sales 15,000 24,000 18,000 3,000 60,000
II. Variable cost 9,000 16,320 14,400 1,200 40,920
III. Contribution 6,000 7,680 3,600 1,800 19,080
IV. Fixed cost 14,700
V. Profit 4,380
P/V ratio = (C/S) x 100 40% 32% 20% 60% 31.8 %
Break even sales = 14,700 / 31.8% = ` 46,226
Illustration 12
Present the following information to show to management:
(i) The marginal product cost and the contribution p.u.
(ii) The total contribution and profits resulting from each of the following sales mix results.
Amount (`)
Illustration 13
The following particulars are extracted from the records of a company:
PER UNIT
PRODUCT A PRODUCT B
Sales (`) 100 120
Consumption of material 2 Kg 3 Kg
Material cost (`) 10 15
Direct wages cost (`) 15 10
Direct expenses (`) 5 6
Machine hours used 3 Hrs 2 Hrs
Overhead expenses:
Fixed (`) 5 10
Variable (`) 15 20
Direct wages per hour is ` 5
(a) Comment on profitability of each product (both use the same raw material) when :
1) Total sales potential in units is limited;
2) Total sales potential in value is limited;
3) Raw material is in short supply;
4) Production capacity (in terms of machine hours) is the limiting factor.
(b) Assuming raw material as the key factor, availability of which is 10,000 Kgs. and each product
cannot be sold more than 3,500 units find out the product mix which will yield the maximum profit.
Solution:
(a) Statement showing computation of contribution per unit of different factors of production and
determination of profitability
Amount (`)
Sr.No. Particulars A B
I. Sales 100 120
II. Variable cost
Material 10 15
Labour 15 10
Direct expenses 5 6
Variable OH 15 20
45 51
III. Contribution (I - II) 55 69
IV. P/V ratio (III - I) 55% 57.5%
V. Contribution per kg of material 55/2 69/3
= 27.5 = 23
VI. Contribution per machine hour 55/3 69/2
= 18 1/3 = 34.5
From the above computations, we may comment upon the profitability in the following manner.
1. If total sales potential in units is limited, product B is more profitable, it has more contribution per
unit.
2. When total sales in value is limited, product B is more profitable because it has higher P/V ratio.
3. If the raw material is in short supply, Product A is more profitable because it has more contribution
per Kg of material.
4. If the production capacity is limited, product B is more profitable, because it has more contribution
per machine hour.
(b) Statement showing optimum mix under given conditions and computation of profit at that mix
Amount (`)
Illustration 14
A company has a capacity of producing 1 lakh units of a certain product in a month. The sales
department reports that the following schedule of sales prices is possible.
VOLUME OF PRODUCTION SELLING PRICE PER UNIT
% `
60 0.90
70 0.80
80 0.75
90 0.67
100 0.61
The variable cost of manufacture between these levels is 15 paise per unit and fixed cost ` 40,000.
Prepare a statement showing incremental revenue and differential cost at each stage. At which volume
of production will the profit be maximum?
Solution:
Statement showing computation of differential cost, incremental revenue and determination of
capacity at which profit is maximum: Amount (`)
Capacity Units Sales V. Cost Fixed cost Total Cost Differential Incremental
% @ (`) 0.15 Cost Revenue
60% 60,000 54,000 9,000 40,000 49,000 -- --
70% 70,000 56,000 10,500 40,000 50,500 1,500 2,000
80% 80,000 60,000 12,000 40,000 52,000 1,500 4,000
90% 90,000 60,300 13,500 40,000 53,500 1,500 300
100% 1,00,000 61,000 15,000 40,000 55,000 1,500 700
From the above computation, it was found that the incremental revenue is more than the differential
cost up to 80% capacity, the profit is maximum at that capacity.
Illustration 15
A company is at present working at 90 per cent of its capacity and producing 13,500 units per annum.
It operates a flexible budgetary control system. The following figures are obtained from its budget.
90% 100%
Amount (`) Amount (`)
Sales 15,00,000 16,00,000
Fixed expenses 3,00,500 3,00,600
Semi-fixed expenses 97,500 1,00,500
Variable expenses 1,45,000 1,49,500
Units made 13,500 15,000
Labour and material costs per unit are constant under present conditions. Profit margin is 10 per cent.
(a) You are required to determine the differential cost of producing 1,500 units by increasing capacity
to 100%
(b) What would you recommend for an export price for these 1,500 units taking into account that
overseas prices are much lower than indigenous prices?
Solution:
Computation of material and labour cost
Illustration 16
The operating statement of a company is as follows: Amount (`)
Sales (80,000 @ `15 each) 12,00,000
Costs:
Variable: (`)
Material 2,40,000
Labour 3,20,000
Overheads 1,60,000
7,20,000
Fixed Cost 3,20,000 10,40,000
PROFIT 1,60,000
The capacity of the plant is 1 lakh units. A customer from U.S.A. is desirous of buying 20,000 units at a net
price of `10 per unit. Advice the producer whether or not offer should be accepted. Will your advice
be different, if the customer is local one.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of profit before and after accepting the order
Amount (`)
Illustration 17
A company manufactures scooters and sells it at `3,000 each. An increase of 17% in cost of materials
and of 20% of labour cost is anticipated. The increased cost in relation to the present sales price would
cause at 25% decrease in the amount of the present gross profit per unit.
At present, material cost is 50%, wages 20% and overhead is 30% of cost of sales.
You are required to :
(a) Prepare a statement of profit and loss per unit at present and;
(b) Compute the new selling price to produce the same percentage of profit to cost of sales as
before.
Solution:
Let X and Y be the cost and profit respectively.
X + Y = 3,000 → (1)
Material = X x 50/100 = 0.5X
Labour = X x 20/100 = 0.2X
Overheads = X x 30/100 = 0.3X
After increase of cost:
Material = 0.5 X x 117/100 = 0.585 X
Labour = 0.2X x 120/100 = 0.240 X
Overheads = 0.300 X
= 1.125 X
Illustration 18
An umbrella manufacturer marks an average net profit of ` 2.50 per piece on a selling price of `14.30
by producing and selling 6,000 pieces or 60% of the capacity. His cost of sales is
Amount (`)
Direct material 3.50
Direct wages 1.25
Works overheads (50% fixed) 6.25
Sales overheads (25% variable) 0.80
During the current year, he intends to produce the same number but anticipates that fixed charges
will go up by 10% which direct labour rate and material will increase by 8% and 6% respectively but he
has no option of increasing the selling price. Under this situation, he obtains an offer for further 20% of
the capacity. What minimum price you will recommend for acceptance to ensure the manufacturer
an overall profit of `16,730.
Solution:
Computation of profit at present after increase in cost
Illustration 19
The Dynamic company has three divisions. Each of which makes a different product. The budgeted
data for the coming year are as follows:
Amount (`)
A B C
Sales 1,12,000 56,000 84,000
Direct Material 14,000 7,000 14,000
Direct Labour 5,600 7,000 22,400
Direct Expenses 14,000 7,000 28,000
Fixed Cost 28,000 14,000 28,000
61,600 35,000 92,400
The Management is considering to close down the division C’. There is no possibility of reducing fixed
cost. Advise whether or not division C’ should be closed down.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of profit before closing down of division C
Amount (`)
From the above computations, it was found that profit is decreased by (`63,000 - `43,400) ` 19,600 by
closing down division ‘C’, it should not be closed down. In other words, as long as if there is a contribution
of ` 1, from division ‘C’, it should not be closed down.
Illustration 20
Mr. Young has ` 1,50,000 investment in a business. He wants a 15% profit on his money. From an analysis
of recent cost figures he finds that his variable cost of operating is 60% of sales; his fixed costs are `75,000
per year. Show supporting computations for each answer.
(b) What sales volume must be obtained to his 15% return on investment?
(c) Mr. Young estimates that even if he closed the doors of his business he would incur `25,000 expenses
per year. At what sales would be better off by locking his sales up?
Solution:
Illustration 21
The manager of a Co. provides you with the following information:
Amount (`)
Sales : 4,00,000
Costs: Variable
(60% of sales)
Fixed cost : 80,000
Profit before tax : 80,000
Income-tax (60%)
Net profit : 32,000
The company is thinking of expanding the plant. The increased fixed cost with plant expansion will be
`40,000. It is estimated that the maximum production in new plant will be worth `2,40,000. The company
also wants to earn additional income `3,200 on investment. On the basis of computations give your
opinion on plant expansion.
Solution:
Statement showing computation of profit before and after plant expansion
Amount (`)
GLOSSARY
Angle of Incidence: Angle of Incidence is the angle between sales and total cost line. This angle is an
indicator of profit earning capacity of the firm over the break-even point sales.
Break-even Analysis: Break-even Analysis is a method for examining the relationship between sales
revenue, variable costs and fixed costs to determine the minimum value of production necessary to
break-even.
Break-even Chart: Break-even Chart is the chart which shows the profitability or otherwise of a firm at
various levels of activity. It indicates the point at which neither profit nor loss is made.
Break-even Point: Break-even Point is the volume of production or sales where total costs are equal to
total revenue. In other words, Break-even Point is the level of activity at which there is neither profit nor
loss.
Contribution or Gross Margin: Contribution or Gross Margin is the difference between sales value and
the variable cost. In other words, Contribution or Gross Margin is defined as the amount recovered
towards fixed cost and profit.
Differential Cost: Differential Cost is the change in the costs which results from the adoption of an
alternative course of action.
Marginal Cost: Marginal Cost is the amount at any given volume of output by which aggregate costs
are changed if the volume of output is increased or decreased by one unit. Marginal cost includes
prime cost plus variable overhead.
Marginal Costing: Marginal Costing is the ascertainment of marginal costs and of the effect on profit of
changes in volume or type of output by differentiating between fixed costs and variable costs. In other
words, Marginal Costing is a costing system in which variable costs are charged to cost units and fixed
costs of the period are written off in full against the total contribution.
Margin of Safety: Margin of Safety is represented by excess sales over and above the break-even point
sales.
Profit Volume Ratio (P/V Ratio) or Contribution Ratio: Profit Volume Ratio (P/V Ratio) or Contribution
Ratio is the ratio of Contribution to Sales.
Theoretical Questions:
1. Discuss the break-even point with an illustration and a break-even chart.
2. Explain the points of difference between absorption costing and marginal costing.
3. Write short notes on:
(a) Margin of safety
(b) Angle of incidence
(c) Cash break-even point
(d) CVP Analysis
2. The difference between absorption costing and marginal costing is in regard to the treatment of :
A. Direct materials
B. Fixed overhead
C. Prime cost
D. Variable overhead
E. All of the above
4. When sales and production (in units) are same then profits under:
A. Marginal costing is lower than that of absorption costing
B. Marginal costing is higher than that of absorption costing
C. Marginal costing is equal to that of absorption costing
D. None of the above
6. Which of the following factors responsible for change in the break-even point?
A. Change in selling price
B. Change in variable cost
C. Change in fixed cost
D. All of the above
7. If sales are ` 90,000 and variable cost to sales is 75%, contribution is
A. ` 21,500
B. ` 22,500
C. ` 23,500
D. ` 67,500
8. Variable cost
A. Remains fixed in total
B. Remains fixed per unit
C. Varies per unit
D. Nor increase or decrease
9. If sales are ` 150,000 and variable cost are ` 50,000. Compute P/V ratio.
A. 66.66%
B. 100%
C. 133.33%
D. 65.66%
10. Marginal Costing technique follows the following basic of classification
A. Element wise
B. Function Wise
C. Behaviour wise
D. Identifiability wise
11. P/V ratio will increase if the
A. There is an decrease in fixed cost
B. There is an increase in fixed cost
C. There is a decrease in selling price per unit.
D. There is a decrease in variable cost per unit.
6. When sales are ` 300,000 and variable cost is ` 180,000, P/V ratio will be ____________.
[Ans: Fixed, Excess, Contribution, 40, Prime cost, 40%, fixed per unit, Actual sales-
Sales at breakeven point, Total Fixed cost/ P/V ratio, Sales – Variable cost.]
Column A Column B
1. Indifference point (in units) A Difference in Fixed Cost/ Difference in P/V ratio
2. Breakeven point (in Value) B Fixed Cost / Contribution per unit
3. Variable cost per unit C Total sales less BEP sales
4. P/V ratio D Marginal Cost
5. Prime cost + Variable overhead E Fixed Cost / P/V ratio
6. Breakeven point (in Quantity) F Difference in Fixed Cost/ Difference in
contribution per unit
7. Indifference point (in Value) G Total contribution /Total Sales Value *100
8. Shut Down point (in Quantity) H Avoidable Fixed Cost/ P/V Ratio
9. Shut Down point (in value) I Fixed
10. Margin of Safety J Avoidable Fixed Cost/ Contribution per unit
[Ans: F, E, I, G, D, B, A, J, H, C]
Standard Cost
Standard Cost is defined as “the predetermined cost that is calculated at the management’s standards
of efficient operations and the relevant necessary expenditure”.
From this we understand that it is the cost calculated when all the people working in the organisation
to their utmost, the expenditure incurred for producing the product can be taken as standard cost.
The optimum efficiency can not at all time exists. Therefore, optimum efficiency is assumed and that is
why standard cost is called assumed cost. Further, all the inputs of cost scientifically analysed using so
many industrial engineering techniques such as work measurement, method study, time and motion
study, merit rating, job evaluation and other scientific techniques, it can also be called as Scientific Cost.
Types of Standards
There are different types of standards stated as follows:
(i) Ideal Standard: Ideal standard represents the level of performance attainable when prices for
material and labour are most favourable, when the highest output is achieved with the best
equipments and layout and when the maximum efficiency in utilising the resources results in
maximum output with minimum cost. However, this type of standard is criticised due to the fact
that such standard is practically unattainable.
(ii) Normal Standard: Normal standard can be achieved under normal operating conditions. The
normal activity is the number of standard hours which will produce at normal efficiency sufficiently
good enough to meet the average sales demand over a period of time. This standard requires
a degree of forecasting. Under this system the variances are deviations from normal efficiency,
normal sales volume, or normal production volume.
(iii) Basic Standard: Basic standard is applied only when it is likely to remain constant over a long
period of time. A base year is chosen for the purpose of comparison. Since basic standard does
not represent what should be attained in the present period, current standard should also be
prepared when basic standard is used.
(iv) Current Standard: Current standard reflects the management’s anticipation of what actual costs
will be for the current period. These are the costs that the firm will incur if anticipated prices are
paid for the goods and services and the usage necessary to produce the planned output.
5. Cost are available with promptitude for various purposes like fixation of selling prices, pricing of inter-
departmental transfers, ascertaining the value of costing stocks of work-in-progress and finished
stock and determining idle capacity.
6. Standard Costing is an exercise in planning - it can be very easily fitted into and used for budgetary
planning.
7. Standard Costing system facilities delegation of authority and fixation of responsibility for each
department or individual. This also tones up the general organisation of the concern.
8. Variance analysis and reporting is based on the principles of management by exception. The top
management may not be interested in details of actual performance but only in the variances
form the standards, so that corrective measures may be taken in time.
9. When constantly reviewed, the standards provide means for achieving cost reduction.
10. Standard costs assist in performance analysis by providing ready means for preparation of
information.
11. Production and pricing policies may be formulated in advance before production starts. This helps
in prompt decision-making.
12. Standard costing facilitates the integration of accounts so that reconciliation between cost accounts
and financial accounts may be eliminated.
13. Standard Costing optimizes the use of plant capacities, current assets and working capital.
Types of Variances
Following are the types of variances:
(i) Controllable and Uncontrollable variance
(ii) Favourable and Adverse Variance
Controllable variances are those which can be controlled by the departmental heads whereas
Uncontrollable variances are those which are beyond their control. However, controllability is a
subjective matter and varies according to situations. If the Uncontrollable variances are of significant
nature and persistent, the standard may need revision.
Favourable variances are those which are profitable for the company and Adverse variances are
those which cause loss to the company. While computing cost variances favourable variances means
actual cost is less than standard cost. On the contrary, adverse variances means actual cost exceeding
standard cost. However, the situation will be reverse for Sales variance .Favourable variance means
actual sales are more than budgeted. On the contrary Adverse variance means actual sales are less
than budgeted. In short favourable variance is written as ‘F’ and adverse variance as ‘A’.
Usage Price
Variance Variance
Efficiency Rate
Variance Variance
Direct Materials Cost Variance: Direct materials cost variance is the difference between the actual direct
material cost incurred and the standard direct material cost specified for the production achieved.
1. Direct Materials Price Variance: The difference between the actual and standard price per unit of
the material applied to the actual quantity of material purchased or used.
Direct materials price variance = (Standard Price minus Actual Price) x Actual Quantity, or
= (SP-AP) AQ
= (Standard Price x Actual Quantity) minus (Actual Price x Actual Quantity)
= (AQSP-AQAP)
(1-2) (2-3)
(1-3) (3-4)
(1-4)
Where
SQ = Standard Quantity for Actual Production or Output
SP = Standard Price
AQ = Actual Quantity of Materials Consumed
AP = Actual Price
RSQ = Revised Standard Quantity
1. SQSP = Standard Cost of Standard Material
2. RSQSP = Revised Standard Cost of Standard Material
3. AQSP = Standard cost of Actual Material
c. Delays due to waiting for materials, tools, instructions, etc. if not treated as idle time
d. Defective machines, tools and other equipments
e. Machine break-down, if not booked to idle time
f. Work on new machines requiring less time than provided for, till such time standard is not revised
g. Basic inefficiency of workers due to low morale, insufficient training, faulty instructions, incorrect
scheduling of jobs, etc.
h. Use of non-standard material requiring more or less operation time
i. Carrying out operations not provided for a booking them as direct wages
j. Incorrect standards
k. Wrong selection of workers, i.e., not employing the right type of man for doing a job
l. Increase in labour turnover
m. Incorrect recording of performances, i.e., time or output
i. Direct Labour Composition or Mix or Gang Variance: This is a sub-variance of labour efficiency
variance. This variance arises due to change in the composition of a standard gang, or, combination
of labour force.
Mix or Gang or Composition Variance = (Actual Hours at Standard Rate of Standard Gang) minus
(Actual Hours at Standard Rate of Actual Gang)
ii. Direct Labour Yield Variance: Just as material yield variance is calculated, similarly labour yield
variance can also be known. It is the variation in labour cost on account of increase or decrease
in yield or output as compared to the relative standard. The formula is –
3. Idle time variance: This variance which forms a portion of wages efficiency variance, is represented
by the standard cost of the actual hours for which the workers remain idle due to abnormal
circumstances.
Idle time variance = (Standard rate x Actual hours paid for) minus (Standard rate x Actual hours
worked) or
= Standard Rate x Idle Hours
(1-2) (2-3)
(1-3) (3-4)
(1-4)
AH = Actual Hours
AR = Actual Rate of Labour per Hour
1. SRSH = Standard Cost of Standard Labour
2. SRRSH = Revised Standard Cost of Labour
3. SRAH = Standard Cost of Actual Labour
4. ARAH = Actual Cost of Labour
a. Labour Sub-Efficiency or Yield Variance = 1-2
b. Labour Mix or Gang or Composition Variance = 2-3
c. Labour Efficiency Variance = 1-3
d. Labour Rate Variance = 3-4
e. Labour Cost Variance = 1-4
Idle Time Variance = Idle Time Hours x Standard Rate per Hour.
It is to be noted that this is the part and parcel of efficiency ratio and always it is adverse.
Illustration 1
Product A required 10 kg of material at a rate of `4 per kg. The actual consumption of material for the
manufacturing product A comes to 12 kg of material at the rate of `4.50 per kg.
Solution:
Given Values:
Illustration 2
The standard quantity and standard price of raw material required for one unit of product A are given
as follows
Quantity (kg.) S.P. (`)
Material X 2 3
Material Y 4 2
The actual production and relevant data are as follows:
Material X 1,100 kgs. @ ` 3,410
Material Y 1,800 kgs. @ ` 3,960
Calculate Variances. Actual production was 500 units.
Solution:
Analysis of Given Data
Amount (`)
Amount (`)
Computation of Variances
(a) Material Sub-usage variance = (1) – (2) = 7,000 – 6,767 = ` 233 (F)
(b) Material Mix variance = (2) – (3) = 6,767 – 6,900 = ` 133 (A)
(c) Material Usage variance = (1) – (3) = 7,000 – 6,900 = `100 (F)
(d) Material price variance = (3) – (4) = 6,900 – 7,370 = ` 470 (A)
(e) Material cost variance = (1) – (4) = 7,000 – 7,370 = ` 370 (A)
Illustration 3
From the following you are required to calculate
(a) Material Usage Variance
(b) Material Price Variance
(c) Material Cost Variance
Quantity of material purchased 3,000 units
Value of material purchased ` 9,000
Standard quantity of material required
for one tonne of finished product 25 units
Standard rate of material ` 2 per unit
Opening stock of material NIL
Closing stock of material 500 units
Finished production during the period 80 tonnes
Solution:
Given Values:
SP = Standard Price = ` 2
AP = Actual Price = ` 3
(3) AQAP = Actual Cost of Material = ` 7,500 (2,500 units × ` 3 per unit)
Illustration 4
From the following information, compute (a) Mix, Price and Usage Variances.
Actual:
5 3 15
Material A
10 6 60
Material B
Material C 15 5 75
30 150
Solution:
Computation of Required Values
Amount (`)
Illustration 5
From the data given below, calculate the Material Price Variance, Material Usage Variance and
Material Mix Variance:
Illustration 6
The standard material cost for 100 kg of chemical D is made up :
Chemical A 30 kg. @ ` 4 per kg
Chemical B 40 kg. @ ` 5 per kg
Chemical C 80 kg. @ ` 6 per kg
40
For B = x 160 = 42.67 units.
150
80
For C = x 160 = 85.33 units.
150
Illustration 7
Solution:
Computation of Required Values
Amount (`)
SQSP (1) RSQSP (2) AQSP (3) AQAP (4)
A 3,000 541.67 x 6 = 3,250 400 x 6 = 2,400 2,400
B 1,500 433.33 x 3.75 = 1,625 500 x 3.75 = 1,875 1,800
C 900 325 x 3 = 975 400 x 3 = 1,200 1,120
5400 5,850 5,475 5,320
Computation of RSQ
500
For A = x 1,300 = 541.67 units.
1,200
400
For B = x 1,300 = 433.33 units.
1,200
300
For C = x 1,300 = 325.00 units.
1,200
Where
Illustration 8
A manufacturing concern which has adopted standard costing furnishes the following information.
Standard
Actual
Calculate:
Solution:
Computation of Required Values
Amount (`)
Illustration 9
The standard set for material consumption was 100kg. @ ` 2.25 per kg.
In a cost period:
Solution:
(a) Computation of Material Usage Variance
Material Usage Variance = SQSP – AQSP
= SP (SQ – AQ)
= 2.25(100-110)
= 22.50 (A)
Dept X Dept Y
Gross wages direct (`) 28,080 19,370
Standard hours produced 8,640 6,015
Standard rate per hour (`) 3 3.40
Actual hours worked 8,200 6,395
Solution:
Dept. X : Computation of Required Values
Illustration 11
Calculate variances from the following:
STANDARD ACTUAL
INPUT MATERIAL (`)/KG TOTAL INPUT MATERIAL (`)/KG TOTAL
400 A @ 50 20,000 420 A @ 45 18,900
200 B @20 4,000 240 B @ 25 6,000
100 C @15 1,500 90 C @15 1,350
700 25,500 750 26,250
LABOUR HOURS LABOUR HOURS
100 @ `2 per hour 200 120 @ `2.50 per hour 300
200 woman @ ` 1.50 300 500 240 woman @ ` 1.60 384 684
25 Normal Loss 75 Actual Loss
675 26000 675 26,934
Solution:
Calculation of Material Variances
Amount (`)
(1) (2) (3) (4)
SQSP RSQSP AQSP AQAP
A 428.57 x 50 420 x 50
B 214.29 x 20 240 x 20
C 107.14 x 15 90 x 15
A 20,000 21,429 21,000 18,900
B 4,000 4,289 4,800 6,000
C 1,500 1,607 1,350 1,350
25,500 27,325 27,150 26,250
RSQ for
A = 400/700 x 750 = 428.67 units
B = 200/700 x 750 = 214.29 units
C = 100/700 x 750 = 107.14 units
1. SQSP = Standard Cost of Standard Material = ` 25,500
2. RSQSP= Revised Standard Cost of Material = ` 27,325
3. AQSP= Standard Cost of Actual Material = ` 27,150
4. AQAP = Actual Cost of Material = ` 26,250
a. Material Yield Variance (1-2) = ` 1,825 (A)
b. Material Mix Variance (2-3) = ` 175 (F)
c. Material Usage Variance (1-3) = ` 1,650 (A)
d. Material Price Variance (3-4) = ` 900 (F)
e. Material Cost Variance (1-4) = ` 750 (A)
RSH for
Men = 100/700 x 750 = 107.14 units.
Women = 200/700 x 750 = 214.28 units.
1. SRSH = Standard Cost of Standard Labour = ` 500
2. SRRSH = Revised Standard Cost of Labour = ` 536
3. SRAH = Standard Cost of Actual Labour = ` 600
4. ARAH = Actual Cost of Labour = ` 684
a. Labour Yield Variance (1-2) = ` 36 (A)
b. Labour Mix Variance (2-3) = ` 64 (A)
c. Labour Efficiency Variance (1-3) = ` 100 (A)
d. Labour Rate Variance (3-4) = ` 84 (A)
e. Labour Cost Variance (1-4) = ` 184 (A)
Illustration 12
The standard labour complement and the actual labour complement engaged in a week for a job
are as under:
Skilled Semi-skilled Unskilled
workers workers workers
a) Standard no. of workers in the gang 32 12 6
b) Standard wage rate per hour (`) 3 2 1
c) Actual no. of workers employed in the gang during
28 18 4
the week
d) Actual wage rate per hour (`) 4 3 2
During the 40 hour working week the gang produced 1,800 standard labour hours of work. Calculate
1) Labour Efficiency Variance 2) Mix Variance
3) Rate of Wages Variance 4) Labour Cost Variance
Solution:
Analysis of Given Data
Amount (`)
Computation of SH
240
For Unskilled worker = × 1,800 = 216
2,000
Illustration 13
A chemical company gives you the following standard and actual data of its Chemical No.1456. You
are required to calculate variances (material).
Standard Data
450 kg. of Material A @ `20 per kg. 9,000
360 kg. of Material B @ `10 per kg. 3,600
810 12,600
Actual Data
Solution:
Computation of Required Values
Computation of SQ:
450
For A = × 760 = 475 units.
720
360
For B = × 760 = 380 units.
720
GLOSSARY
Basic Standard: Basic standard is the standard established for use over a long period from which a
current standard can be developed.
Current Standard: Current standard is a standard which is established for use over a short period of time
and is related to current conditions.
Idle Time Variance: Idle time variance is the standard cost of actual time paid to workers for which they
have not worked due to abnormal reasons.
Labour Cost Variance: Labour cost variance is the difference between the actual labour costs and the
standard labour costs.
Labour Efficiency Variance: Labour efficiency variance is the difference between the standard hours
which should have been worked and the hours actually worked, valued at the standard wage rate.
Labour Mix Variance: Labour mix variance is the variance which arises due to change in the composition
of a standard group, or, combination of labour force.
Labour Rate Variance: Labour rate variance is the difference between the actual and standard wage
rate per hour applied to the total hours worked.
Labour Yield Variance: Labour yield variance is the variation in labour cost on account of increase or
decrease in yield or output as compared to the relative standard.
Material Cost Variance: Material cost variance is the difference between standard material costs and
actual material costs.
Material Mix Variance: Material mix variance is that part of material usage variance which arises
from the difference between the standard mix and actual mix of different types of materials used in
production.
Material Price Variance: Material price variance is the difference between the actual and standard
price per unit of the material applied to the actual quantity of material purchased or used.
Material Usage Variance: Material usage variance is a part of material cost variance which reveals the
deviation due to difference in quantity of material used.
Material Yield Variance: Material yield variance is the difference between the standard cost of
production achieved and the actual total quantity of materials used, multiplied by the standard
weighted average price per unit.
Standard Cost: Standard cost is a pre-determined cost which shows in advance what each product
should cost under the given situation.
Standard Costing: Standard costing is a technique which uses standards for costs and revenue for the
purpose of control through variance analysis.
Standard Price: Standard price is a pre-determined price fixed on the basis of a specification of a
product or service and of all factors affecting the price.
Standard Time: Standard time is the total time in which a task should be completed at standard
performance, i.e. basic time plus contingence time allowance plus allowance for relaxation.
Variance: The deviation of actual from standard is called variance. When actual cost is less than the
standard cost, it is known as ‘favourable variance’. When actual cost is more than the standard cost, it
is known as ‘unfavourable or adverse variance’. It is also referred to as a measure of dispersion defined
as the mean squared deviation from the expected value.
Variance Analysis: Variance analysis is the analysis of variances arising in standard costing system into
their constituent parts.
Theoretical Questions:
1. Write short notes on :
(a) Process of setting standards
(b) Types of standards
(c) Material yield variance
(d) Labour mix variance
C. As a basis for price fixation and cost control through variance analysis.
4. The cost of the product determined at the beginning of production under standard cost system is
known as :
A. Actual cost
B. Direct cost
C. Pre-determined cost
D. Historical cost
E. None of the above
5. The deviation between standard and actual cost is known as
A. Variable cost analysis
B. Variance analysis
C. Linear trend analysis
D. Multiple analysis
E. None of the above
6. From cost control point of view the standard most commonly used is:
A. Expected standard
B. Theoretical standard
C. Normal standard
D. Basic standard
E. None of the above
7. When more than one material is used in the manufacture of a product, which of the following
variances arises:
A. Material yield variance
B. Material mix variance
C. Material price variance
D. Material usage variance
E. None of the above
8. Standard price of material per kg ` 20, standards consumption per unit of production is 5 kg.
Standard material cost for producing 100 units is
A. ` 20,000
B. ` 12,000
C. ` 8,000
D. ` 10,000
9. Standard cost of material for a given quantity of output is ` 15,000 while the actual cost of material
used is ` 16,200. The material cost variance is:
A. ` 1,200 (A)
B. ` 16,200 (A)
C. ` 15,000 (F)
D. ` 31,200 (A)
10. For the purpose of Proof, Material Cost Variance is equal to:
A. Material Usage Variance + Material Mix variance
B. Material Price Variance + Material Usage Variance
C. Material Price Variance + Material yield variance
D. Material Mix Variance + Material Yield Variance
11. Cost variance is the difference between
A. The standard cost and marginal cost
B. The standards cost and budgeted cost
C. The standards cost and the actual cost
D. None of these
12. Standard price of material per kg is ` 20, standard usage per unit of production is 5 kg. Actual
usage of production 100 units is 520 kgs, all of which was purchase at the rate of ` 22 per kg.
Material usage variance is
A. ` 400 (F)
B. ` 400 (A)
C. ` 1,040 (F)
D. ` 1,040 (A)
13. Standard price of material per kg is ` 20, standard usage per unit of production is 5 kg. Actual
usage of production 100 units is 520 kgs, all of which was purchase at the rate of ` 22 per kg.
Material cost variance is
A. 2,440 (A)
B. 1,440 (A)
C. 1,440 (F)
D. 2,300 (F)
14. Standard quantity of material for one unit of output is 10 kgs. @ ` 8 per kg. Actual output during a
given period is 800 units. The standards quantity of raw material
A. 8,000 kgs
B. 6,400 Kgs
C. 64,000 Kgs
D. None of these
15. What is the labour rate variance if standard hours for 100 units of output are 400 @ ` 2 per hour and
actual hours taken are 380 @ ` 2.25 per hour?
(a) ` 120 (adverse)
(b) ` 100 (adverse)
(c) ` 95 (adverse)
(d) ` 25 (favourable)
(e) None of the above
[Ans: B, C, C, C, B, A, B, D, A, B, C, B, B, A, C]
3. While fixing standards, normal losses and wastages are taken into account.
4. Under the system of standard costing, there is no need for variance analysis.
[Ans. Predetermined, Standard cost, Predetermined, Current, basic and Normal standard, Cost
Accountants, Standard cost, Current standard, Favourable, Cost control, difference.]
[Ans: I, D, F, C, H, A, J, B, E, G]
The literary meaning of the word Budget is a statement of income and expenditure of a certain period.
In principle, the meaning is same in the context of business also. An individual will have his own budget,
a family, a local authority, state and country etc. All will have their respective budgets. So also the
business concern must have its budget so as to attain their objectives.
CIMA defines a budget as, “A budget is a financial and/or quantitative statement, prepared prior to
a defined period of time, of the policy to be pursued during that period for the purpose of attaining a
given objective.”
Features of Budget
An analysis of the above definition reveals the following as features of the budget.
(i) A Budget must be expressed either in quantitative form i.e., the number of units of different products
or it may be expressed in rupees of each product or it may be quantitative and financial form i.e.,
the number of units and rupees of each product etc.,
(ii) It must be prepared before the time for which it is required, for example, if budget is required for
the year 2013-14, it must be prepared in the year 2012-13.
(iii) Budget must be prepared for a definite period.
(iv) Budget must be prepared in accordance with the policies of the business enterprise.
(v) Budgets are prepared normally for attaining organisational objectives, because policies are
formulated to achieve the objectives and those are translated into quantitative and financial form.
Preparation of Budget
The preparation of budget requires many importance activities as enumerated below:
1. Definition of Objective
2. Location of the Key or Budget Factor
3. Appointment of Budget Controller
4. Preparation and circulation of Budget Manual
5. Fixation of Budget Period
6. Determination of Standard activity or Output
In budgeting, fixation of the budget of sales and of capital expenditure is important as these budgets
determine the extent of development activity.
Limitations of Budgets
(i) Budgets fail if estimates are not accurate
Budgets mainly depend upon the accuracy of the estimates. So estimates should be made on
the basis of all the information available. Though forecasting is not an exact science, accurate
estimates can be made by using advanced statistical techniques. Thus preparation of budgets
involves certain amount of judgment and proper interpretation of reports.
(ii) Risk of Rigidity
Budgeting process creates a sense of rigidity in the minds of people who are working in the
organisation. But in the modern business world, which is more dynamic in nature, such rigidity will
create problems. Therefore budgeting process should also be dynamic in nature, so that it can be
updated according to the situation.
Classification of Budgets
Budgets are broadly classified based on :
(A) Time
(B) Nature of expenditure and receipts
(C) Functions
(D) Capacity
Let us discuss the budgets as per above classification in detail.
(A) ON THE BASIS OF TIME
(i) Long term budget: Though there is no exact definition of long term budget, yet we can say
that a budget prepared covering a period of more than a year can be taken as long term
budget. Of course, it may be for 3 years, 5 years, 10 years and even 20 years etc.,
(ii) Short term budget: It is a budget prepared for a period covering a year or less than a year.
(B) ON THE BASIS OF NATURE OF EXPENDITURE AND RECEIPTS
(i) Capital Budget: It is a budget prepared for capital receipts and expenditure such as obtaining
loans, issue of shares, purchase of assets, etc.,
(ii) Revenue Budget: A Budget covering revenue receipts and expenses for a certain period is
called Revenue Budget. Examples: Sales, other incomes, purchases, administrative expenses
etc.,
(C) ON THE BASIS OF FUNCTIONS
Functional Budget: If budgets are prepared of a business concern for a certain period taking each
and every function separately such budgets are called functional budgets. Example: Production,
Sales, purchases, cost of production, cash, materials etc.
Types of Functional Budgets
The following are the various functional budgets, some of which are briefly explained here under:
(i) Sales Budget: The sales budget is a forecast of total sales, expressed in terms of money or quantity
or both. The first step in the preparation of the sales budget is to forecast as accurately as possible,
the sales anticipated during the budget period. Sales forecasts are usually prepared by the sales
manager assisted by the market research personnel.
(d) Sales budgets must also be considered before preparing production budget because it may so
happen that the entire production of the concern may not be sold. In such a case the production
budget must be in line with the sales budget.
(e) A plan of the sequence of operations of production for effective preparation of a production
budget should always be there.
(f) Last, but not the least, the policy of the management should also be considered before preparing
the production budget.
(iii) Materials Budget: The material budget includes quantities of direct materials; the quantities of each
raw material needed for each finished product in the budget period is specified. The input data
for this budget is obtained by applying standard material usage rates by each type of material to
the volume of output budgeted.
(iv) Purchase Budget: The purchase budget establishes the quantity and value of the various items of
materials to be purchased for delivery at specified points of time during the budget period taking
into account the production schedule of the concern and the inventory requirements. It takes into
account the requirements for the entire budget plan as per the sales, materials, maintenance,
research and development, and capital budgets. Purchases may be required to be made in
respect of direct and indirect materials, finished goods for resale, components and parts, and
purchased services. Before incorporation in the purchase budget, these purchase requirements
should be suitably ascertained. Purchase budget also includes material procurement budget.
(v) Cash Budget: Cash Budget is estimated receipts and expenses for a definite period, which usually
are cash sales, collection from debtors and other receipts and expenses and payment to suppliers,
payment of wages, payment of other expenses etc.
(vi) Direct Labour Budget or Personnel Budget: This budget is based on: (a) Production Budget, (b) Sales
Budget, (c) Capital expenses Budget, (d) Research and Development cost Budget, (e) possibility
of new wage agreements.
The main purposes of this budget are to: (1) help in the efficient labour management, (2) show
the planned outlay on direct and indirect wages.
(vii) Selling and Distribution Cost Budget: This budget is based on: (a) Sales budget, (b) Selling and
Distribution cost budget for the current period, (c) Actual selling and distribution costs for the
current period, (d) Expected changes in the rate of commission on sales, method of distribution,
advertisement policy, etc.
(viii) Administration Cost Budget: This budget shows the total estimated cost of administration, i.e. cost
of formulating the policy, directing the organisation and controlling the operations. Most of the
expenses relating to administration are of ‘fixed’ nature within defined limits. This budget is easy
to prepare. Formally each budget centre or department prepares its own budget which gets
incorporated in this budget afterwards.
(ix) Capital Expenditure Budget: It is the planned outlay on fixed assets viz. Land, Building, Plant &
Machinery etc. during the budget period. This budget is generally prepared for a long period, say
5 or 10 years. For control purposes, it is broken down into short periods. Preparation of this budget
is the responsibility of Head of Accounts, who will be assisted by the plant manager and other
functional heads, based on a number of information, e.g.
1. Plant utilisation budget
2. Long term business policy
3. Potential demand for certain products
On the basis of information a company may decide for extension factory capacity, purchase of
new and better factory equipments which will entail heavy capital expenditure.
(x) Research and Development Budget (R & D Budget): It is a planned outlay on R & D activities of a
company. The budget covers materials, equipments and supplies, salaries, expenses, and other
costs relating to design, development, and technical research projects.
Master Budget: Master budget is the budget prepared to cover all the functions of the business
organisation. It can be taken as the integrated budget of business concern, that means, it shows the
profit or loss and financial position of the business concern such as Budgeted Profit and Loss Account,
Budgeted Balance Sheet etc. Master budget, also known as summary budget or finalized profit plan,
combines all the budgets for a period into one harmonious unit and thus, it shows the overall budget
plan. The master budget incorporates all the subsidiary functional budgets and the budgeted Profit
and Loss Account and Balance Sheet. Before the budget plan is put into operation, the master budget
is considered by the top management and revised if the position of profit disclosed therein is not found
to be satisfactory. After suitable revision is made, the master budget is finally approved and put into
action. Another view regards the budgeted Profit and Loss Account and the Balance Sheet as the
master budget.
(ii) Flexible Budget: A flexible budget is a budget that is prepared for different levels of activity or
capacity utilization or volume of output. If the budgets are prepared in such a way so as to change
in accordance with the volume of output, they are called flexible budgets. These can be prepared
from fixed budget which are also called revised budgets. These are much helpful in comparison with
actual because the exact deviations are found for which timely corrective action can be taken.
The basic idea of a flexible budget is that there shall be some standard of cost and expenditures.
Thus, a budget prepared in a manner to give budgeted costs for any level of activity is known as
flexible budget. Such budget is prepared after considering the variable and fixed elements of costs
and the changes, which may be expected for each item at various levels of operations. Thus a
flexible budget recognises the difference in behaviour between fixed and variable costs in relation
to fluctuations in production or sales and is designed to change appropriately with such fluctuations.
In flexible budget, data relating to costs, expenditures may progressively be changed in any month
in accordance with actual output achieved. While preparing flexible budgets, estimates of costs
and expenditures on the basis of standards determined are made from minimum to maximum level
of operations.
production department is able to produce only 1800 units due to non-availability of raw materials. In this
case, non-availability of raw materials is the principal budget factor (limiting factor). If the sales manger
estimates that he can sell only 1500 units due to lack of demand. Then lack of demand is the principal
budget factor. This concept is also known as key factor, or governing factor. This factor highlights the
constraints with in which the organisation functions.
BUDGETARY CONTROL
Budgetary control is defined as “the establishment of budgets relating the responsibilities of executives
to the requirements of a policy and the continuous comparison of actual with budgeted results, either
to secure by individual action the objective of that policy or to provide a basis for its revision.”
RESPONSIBILITY ACCOUNTING
One of the recent developments in the field of management accounting is the responsibility accounting,
which is helpful in exercising cost control. ‘Responsibility Accounting is a system of accounting that
recognizes various responsibility centers throughout the organization and reflects the plans and actions
of each of these centers by assigning particular revenues and costs to the one having the pertinent
responsibility. It is also called profitability accounting and activity accounting.
It is a system in which the person holding the supervisory posts as president, function head, foreman,
etc are given a report showing the performance of the company or department or section as the case
may be. The report will show the data relating to operational results of the area and the items of which
he is responsible for control. Responsibility accounting follows the basic principles of any system of cost
control like budgetary control and standard costing. It differs only in the sense that it lays emphasis
on human beings and fixes responsibilities for individuals. It is based on the belief that control can be
exercised by human beings, so responsibilities should be fixed for individuals.
PERFORMANCE BUDGETING
Performance Budgeting is synonymous with Responsibility Accounting which means thus the responsibility
of various levels of management is predetermined in terms of output or result keeping in view the authority
vested with them. The main concepts of such a system are enumerated below:
(a) It is based on a classification of managerial level for the purpose of establishing a budget for each
level. The individual in charge of that level should be made responsible and held accountable for
its performance over a given period of time.
(b) The starting point of the performance budgeting system rests with the organisation chart in which
the spheres of jurisdiction have been determined. Authority leads to the responsibility for certain
costs and expenses which are forecast or present in the budget with the knowledge of the manager
concerned.
(c) The costs in each individual’s or department’s budget should be limited to the cost controllable
by him.
(d) The person concerned should have the authority to bear the responsibility.
Illustration 1
Prepare a Production Budget for three months ending March 31, 2016 for a factory producing four
products, on the basis of the following information.
Type of Product Estimated Stock on Jan. Estimated Sales during Desired closing stock on
1, 2016 Jan. to Mar. 2016 31.3.2016
A 2,000 10,000 3,000
B 3,000 15,000 5,000
C 4,000 13,000 3,000
D 3,000 12,000 2,000
Solution:
Production Budget for the 3 Months ending 31st March 2016
Illustration 2
Budgeted production and production costs for the year ending 31st December are as follows:
PRODUCT- X PRODUCT -Y
Production (units) 2,20,000 2,40,000
Direct material/unit ` 12.5 `19.0
Direct wages/unit ` 4.5 `7.0
Total factory overheads for each type of product (variable) ` 6,60,000 `9,60,000
A company is manufacturing two products X and Y. A forecast about the number of units to be sold in
the first seven months is given below:
Solution:
Production Budget for 6 Months ending 30th June (Product X)
Working Notes:
1. Computation of Variable Factory Overhead
6,60,000
For Product X = × 1,11,000 = 3,33,000
2,20,000
9,60,000
For product Y= × 1,27,000 = 5,08,000
2,24,000
Illustration 3
Draw a Material Procurement Budget (Quantitative) from the following information:
Estimated sales of a product 40,000 units. Each unit of the product requires 3 units of material A and 5
units of material B.
Material on order:
Material A = 7,000 units
Material B = 11,000 units
Material on order:
Material A = 8,000 units
B = 10,000 units
Solution:
Production = Sales + Closing Stock - Opening Stock
= 40,000 + 7,000 - 5,000
= 42,000 units
Raw Materials Purchase Budget
Illustration 4
From the following figures prepare the raw material purchase budget for January, 2017:
Materials
A B C D E F
Estimated Stock on Jan 1 16,000 6,000 24,000 2,000 14,000 28,000
Estimated Stock on Jan 31 20,000 8,000 28,000 4,000 16,000 32,000
Estimated Consumption 1,20,000 44,000 1,32,000 36,000 88,000 1,72,000
Standard Price per Unit 25 p. 5 p. 15 p. 10 p. 20 p. 30 p.
Solution:
Raw Materials Purchase Budget For January 2015
Type A B C D E F Total
Estimated Consumption (units) 1,20,000 44,000 1,32,000 36,000 88,000 1,72,000
Add: Estimated stock on Jan 31, 20,000 8,000 28,000 4,000 16,000 32,000
2017 (units)
1,40,000 52,000 1,60,000 40,000 1,04,000 2,04,000
Less: Estimated stock on Jan1, 2017 16,000 6,000 24,000 2,000 14,000 28,000
(units)
Estimated purchase (units) 1,24,000 46,000 1,36,000 38,000 90,000 1,76,000 6,10,000
Rate per unit (`) 0.25 0.05 0.15 0.10 0.20 0.30
Estimated purchases (`) 31,000 2,300 20,400 3,800 18,000 52,800 1,28,300
Illustration 5
A company manufactures product - A and product -B during the year ending 31st December 2016, it is
expected to sell 15,000 kg. of product A and 75,000 kg. of product B at `30 and `16 per kg. respectively.
The direct materials P, Q and R are mixed in the proportion of 3: 5: 2 in the manufacture of product A,
Materials Q and R are mixed in the proportion of 1:2 in the manufacture of product B. The actual and
budget inventories for the year are given below:
Solution:
Production Budget for the Products A & B
Material Purchase Budget for the Year ending Dec 31st 2016
Particulars P Q R Total
Material required for product A in the ratio of 3:5:2 4,050 6,750 2,700 13,500
Material required for product B in the ratio of 1:2 - 25,167 50,333 75,500
Total requirement 4,050 31,917 53,033
Add: Closing Stock 3,000 6,000 9,000
7,050 37,917 62,033
Less: Opening Stock 4,000 3,000 30,000
Purchases (in units) 3,050 34,917 32,033
Cost per Kg. 12 10 8
Total Purchase cost (`) 36,600 3,49,170 2,56,264 6,42,034
Illustration 6
The following details apply to an annual budget for a manufacturing company.
Solution:
Material Purchase Budget
Illustration 7
You are required to prepare a Selling Overhead Budget from the estimates given below:
Amount (`)
Advertisement 1,000
Salaries of the Sales Dept. 1,000
Expenses of the Sales Dept.(Fixed) 750
Salesmen’s remuneration 3,000
Salesmen’s and Dearness Allowance - Commission @ 1% on sales affected
Carriage Outwards: Estimated @ 5% on sales
Agents Commission: 7½% on sales
Solution:
Selling Overhead Budget
(`)
Illustration 8
ABC Ltd. a newly started company wishes to prepare Cash Budget from January. Prepare a cash budget
for the first six months from the following estimated revenue and expenses.
Amount (`)
Overheads
Month Total Sales Materials Wages
Production Selling & Distribution
January 20,000 20,000 4,000 3,200 800
February 22,000 14,000 4,400 3,300 900
March 28,000 14,000 4,600 3,400 900
April 36,000 22,000 4,600 3,500 1,000
May 30,000 20,000 4,000 3,200 900
June 40,000 25,000 5,000 3,600 1,200
Cash balance on 1st January was `10,000. A new machinery is to be installed at `20,000 on credit, to
be repaid by two equal installments in March and April, sales commission @5% on total sales is to be
paid within a month following actual sales.
`10,000 being the amount of 2nd call may be received in March. Share premium amounting to `2,000
is also obtained with the 2nd call. Period of credit allowed by suppliers — 2months; period of credit
allowed to customers — 1month, delay in payment of overheads 1 month. Delay in payment of wages
½ month. Assume cash sales to be 50% of total sales.
Solution:
Cash Budget for the First 6 Months
Illustration 9
Prepare a Cash Budget for the three months ending 30th June, 2016 from the information given below:
(a) Amount (`)
Solution:
Cash Budget for the 3 Months Ending 30th June 2016 (Amount in `)
Particulars April May June
Opening Balance 6,000 3,950 3,000
Add: Receipts :
Cash Sales 1,600 1,700 1,800
Collection from debtors [see note(1)] 13,050 13,950 14,850
Advance for sale of vehicles - - 9,000
Dividends from Investments - - 1,000
Total (A+B) 20,650 19,600 29,650
Less: Payments
Materials 9,600 9,000 9,200
Wages (see note2) 3,150 3,500 3,900
Overheads 1,950 2,100 2,250
Installment of Plant & Machinery 2,000 2,000 2,000
Preference Dividend - - 10,000
Total (C) 16,700 16,600 27,350
Closing Balance (A+B-C) 3,950 3,000 2,300
Working Notes:
(i) Computation of Collection from Debtors (Amount in `)
Month Credit
Total Sales Feb Mar Apr May June
Sales
Feb 14,000 12,600 - 6,300 6,300 - -
Mar 15,000 13,500 - - 6,750 6,750 -
Apr 16,000 14,400 - - - 7,200 7,200
May 17,000 15,300 - - - - 7,650
13,050 13,950 14,850
(ii) Wages payment in each month is to be taken as three-fourths of the current month plus one-fourth
of the previous month.
Illustration 10
For production of 10,000 units the following are budgeted expenses:
Amount (`)
Per Unit
Direct Materials 48
Direct Labour 24
Variable Overheads 20
Fixed Overheads (`1,20,000) 12
Variable Expenses (Direct) 4
Selling Expenses (10% fixed) 12
Administration Expenses (`40,000 fixed) 4
Distribution Expenses (20% fixed) 4
128
Prepare a budget for production of 7,000 units and 9,000 units.
Solution:
Flexible Budget
10000 Units 7000 Units 9000 Units
Particulars
CPU Total CPU Total CPU Total
A) Marginal Cost:
Direct Material 48 4,80,000 48 3,36,000 48 4,32,000
Direct Labour 24 2,40,000 24 1,68,000 24 2,16,000
Variable Expenses 4 40,000 4 28,000 4 36,000
Variable overheads 20 2,00,000 20 1,40,000 20 1,80,000
Selling expenses (90% of ` 12) 10.80 1,08,000 10.80 75,600 10.80 97,200
Distribution expenses (80% of ` 4) 3.20 32,000 3.20 22,400 3.20 28,800
Total (A) 110.00 11,00,000 110.00 7,70,000 110.00 9,90,000
B) Fixed Cost:
Fixed Overheads 12.00 1,20,000 1,20,000 1,20,000
Selling expenses 1.20 12,000 12,000 12,000
Administration overheads 4.00 40,000 40,000 40,000
Distribution expenses 0.80 8,000 8,000 8,000
Total (B) 18.00 1,80,000 1,80,000 1,80,000
Grand Total (A+B) 128.00 12,80,000 9,50,000 11,71,000
Illustration 11
Draw up a flexible budget for overhead expenses on the basis of the following data and determine the
overhead rates at 70%, 80% and 90%
Amount (`)
Working Notes:
Semi Variable Overheads
70% 90%
Power:
Variable 7 9
14,000 × 8 =12,250 14,000 × 8 =15,750
Fixed 6,000 6,000
Total 18,250 21,750
Repairs:
Variable 7 9
800 × 8 = 700 800 × 8 = 900
Fixed 1,200 1,200
Total 1 900 2 100
Illustration 12
From the following information relating to 2014 and conditions expected to prevail in 2015, prepare a
budget for 2015.
Solution:
Budget Showing Costs and Profits for the Year 2015
I. Sales 1,50,000
II. Costs:
6 105
Raw Materials 53,000 × × 83,475
4 100
110 6 100
Wages 11,000 × × × 17,285
100 4 105
6
Variable Overheads 16,000 × 24,000
4
10
Fixed Overheads 10,000 3,70,000 × 13,700
100
1,38,460
iii. Profit (i – ii) 11,540
Illustration 13
Production costs of a factory for a year are as follows:
Amount (`)
Direct Wages 80,000
Direct Materials 1,20,000
Production Overheads: Fixed 40,000
Variable 60,000
During the forthcoming year it is anticipated that:
a. The average rate for direct labour remuneration will fall from `0.80 per hour to `0.75 per hour.
b. Production efficiency will be reduced by 5%
c. Price per unit of direct material and of other materials and services which comprise overheads will
remain unchanged, and
d. Production in the coming year will increase by 33 1 % . Draw up a production cost budget.
3
Solution:
Production Cost Budget for the Forthcoming Year
1
iii. Variable Overheads 60,000 × 133 % 80,000
3
iv. Fixed Overheads 40,000
Production cost 3,85,263
Illustration 14
A company manufactures two products, A and B and the budgeted data for the year are as follows:
Amount (`)
Product A Product B
Sales price per unit 100 75
Direct material per unit 20 10
Direct wages per unit 5 4
Total works overhead 10,105 9,009
Total marketing overhead 1,200 1,100
The sales manager forecasts the sales in units as follows:
Solution:
JAN FEB MAR APR MAY JUN JUL AUG SEP OCT NOV DEC TOTAL
Product –A
Sales 28 28 24 20 16 16 18 18 18 18 18 18 240
42 40 34 28 24 25 27 27 27 27 27 27
Production 28 26 22 18 16 17 18 18 18 18 18 18 235
Product- B
Sales 10 12 16 20 24 24 20 20 20 20 20 20 226
16 20 26 32 36 34 30 30 30 30 30 30
Production 11 14 18 22 24 22 20 20 20 20 20 20 231
Illustration 15
Three Articles X, Y and Z are produced in a factory. They pass through two cost centers A and B. From
the data furnished compile a statement for budgeted machine utilization in both the centers.
(a) Sales budget for the year
Cost centers
Product
A B
X 30 70
Y 200 100
Z 30 20
Solution:
Calculation of Units of Production of Different Products
Particulars Product X Product Y Product Z
Sales 4800 2400 2400
Add: Closing Stock 800 400 400
5600 2800 2800
Less: Opening stock 600 300 800
Production 5000 2500 2000
Illustration 16
The monthly budgets for manufacturing overhead of a concern for two levels of activity were as follows:
Amount (`)
Capacity 60% 100%
Budgeted production (units) 600 1,000
Wages 1,200 2,000
Consumable stores 900 1,500
Maintenance 1,100 1,500
Power and fuel 1,600 2,000
Depreciation 4,000 4,000
Insurance 1,000 1,000
9,800 12,000
Solution:
(i) Fixed Depreciation and insurance.
Variable Wages and consumables stores.
Semi-variable Costs Maintenance, Power and fuel.
Seggregation Of Semi Variable Costs
1,500 − 1,100
Maintenance = = ` 1 per unit variable and
400
`500 fixed (i.e., 1,100-600)
2,000 − 1,600
Power and fuel = = ` 1 per unit variable and
400
`1000 (i.e.,1,600-600) is fixed.
Amount (`)
Wages @`2 per unit 1,600
Consumables stores @ ` 1.50 per unit 1,200
Maintenance: ` 500 + ` 1.00 per unit 1,300
Power & fuel ` 1,000 + `1 per unit 1,800
Depreciation 4,000
Insurance 1,000
Total cost: 10,900
(iii)
GLOSSARY
Budget: The Terminology (CIMA-London) defines a Budget as a plan quantified in monetary terms,
prepared and approved prior to a defined period of time, usually showing planned income to be
generated and / or expenditure to be incurred during that period and the capital to be employed to
attain a given objective.
Budget Centre: A Budget Centre is a section of an organisation developed for the purpose of
budgetary control, and is intended to facilitate formulation of various budgets with the help of head
of the department.
Budget Manual: Budget Manual is a document which contains standing instructions regarding the
procedures to be followed at the time of budget preparation.
Budget Period: Budget Period is the period for which a budget is prepared and used. It usually covers
one year.
Budgetary Control: As per CIMA-London Terminology Budgetary Control is the establishment of
budgets, relating the responsibilities of executives to the requirements of a policy, and the continuous
comparison of actual with budgeted results, either to secure by individual action the objective of that
policy or to provide a basis for its revision.
Budgeted Cost: Budgeted Cost is an expected cost for the total activity.
Capital Budget: Capital Budget is a budget prepared for capital receipts and expenditure such as
obtaining loans, issue of shares, purchase of assets etc.
Cash Budget: Cash Budget is a detailed budget of cash income and cash expenditure incorporating
both revenue and capital items for the budget period.
Fixed Budget: Fixed Budget is the budget designed to remain unchanged irrespective of the level of
activity actually attained.
Flexible Budget: Flexible Budget is the budget which, by recognising the difference in behaviour
between fixed and variable costs in relation to fluctuations in output, turnover, or other variable factors,
is designed to change appropriately with such fluctuations.
Functional Budget: Functional Budget is the budget prepared for a certain period covering each and
every function of the organisation separately.
Long Term Budget: Long Term Budget is a budget prepared covering a period of more than a year.
Master Budget: Master Budget is a budget which is prepared from the functional budgets in summary
form. When all functional budgets are prepared, they are summarised to produce budgeted profit &
loss account and budgeted balance sheet.
Materials Budget: Materials Budget is the budget that includes quantities of direct materials needed for
the finished product in the budget period of an organisation.
Performance Budgeting: Performance Budgeting means that the responsibility of various levels of
management is predetermined in terms of output or result keeping in view the authority vested with
them.
Principal Budget Factor: The Terminology (CIMA-London) defines Principal Budget Factor or Key Factor
or Limiting Factor as a factor which at a particular time or over a period will limit the activities of an
organisation and which is therefore, taken into account in preparing budgets.
Production Budget: Production Budget is a forecast of the production for the budget period of an
organisation.
Purchase Budget: Purchase Budget is the budget that establishes the quantity and value of the various
items of materials to be purchased for delivery at specified point of time during the budget period
taking into account the production schedule and the inventory requirements of the organisation.
Responsibility Accounting: Responsibility Accounting is the system of accounting that segregates
revenues and costs into areas of personal responsibility in order to assess the performance attained by
persons to whom authority has been assigned.
Revenue Budget: Revenue Budget is a budget covering revenue receipts and expenses for a certain
period, such as, sales, purchases, administrative expenses etc.
Sales Budget: Sales Budget is the quantitative and financial statement of sales, prepared prior to a
defined period of time, to be achieved during that period.
Short Term Budget: Short Term Budget is a budget prepared for a period covering a year or less than
a year.
Zero-based Budgeting: Zero-based Budgeting is defined as a method of budgeting which requires
each cost element to be specifically justified, though the activities to which the budget relates are
being undertaken for the first time, without approval, the budget allowance is zero.
Theoretical Questions
1. Explain the advantages and disadvantages of Budget and Budgetary Control.
2. Distinguish between Fixed and Flexible Budget
3. What is Flexible Budget? Discuss the characteristics of Flexible of Budget.
4. Write short notes on:
(a) Master Budget
(b) Performance Budgeting
(c) Responsibility Accounting
(d) Zero based Budgeting
A. Master Budget
B. Flexible Budget
C. Cash Budget
D. Capital Budget
6. The difference between fixed cost and variable cost assumes significance in the preparation of
the following budget.
A. Master Budget
B. Flexible Budget
C. Cash Budget
D. Capital Budget
A. Master budget
C. Cash Budget
8. Sales budget is a
A. expenditure budget
B. functional budget
C. Master budget
D. None of these
9. When a company wants to prepare a factory overhead budget in which the estimated costs
are directly derived from the estimates of activity levels, which of the following budget should be
prepared by the company?
A. Flexible budget
B. Fixed budget
C. Master budget
D. R & D budget
E. None of the above
10. Which of the following budgets facilitates classification of fixed and variable costs:
A. Capital expenditure budget
B. Flexible budget
C. Cash budget
D. Raw materials budget
E. All of the above
11. The entire budget organisation is controlled and headed by a senior executive known as:
A. General Manager
B. Accountant
C. Budget Controller
D. None of the above
12. Which of the following is generally a long term budget?
A. Cash budget
B. Sales budget
C. Research and Development budget
D. Capital expenditure budget
E. None of the above
13. A flexible budget requires a careful study of
A. Fixed, semi-fixed and variable expenses
B. Past and current expenses
C. Overheads, selling and administrative expenses.
D. None of these.
14. The basic difference between a fixed budget and flexible budget is that a fixed budget
A. is concerned with a single level of activity, while flexible budget is prepared for different levels
of activity
B. Is concerned with fixed costs, while flexible budget is concerned with variable costs.
C. is fixed while flexible budget changes
D. None of these.
[Ans: D, B, D, D, A, B, B, B, A, B, C, D, A,A]
2. To achieve the anticipated targets, Planning, Co-ordination and Control are the important main
tasks of management, achieved through budgeting and budgetary control.
3. A key factor or principal factor does not influence the preparation of all other budgets.
5. Generally, budgets are prepared to coincide with the financial year so that comparison of
the actual performance with budgeted estimates would facilitate better interpretation and
understanding.
7. A flexible budget recognises the difference between fixed, semi-fixed and variable cost and is
designed to change in relation to the change in level of activity
8. Sales budget, normally, is the most important budget among all budgets.
9. The principal factor is the starting point for the preparation of various budgets.
[Ans. 1. True 2. True 3. False 4. False 5. True 6. False 7. True 8. True 9. True 10. False.]
2. The key factor in a budget does not remain the _____ every year.
7. The document which describes the budgeting organisation, procedure etc is known as
________________.
9. The principle budget factor for consumer goods manufacture is normally ________.
Column A Column B
1. Master budget denotes the summary of A Financial means.
2. A flexible budget takes into the account. B A specified period.
3. A budget is expressed in terms of. C Flexible Budget
4. Which budget is prepared for a longer period. D Mater Budget
5. Budget is generally prepared for how long. E Fixed, variable and semi variable costs.
6. Which budget is prepared for more than one F Functional Budget
level of activity
7. The summary of all functional budgets. G Principle Key factor
8. Which budget is prepared at first. H Capital Expenditure Budget
9. Which budget shows utilisation of liquid cash I Decision Package
10. Zero based budgeting J Cash Budget
[Ans: F, E, A, H, B, C, D, G, J, I]
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
June 2019 P-8 (CAC)
Syllabus 2016
Cost Accounting
Time Allowed: 3 Hours Full Marks: 100
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
All Sections are compulsory. Each section contains instructions
regarding the number of questions to be answered within the section.
All working notes must form part of the answer.
Wherever necessary, candidates may make appropriate assumptions
and clearly state them.
No present value factor table or other statistical table will be provided in
addition to this question paper.
Section-A
Section A contains Question Number 1. All parts of this question are compulsory.
(v) Which of the following items is not included in preparation of cost sheet?
(A) Purchase returns
(B) Carriage inwards
(C) Sales commission
(D) Interest paid
(vi) In job costing to record the issue of direct materials to a job which of the following document is
used?
(A) Purchase order
(B) Goods receipt note
(C) Material requisition
(D) Purchase requisition
(vii) In a process 4000 units are introduced during a period. 5% of input is normal loss. Closing work-in-
progress 60% complete is 500 units. 3300 completed units are transferred to next process. Equivalent
production for the period is
(A) 3550 units
(B) 3600 units
(C) 3800 units
(D) 3950 units
(viii) Product A generates a contribution to sales ratio of 40%. Fixed cost directly attributable to A amount
` 60,000. The sales revenue required to achieve a profit of ` 15,000 is
(A) ` 2,00,000
(B) ` 1,85,000
(C) ` 1,87,500
(D) ` 2,10,000
(ix) During a period 13600 labour hours were worked at a standard rate of ` 8 per hour. The direct labour
efficiency variance was ` 8,800 (Adv). How many standard hours were produced?
(A) 12000 hours
(B) 12500 hours
(C) 13000 hours
(D) 13500 hours
(x) Cash Budget of ABC Ltd. forewarns of a short-term surplus. Which of the following would be
appropriate action to be taken in such a situation?
(A) Purchase new fixed assets
(B) Repay long-term loans
(C) Write off preliminary expenses
(D) Pay creditors early to obtain a cash discount
(b) Match the statement in Column I with the most appropriate statement in Column II
(You may opt to write only the Roman numeral and the matched alphabet instead of copying contents
into the answer books): 1x5=5
Column I Column II
(i) Pharma Industry (A) Opportunity Cost
(ii) Management by exception (B) Direct Allocation
(iii) Assessment of employee (C) Joint Cost
with respect to a job
(iv) Royalties (D) Batch Costing
(v) CAS-19 (E) Merit Rating
(F) Variance Analysis
(G) Job Evaluation
(H) Notional Cost
(c) State whether the following are ‘True’ or ‘False’: (You may write only the Roman numeral and whether
‘True’ or ‘False’ without copying the statements into the answer books): 1 x5=5
(i) Bin card is maintained by the costing department.
(ii) CAS-8 deal with the principles and methods of determining the direct expenses.
(iii) FIFO method is followed for evaluation of equivalent production when prices are fluctuating.
(iv) Profit Volume ratio remains constant at all levels of activity.
(v) The principal factor is the starting point for the preparation of various budgets.
(d) Fill in the blanks: (You may write only the Roman numeral and the content filling the blanks): 1x5=5
(i) Differential cost is the change in the cost due to change in ________ from one level to another.
(ii) CAS ________ stands for cost of service cost centre.
(iii) In contract costing, the cost unit is ________ .
(iv) Marginal cost is the ________ of sales over contribution.
(v) When actual cost is less than the standard cost, it is known as ________ variance.
Section - B
Answer any five questions from question numbers 2 to 8.
Each question carries 15 marks.
15x5=75
2. (a) ZINTES LTD. a manufacturing company has its factories at two locations. Rowan plan is in use at location A
and Halsey plan at location B. Standard time and basic rate of wages are same for a job which is similar
and is carried out on similar machinery. Time allowed is 60 hours.
Job at location A is completed in 36 hours while at B, it has taken 48 hours. Conversion costs at respective
places are ` 1224 and ` 1500. Overheads amount to ` 20 per hour.
Required:
(i) Find out the normal wage rate, and
(ii) Compare conversion costs. 7
(b) ALPHA LTD. has three Production Departments and two Service Departments. The overhead distribution
sheet of the company showed the following totals:
Production Department: Amount (`)
P 75,500
Q 72,000
R 96,500
Service Department:
X 46,250
Y 15,750
P Q R X Y
Department X 20% 30% 40% — 10%
Department Y 40% 20% 30% 10% —
Required:
(i) Calculate the total overhead of production departments distributing the cost of service departments
by Simultaneous Equation Method.
(ii) Calculate the overhead rate per hour of production departments. 8
3. (a) What is the Employee Cost as defined in CAS-7 (Limited Revision 2017)? Also discuss the general principles
of its measurement as per CAS-7. (any five only) 6
(b) The following information has been extracted from the financial books of ABC Ltd. for the year ended 31st
March, 2019:
4. (a) VIPUL LTD. submits the following information on 31st March, 2019:
Work-in-progress 80,000
Materials inventory—
Work-in-progress 1,20,000
(b) WEST LAND LTD. in the course of refining crude oil obtains four joint products P, Q, R and S. The total cost till
the split-off point was ` 9,76,640. The output and sales in the year 2018 were as follows:
Required:
(i) Calculate the net income for each of the products if the joint costs are apportioned on the basis of
Net realisable values (NRV) of the different products.
(ii) Calculate the net income of each of the products if the company decides to sell the products at the
split-off point itself as-P@ `18, Q @ `1.50, R @ `10 and S @ `7.80 per gallon. 7
5. (a) CARLHAMS LTD. runs a lodging home in a hill station. For this purpose, it has hired a building at a rent
of `1,20,000 per month along with 5% of total takings. The lodging home has three types of suites for its
customers, viz., single room, double rooms and triple rooms.
Provide profit @ 20% on total takings and assume 360 days in a year.
You are required to work out the room rent chargeable per day for each type of suite. 8
(b) NIRVANA LTD. undertook a contract for `50,00,000 on 1st April, 2018. On 31st March, 2019 when the
accounts of the company were closed, the following details about the contract were gathered:
Amount (`)
Particulars X Y Z
Sales 22,40,000 11,20,000 16,80,000
Direct materials 2,80,000 1,40,000 2,80,000
Direct labour 1,12,000 1,40,000 4,48,000
Direct expenses 2,80,000 1,40,000 5,60,000
Fixed cost 5,60,000 2,80,000 5,60,000
The management of the company is considering to close down department ‘Z’. There is a possibility of
reducing fixed cost by `1,50,000 if department ‘Z’ is closed down.
Advise the management whether or not department ‘Z’ should be closed down. 8
(b) SRIJAN LTD. had incurred fixed expenses of `9,00,000 with sales of `20,00,000 and earned a profit of `3,00,000
during the first half-year. In the second-half, it suffered a loss of `1,50,000.
Required:
Calculate the following:
(i) The P/V Ratio, Break Even Point and Margin of Safety for the first half-year.
(ii) The expected sales amount for the second half-year assuming that the selling price and fixed
expenses remained unchanged during the second half-year.
(iii) The Break Even point and Margin of Safety for the whole year. 7
7. (a) BENCO LTD. a manufacturing concern which has adopted standard costing furnishes the following
information for the month ending March 31, 2019:
The standard mix to produce one unit of product Z is as under—
Material A 30kg @ ` 30 per kg
Material B 40kg @ ` 50 per kg
Material C 50kg @ ` 40 per kg
During the month of December 2018, 10 units of product Z were actually produced and consumption was
as under—
Material A 320kg @ ` 35 per kg
Material B 475kg @ ` 55 per kg
Material C 435kg @ ` 36 per kg
Required:
Calculate the following Material Variances:
(i) Material Cost Variance
(ii) Material Price Variance
(iii) Material Usage Variance
(iv) Material Mix Variance
(v) Material Yield Variance 8
(b) ANKRITI LTD. manufactures product X and product Y during the year ending on 31st March, 2019. It is
expected to sell 7500 kg of product X and 37500 kg of product Y @ ` 60 and ` 32 per kg respectively.
The direct materials A, B and C are mixed in the proportion of 4:4:2 in the manufacture of Product X and
in the proportion of 3:5:2 in the manufacture of product Y. The actual and budget inventories for the year
are as follows:
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
December 2018 P-8 (CAC)
Syllabus 2016
Cost Accounting
Time Allowed: 3 Hours Full Marks: 100
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
All Sections are compulsory. Each section contains instructions
regarding the number of questions to be answered within the section.
All working notes must form part of the answer.
Wherever necessary, candidates may make appropriate assumptions
and clearly state them.
No present value factor table or other statistical table will be provided in
addition to this question paper.
Section-A
Section A contains Question Number 1. All parts of this question are compulsory.
(b) Match the statement in Column I with the most appropriate statement in Column II
(You may opt to write only the Roman numeral and the matched alphabet instead of copying contents
into the Answer Books): 1 x5=5
Column I Column II
(i) Cash discount allowed (A) Joint Cost
(ii) Escalation Clause (B) Imputed Cost
(iii) CAS-19 (C) Direct Expenses
(iv) Notional Cost (D) Not shown is cost sheet but debited to profit
and loss account
(v) Zero base budgeting (E) Sunk Cost
(F) Contract Costing
(G) Decision Package
(H) Variable Cost
(c) State whether the following statements are ‘True’ or ‘False’ (You may write only the Roman numeral and
whether True’ or ‘False’ without copying the statements into the Answer Book): 1x5=5
(i) Multiple costing is suitable for banking industry.
(ii) Slow moving materials have a high turnover ratio.
(iii) Cost ledger control account makes the cost ledger self-balancing.
(iv) There is inverse relationship between batch size and carrying costs.
(v) Marginal costing follows the identifiability wise classification of costs.
(d) Fill in the blanks (You may write only the Roman numeral and the content filling blanks): 1x5=5
(i) _______ is discount allowed to the bulk purchaser.
(ii) CAS _______ stands for cost of utilities.
(iii) Under integrated accounting system, the accounting entry for payment of wages is to debit _______
and to credit cash account.
(iv) If the actual loss in a process is less than the normal loss, the difference is known as _______.
(v) The principal budget factor for consumer goods manufacturer is normally _______ .
Section-B
Answer any five questions from question numbers 2 to 8.
Each question carries 15 marks. 15x5=75
2. (a) ZEDYAAH TUBES LTD. manufactures a special product, which requires ZEDY. The following particulars were
collected for the year 2017-18:
(i) Monthly demand of Zedy : 7500 units
(ii) Cost of placing an order : `500
(iii) Re-order period : 5 to 8 weeks
(iv) Cost per unit : ` 60
(v) Carrying cost % p.a. : 10%
Required:
Calculate the following:
(i) Re-order quantity
(ii) Re-order level
(iii) Minimum stock level
(iv) Maximum stock level
(v) Average stock level 7
(b) SONAX LTD. has three Production Departments and two Service Departments. The overhead distribution
sheet showed the following totals:
`
Production Departments:
A 25,000
B 31,000
C 28,000
Service Departments:
S 8,000
T 13,900
Required:
Using the following bases of apportionment, distribute the cost of service departments under Simultaneous
Equation Method:
A B C S T
3. (a) What are the various types of materials included in the Material Cost as dealt with by CAS-6 relating to
Cost Accounting Standard on Material Cost?
State the objective and scope of the Standard. 6
(b) The following information is available from the financial books of PQR Ltd. having a normal production
capacity of 60000 units for the year ended 31 st March. 2018:
(i) Sales ` 10,00,000 (50000 units)
(ii) There was no opening and closing stock of finished units.
(iii) Direct material and direct wages costs were ` 5,00.000 and ` 2,50,000 respectively.
(iv) Actual factory expenses were ` 1,50,000 of which 60% are fixed.
(v) Actual administrative expenses were `45,000 which are completely fixed.
(vi) Actual selling and distribution expenses were ` 30.000 of which 40% are fixed.
(vii) Interest and dividends received ` 15,000
4. (a) Z Ltd., manufactured and sold 200 typewriters in the year 2017. Its summarised Trading and Profit & Loss
Account for the year 2017 is as follows:
Total Output (in units) 200
Particulars ` Particulars `
6,00,000 6,00,000
2,25,000 2,25,000
Required:
Prepare a Cost Sheet showing the cost at which typewriters will be manufactured in 2018 and give price
at which it should by marketed so as to show profit of 10% on selling price. 8
(b) The following details are extracted from the costing records of EVINIE LTD., an oil mill for the year ended
31st March, 2018. Purchased 2000 tons of copra for `1,00,000 and other expenses were as under:
5. (a) GOLDEN TRANSPORT CO. has been given a route 20km. long for running buses. The company has a fleet
of 10 buses each costing ` 60,000 and having a life of 5 years without any scrap value.
The following are estimated expenditure and other details:
(i) Insurance charges 3% p.a.
(ii) Annual tax for each bus ` 3,000
(iii) Total garage charges ` 4,000 p.m.
(iv) Driver’s salary for each bus ` 10,000 p.m.
(v) Conductor’s salary for each bus ` 7,000 p.m.
(vi) Annual repairs to each bus ` 6,000
(vii) Commission to be shared by the driver and
conductor equally: 10% of the takings
(vii) Cost of stationary ` 1,500 p.m.
(ix) Manager’s salary ` 12,000 p.m.
(x) Accountant’s salary ` 9,000 p.m.
(xi) Petrol and oil ` 400 per 100 km
Each bus will make 3 round trips carrying on an average 40 passengers on each trip. The bus will run on an
average for 25 days in a month.
Assuming 15% profit on takings, Calculate the bus fare to be charged from each - passenger. 8
(b) OMEGA LTD. undertook a contract for ` 5,00,000 on 1st January, 2017. The company furnishes the following
details for the year ended 31st December, 2017:
`
Materials consumed 1,65,000
Direct Expenses 5,000
Wages 30,000
Materials returned to stores 5,000
Materials stolen from site 10,000
Insurance claim admitted 6,000
6. (a) A company budgets for a production of 5 lakh units at a variable cost of ` 20 each. The fixed costs are `20
lakh. The selling price is fixed to yield a profit of 25% on cost.
You are required to calculate
(i) P/V Ratio and Break even point.
(ii) If the selling price is reduced by 20%,
Ascertain:
(A) The effect of price reduction on the P/V Ratio and BEP.
(B) The number of units required to be sold at the reduced selling price to obtain an increase of 20% over
the budgeted profit. 8
(b) AVONA LTD.. a toy factory presents the following information ior the year endi March, 2018:
`
Material cost 1,20,000
Labour cost 2,40,000
Fixed overheads 1,20,000
Variable overheads 60,000
Units produced 12,000
Selling Price per Unit 50
The available capacity is a production of 20000 units per year. The firm has an offer for the purchase of
5000 additional units ai a price of ` 40 per unit. It is expected that accepting this offer there will be a saving
of rupee one per unit in material cost on all ui manufactured, the fixed overhead will increase by ` 35.000
and the overall efficiency will drop by 2% on all production.
State whether offer is acceptable or not. 7
7. (a) The details regarding the composition and the weekly wage rates of labour force of PB LTD engaged on
a job scheduled to be completed in 30 weeks are as follows:
(b) NP LTD produces a standard product. The estimated costs are given below:
`
Raw Materials 10
Direct Wages 8
Direct Expenses 2
Variable Overheads 3
23
Semi-variable overheads at 100% capacity level (10,000 units) are expected to be ` 40,000 and these
overheads vary in steps of ` 2,000 for each change in output of 1,000 units. Fixed overheads are estimated
at ` 50,000. Selling price per unit is expected to be ` 40.
Required:
Prepare a Flexible Budget at 50%, 70% and 90% level of activity on marginal cost basis. 7
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
June 2018 P-8 (CAC)
Syllabus 2016
Cost Accounting
Time Allowed: 3 Hours Full Marks: 100
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
All Sections are compulsory. Each section contains instructions
regarding the number of questions to be answered within the section.
All working notes must form part of the answer.
Wherever necessary, candidates may make appropriate assumptions
and clearly state them.
No present value factor table or other statistical table will be provided in
addition to this question paper.
Section-A
Section A contains Question Number 1. All parts of this question are compulsory.
(iv) Standard deals with the principles and methods of determining depreciation and amortization cost
is
(a) CAS-8
(b) CAS-11
(c) CAS-16
(d) CAS-20
(v) In Reconciliation Statement expenses shown only in cost accounts are
(a) Added to financial profit
(b) Deducted from financial profit
(c) Ignored
(d) Deducted from costing profit
(vi) In a job cost system, costs are accumulated
(a) On a monthly basis
(b) By specific job
(c) By department or process
(d) By kind of material used
(vii) In a process 6,000 units are introduced during a period. 5% of input is normal loss. Closing work-in-
process 60% complete is 800 units. 4,900 completed units are transferred to next process. Equivalent
production for the period is
(a) 6,800 units
(b) 5,700 units
(c) 5,680 units
(d) 5,380 umts
(viii) Which of the following best describes a fixed cost?
(a) It may change in total where such change is unrelated to changes in production.
(b) It may change in total where such change is related to changes in production.
(c) It is constant per unit of change in production.
(d) It may change in total where such change depends on production within the relevant range.
(ix) Z Ltd. is planning to sell 1,00,000 units of product A for ` 12.00 per unit. The fixed costs are ` 2,80,000.
In order to realize a profit of ` 2,00,000, what would the variable costs be?
(a) ` 4,80,000
(b) ` 7,20,000
(c) ` 9,00,000
(d) ` 9,20,000
(x) Sales budget is an example of
(a) Expenditure budget
(b) Functional budget
(c) Capital budget
(d) Master budget
(b) Match the statement in Column I with the most appropriate statement in Column II:
(You may opt to write only the Roman numeral and the matched alphabet instead of copying contents
into the answer Books) 1x5=5
Column I Column II
(i) Imputed costs A Cost control technique
(ii) FSN analysis B Treated as part of factory expenses
(iii) Captive power plant expenses C Costing profit and loss account
(iv) Abnormal loss is transferred to D Process of classifying material
(v) Variance analysis E Direct allocation
F Not involving cash outlay
G Management by exception
H Decision package
(c) State whether the following statements are ‘True’ or ‘False’:(You may write only the Roman numeral and
whether ‘True’ or ‘False’ without copying the statements into the answer books): 1x5=5
(i) Factory overhead cost applied to a job is usually based on a pre-determined rate.
(ii) CAS-19 deals with the principles and methods of determining the manufacturing cost of excisable
goods.
(iii) Cost ledger control account makes the cost ledger self-balancing.
(iv) FIFO method is followed for evaluation of equivalent production when prices are fluctuating.
(v) Standard costs and budgeted costs are inter-related and inter-dependent.
(d) Fill in the blanks : (You may write only the Roman numeral and the content filling the blanks) 1x5=5
(i) _______ is the process of regulating the action so as to keep the element of cost within the set
parameters.
(ii) In absorption costing _______ is added to inventory.
(iii) CAS _______ stands for cost of service cost centre.
(iv) At _______ contribution available is equal to total fixed cost.
(v) The document which describes the budgeting organisation, budgeting procedure etc. is known as
_______.
Section-B
Answer any five questions from question numbers 2 to 8.
Each question carries 15 marks. 15x5=75
(b) The following figures are taken from the accounts of BALEN LTD a manufacturing concern for the month of
October, 2017:
Indirect Materials : Production Departments : X `19,000; Y `24,000; Z `4,000;
Service Departments : Maintenance ` 30,000; Stores ` 8,000.
Indirect Wages : Production Departments : X `18,000; Y `22,000; Z `6,000;
Service Departments : Maintenance ` 20,000; Stores ` 13,000.
Other Expenses : Power and Light : `1,20,000; Rent and Rates `56,000; Insurance of Assets `20,000; Meal
Charges `60,000; Depreciation @ 6% p.a. on capital value of assets.
Departmental Data
3. (a) What are the Direct Expenses as defined in CAS-10 (Limited Revision 2017)? Also discuss the general
principles of its measurement as per CAS-10. (any five only) 6
(b) The net profit of X Ltd., appeared at `41,800 as per financial records for the year ending 31st March, 2018.
A scrutnity of the figures from both the sets of accounts revealed the following facts:
`
Works overhead under-recovered in costs 1,500
Administrative overheads over-recovered in costs 850
Depreciation charged in financial accounts 5,600
Depreciation recovered in costs 6,250
Interest on investments not included in costs 3,000
Loss due to obsolescence charged in financial accounts 2,850
Income tax reserve made in financial accounts 20,150
Bank interest and transfer fee credited in financial books 370
Stores adjustment (credit) in financial books 230
Value of opening stock in : Cost accounts 24,800
: Financial accounts 26,300
Value of closing stock in : Cost accounts 25,000
: Financial accounts 23,000
Interest charged in cost accounts 2,000
Imputed rent charged in cost accounts 1,000
Goodwill written off 5,000
Loss on sale of furniture 600
Selling and distribution expenses not charged in cost accounts 10,000
Donations to Prime Minister’s Relief Fund 5,100
Transfer to Debenture Redemption Fund 9,000
Transfer to Dividend Equalisation Fund 20,500
Required:
Prepare a statement showing the reconciliation statement and findout the profit as per cost Accounts. 9
4. (a) The following data are available from the books and records of VEEMYES Ltd. for the month of November
2017.
Direct Labour cost : ` 20,000 (125% of factory overheads)
Inventory accounts show the following figures:
November 1 November 30
` `
Raw materials 10,000 20,000
Work in progress 8,000 4,000
Finished goods 10,000 5,000
Selling expenses 15,000
Office expenses 10,000
Sales 1,25,000
(b) CBA Ltd. , manufactures certain grades of products known as M, Bl and B2. In course of manufacture of
product M (main product), by-products- Bl and B2 emerge. The joint expenses of manufacture amount to
`2,37,600.
All the three products are processed further after separation and sold as per details given below:
Product-M (By products)
Product B1 Product B2
Sales (`) 2,00,000 1,20,000 80,000
Cost incurred after separation (`) 20,000 15,000 10,000
Profit as percentage on sales 25 20 15
Total fixed selling expenses are 10% of total cost of sales which are apportioned to the three products in
the ratio of 20:40:40.
Required:
(i) Prepare a statement showing the apportionment of joint costs to the products (M, Bl andB2)
(ii) If the product Bl (by product) is not subject to further processing and is sold at the point of separation,
for which there is a market at `1,00,440 without incurring any selling expenses, would you advise its
disposal at this stage? Show the workings. 7
5. (a) JANATA TRANSPORT LTD. a Transport Company is running 4 buses between two towns which are 50 kms.
away. Seating capacity of each bus is 40 passengers. The following information is obtained from its books
for November, 2017:
Particulars `
Wages of drivers, conductors and cleaners 24,000
Salaries of office and supervisory staff 10,000
Diesel, oil and other lubricants 40,000
Repairs and maintenance 8,000
Taxes, insurance etc. 16,000
Depreciation of buses 26,000
Interest and other charges 20,000
Actual passengers carried were 75% of the seating capacity. All the 4 buses ran on all the days of the
month. Each bus made one to and fro round trip per day.
Prepare the Operating Cost Statement and determine the cost per passenger km. for each bus. 8
(b) A contractor, who prepare his accounts on 31st March each year, commenced a Contract No. 220 on 1st
July, 2016. The following information is revealed from his costing records on 31st March, 2017:
Particulars (`)
Materials sent to site 2,51,000
Labour 5,65,600
Foreman’s salary 81,300
A machine costing `2,60,000 remained in use on site for 146 days. Its working life is estimated at 7 years and
final scrap value at `15,000. A supervisor is paid `8,000 per month and has devoted one half of his time on
the contract. All other expenses amount to `1,36,500. Materials at site on 31st March, 2017 cost `35,400.
The contract price is `20,00,000. On 31st March, 2017 two-third of the contract was completed, however,
the architect gave certificate only for 50% of the contract price and `7,50,000 had so far been paid on
account.
Prepare Contract Account and state how much profit or loss should be included on 31st March, 2017 in
financial accounts. 7
6. (a) ANKIT LTD. a manufacturing Company which produces three products furnishes the following information
for the year 2016-17:
Particulars Products
A B C
Selling Price (per unit) `200 `150 `100
Profit Volume Ratio 10% 20% 40%
Raw Material content as a % of Variable Cost 50% 50% 50%
Maximum Sales Potential (units) 40,000 25,000 10,000
Fixed costs are estimated at `12 lakhs. The firm uses same raw material in all the three products. Raw
material is in ‘Short Supply’. The firm has a quota for the supply of raw materials of the value of `36 lakhs for
the year 2016-17 for the production of three products to meet sales demand.
Required:
Determine the optimal product mix and ascertain the maximum profit therefrom. 8
(b) The following figures are obtained from the records of P. Ltd.:
2015-16 (`) 2016-17 (`)
Sales 80,000 1,00,000
Net Profit 10,000 16,000
Required’.
Calculate the following:
(i) Profit Volume Ratio
(ii) Break Even Point
(iii) Profit or loss at sales of `40,000
(iv) Sales required to earn a profit of `22,000
(v) Margin of Safety if sales in `55,000 7
7. (a) The standard cost card of A & Co. shows the following costs:
Material cost - 2 kg @ `2.50 each `5.00 per unit
Wages - 2 hours @ 50 paise each `1.00 per unit
The actual data from business operations are as follows:
Production 8,000 units
Actual total cost of production:
Material cost - 16,500 kg @ ` 2.40 each `39,600
Wages -18,000 hours @ 40 paise each `7,200
(b) Summarised below are the revenue and expenditure figures of AB Ltd. for the month of March to August,
2017:
The Directorate of Studies is committed to keep abreast of CMA Students with the
latest amendments/notifications/advancements on each subject on regular basis.
Students are requested to visit CMA Students’ Portal [https://icmai.in/studentswebsite/]
regularly to view the updates.